274 110 9MB
English Pages 284 Year 2009
Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings
Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills
David C. Fischetti
John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
This book is printed on acid-free paper. ⬁ Copyright © 2009 by John Wiley & Sons, Inc. All rights reserved. Published by John Wiley & Sons, Inc., Hoboken, New Jersey Published simultaneously in Canada No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, scanning, or otherwise, except as permitted under Section 107 or 108 of the 1976 United States Copyright Act, without either the prior written permission of the Publisher, or authorization through payment of the appropriate per-copy fee to the Copyright Clearance Center, 222 Rosewood Drive, Danvers, MA 01923, (978) 750-8400, fax (978) 646-8600, or on the web at www.copyright.com. Requests to the Publisher for permission should be addressed to the Permissions Department, John Wiley & Sons, Inc., 111 River Street, Hoboken, NJ 07030, (201) 748-6011, fax (201) 748-6008, or online at www.wiley.com/go/permissions. Limit of Liability/Disclaimer of Warranty: While the publisher and the author have used their best efforts in preparing this book, they make no representations or warranties with respect to the accuracy or completeness of the contents of this book and specifically disclaim any implied warranties of merchantability or fitness for a particular purpose. No warranty may be created or extended by sales representatives or written sales materials. The advice and strategies contained herein may not be suitable for your situation. You should consult with a professional where appropriate. Neither the publisher nor the author shall be liable for any loss of profit or any other commercial damages, including but not limited to special, incidental, consequential, or other damages. For general information about our other products and services, please contact our Customer Care Department within the United States at (800) 762-2974, outside the United States at (317) 572-3993 or fax (317) 572-4002. Wiley also publishes its books in a variety of electronic formats. Some content that appears in print may not be available in electronic books. For more information about Wiley products, visit our web site at www.wiley.com. Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data: Fischetti, David C. Structural investigation of historic buildings : a case study guide to preservation technology for buildings, bridges, towers, and mills / David C. Fischetti. p. cm. Includes index. ISBN 978-0-470-18967-2 (cloth) 1. Building inspection. 2. Historic buildings—Conservation and restoration—Case studies. 3. Historic preservation—Conservation and restoration— Case studies. 4. Structural engineering—United States. I. Title. TH439.F55 2008 720.28'8—dc22 2008038581 Printed in the United States of America 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
Contents Introduction
CHAPTER 1
CHAPTER 2
vii
Acknowledgments
x
Historic Structures: The Role of the Structural Engineer
1
Preservation and Public Safety: Structural Safety of Historic Timber Structures
15
CHAPTER 3
Simplified Engineering
21
CHAPTER 4
Conservation and the Specialty Contractor
41
CHAPTER 5
Historic Timber Structures
57
CHAPTER 6
Watauga Hall and the Montague Building
71
CHAPTER 7
The Restoration of St. Helena’s Church
91
CHAPTER 8
Market Hall Rehabilitation
115
CHAPTER 9
Differential Settlement at St. Philip’s Moravian Church at Old Salem
123
CHAPTER 10 James Madison’s Montpelier
139
CHAPTER 11 Timber, Glulam, and Conservation
149
v
vi
Contents
CHAPTER 12 Tabby: Engineering Characteristics of a Vernacular Construction Material 169 CHAPTER 13 Relocating the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse
181
CHAPTER 14 Crisis in American Covered Bridges
207
CHAPTER 15 The Timber Trusses of Burr, Town, and Haupt
211
CHAPTER 16 The Cornish-Windsor Covered Bridge
227
CHAPTER 17 A New Covered Bridge for Old Salem
241
CHAPTER 18 The Tohickon Aqueduct
253
CHAPTER 19 The Current State of Historic Preservation Engineering: One Engineer’s Point of View
263
Index
271
Introduction n North America, our built environment of what is commonly referred to as historic structures typically includes everything 50 years of age or older. These structures are as diverse as Montezuma Castle, a cliff dwelling of mud and stone constructed in Arizona about 1150 A.D., to Dorton Arena, the world’s first cablesupported roof system, built in Raleigh, North Carolina, in 1952. The purpose of this book is to help prepare consulting structural engineers and others to deal with issues unique to historic structures. This book will also explore the reasons why engineering practitioners tend to shy away from these projects. Unfortunately, for liability concerns, and other reasons, few American structural engineers have embraced a preservation philosophy that allows for the continued use of our architectural and structural heritage. And yet, with the possible exception of the absence of timber design in some programs, civil engineering curricula in most North American universities should adequately equip the graduate engineer with sufficient skills to address the varied challenges posed by evaluation and condition assessment through observation, measurement, analysis, and testing. The case studies in this book are not totally representative of the full array of possible building types that may be encountered by the great majority of structural engineers. As case studies, they represent the particular experience encountered in one consulting structural engineer’s practice. The building types may be somewhat skewed by my experience in timber design and my geographic location, and specifically, the states where I am registered to practice engineering. This book can serve as a text in preservation courses for students of many disciplines. Whether the curriculum is history, architecture, art history, planning, engineering, construction management, or materials based, there is a need for the students who are anticipating a preservation career to know what to expect from their structural engineer team members or consultants. The seasoned structural engineer will find information useful to projects involving existing buildings to the extent that one may wish to obtain continuing education credits in the field to fulfill registration obligations, or obtain some certificate or advanced degree in historic preservation.
I
vii
viii
Introduction
Conservation of our existing structures has obvious economic and social value. The success of various structural engineering solutions can be told through case studies to a wider audience, so that potential candidates for restoration, rehabilitation, or adaptive reuse, do not meet the wrecking ball without a second chance.
EVALUATING A TIMBER STRUCTURE Our procedure for evaluating an existing framed building or roof structure, historic or not, is to apply today’s code mandated snow, live, and wind and seismic loads to various component systems, assuming that no deterioration has occurred. In this way, the original structure can be tested with specific load criteria, against reasonable allowable design values so that the amount of stress in various elements can be tabulated and compared to allowables. By performing a computer analysis, the stiffness in various components, and the continuity, or lack of continuity, through joints, can be included, resulting in accurate theoretical deflections. The computed deflections can then be compared to today’s code mandated limits for structures. Once this process is completed, then a review of the amount of stress in particular elements can be compared against reasonable values that could be expected from the materials used at the time the building was constructed. After structural analysis is complete, then a condition analysis can be made on the basis of field observation, measurement, and testing. Ideally, it is best to have at least a preliminary analysis in hand prior to actually observing conditions in the field. In reality, we often are responding to the client’s wishes to inspect the structure as soon as possible, without benefit of measured drawings from the architect or prior information of any kind. Through analysis and engineering judgment, the capacity of various components can be tabulated to account for deterioration. The theoretical deflection can be compared to the actual deformation of the structure as measured in the field. Each study will be presented with emphasis on the structural evaluation and condition assessment. Each section will include a description of the project and its history, a condition assessment, structural analysis, discussion, recommendations and a description of the subsequent intervention as executed with drawings and photographs.
WHY THE BOOK IS NEEDED Tasks as simple as determining the grades and applicable design values for timber components and how to apply the effects of load duration to the evaluation of historic timber structures need to be included in a preservation engineering
Introduction
ix
text. Reservations in the evaluation of wrought iron, and the unknowns associated with determining the capacity of unreinforced historic masonry or archaic concrete systems, are but a few of the issues leading to the wholesale destruction of potentially serviceable buildings and bridges. For example, not knowing the effects on strength of slag inclusions in wrought iron has caused structural engineers to automatically call for the replacement, with new steel, of all the possibly perfectly serviceable wrought iron tension rods in many building trusses and historic bridges. This book will also raise some questions that will be of interest to the research community. Historic structures provide an excellent laboratory to study aspects of structural engineering, materials science, forensic engineering, and building design. This book emphasizes a preservation philosophy that stresses achieving structural safety using traditional materials, based on modern analysis, measurement, and testing techniques. It is not a compilation of available ASTM tests or a documentation of various archaic structural systems. Lessons learned in historic preservation make us better designers of new structures.
Acknowledgments y career has been influenced by many people who do not appear in these case histories who need to be acknowledged. Some, such as Wm. C. Vick and Tommy Vick of Wm. C. Vick Construction Co. in Raleigh, NC afforded me the opportunity to work on projects with some of these same design issues. Robert C. Browning, P.E. was an engineer interested, early on, on the work I was doing. My parents Rose and Constantine Fischetti, of course, encouraged me in my career. My grandfather Luigi Rinaldi, Master Brickmason, gave me my first job in construction. I graduated from Brooklyn Technical High School thirty years after my father. The teachers at Brooklyn Tech, most with industrial or construction experience, had a positive influence, particularly Angelo Amatelli, Head of the Structural Course of study. My timber design experience began at Koppers Company, Inc. in Pittsburgh in the Unit Structures Department of the Forest Products Division. I would like to thank Harry C. Smith, P.E. and Einar Orsett, P.E. for their guidance. Over the years many people have typed the various manuscripts which enabled this book to be published: Denise Bowles, Beckie Mitchem, Dolly Foster, Lynn McBride, Tami Wahl, and Connie Harrison. Most important is Gretchen Moog Tippett whose work was crucial in the final production of the manuscript. I want to also acknowledge Jim Harper, my editor, and Nancy Cintron, production editor, at Wiley. This book would not be possible without the work of my daughter Stephanie A. Fischetti who assembled the initial outline and proposal. Most of all I would like to thank my wife Joyce and our family for all of their love and support.
M
x
FIGURE 6-7 Floors were replaced in the Eagle Block (ca. 1835) in similar fashion to Watauga Hall. (See page 87 for discussion.)
FIGURE 7-10 Lateral bracing consisting of timber poles and framing was installed on both sidewalls. (See Chapter 7 for discussion of St. Helena’s Church.)
Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
FIGURE 7-19 All exterior surfaces were renewed, including the steeple. (See Chapter 7 for discussion of St. Helena’s Church.)
FIGURE 8-4 The technology used is common to the timber period of original construction. (See Chapter 8 for discussion of Market Hall.)
FIGURE 8-5 The iron work was restored to its original configuration and color. (See Chapter 8 for discussion of Market Hall.)
FIGURE 8-6 This completed building again houses the Confederate Museum. (See Chapter 8 for discussion of Market Hall.)
FIGURE 9-5 The log church has a false chimney and cupola. (See pages 131 to 134 for discussion of the St. Philip’s Log Church.)
FIGURE 9-16 The masonry wall was supported by the mini-piles. Steel bands were used to provide under-slung support to the wall. (See Chapter 9 for discussion of St. Philip’s Church.)
FIGURE 10-1 View of the surrounding property from the attic. (See Chapter 10 for discussion of James Madison’s Montpelier.)
FIGURE 10-10 Arnold Graton (shown here) temporarily braced the chimney prior to removing soil and installing jacks. (See Chapter 10 for discussion of Montpelier.)
FIGURE 10-12 The chimney extension provided duct access into the vertical spaces within the chimney. (See Chapter 10 for discussion of Montpelier.)
FIGURE 12-7 The Horton-DuBignon House on Jekyll Island (ca. 1738) is one of the oldest tabby structures in Georgia. (See Chapter 12 for discussion on Tabby.)
FIGURE 15-3 The deteriorated members in the Utica Road Covered Bridge were replaced in kind. (See page 213 for discussion.)
FIGURE 15-4 The Old Salem Covered Bridge is a modified Burr. A partial arch is shown here during construction. (See Chapter 17 for discussion.)
FIGURE 15-8 The Bunker Hill Covered Bridge with repairs almost completed. (See pages 219–225 for discussion.)
FIGURE 16-3 The cable stayed system allowed for an orderly rehabilitation of the roof structure. (See Chapter 16 for discussion of the Cornish-Windsor Bridge.)
FIGURE 16-8 The governors of both New Hampshire and Vermont attended the dedication ceremony. (See Chapter 16 for discussion of the Cornish-Windsor Bridge.)
FIGURE 17-1 The acrylic panels provided a weathertight sidewall closure. (See Chapter 17 for discussion of the Old Salem Covered Bridge.)
FIGURE 18-1 The aqueduct consists of three equal spans of 66 feet. (See Chapter 18 for discussion of the Tohickon Aqueduct.)
FIGURE 18-7 The completed aqueduct won a National Timber Bridge Award in 2002. (See Chapter 18 for discussion of the Tohickon Aqueduct.)
CHAPTER
1
Historic Structures: The Role of the Structural Engineer
THE STRUCTURAL ENGINEER AS A PRESERVATIONIST ervices of the structural engineer may include planning, estimating, making structural evaluations, conducting feasibility studies, designing, and consulting. Adaptive use, the practice of renovating or rehabilitating a structure for a use other than that for which it was first designed, involves, for the structural engineer, several opportunities to be of service. Although the final construction cost may include as little as 5 to 12 percent of the total project cost for structural work, the structural engineer may play a pivotal role in determining whether a project will be economically feasible. A structural evaluation will indicate whether structural elements are reused, reinforced, or replaced. Often, adapting a building to a new use requires extensive structural changes to be made in order to make the building conform to current needs and code requirements. A common challenge for the structural engineer is how to construct, within a historic structure, an elevator shaft so that upper floors may be accessible. Seismic retrofit is an important concern facing historic structures in areas where retroactive seismic building code requirements are in force. The services provided by a structural engineer associated with moving a
S
Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
1
2
Historic Structures: The Role of the Structural Engineer
historic building might include a structural evaluation to determine whether the structure can be moved intact, partially disassembled, or relocated in sections. Structural reinforcement or the design of a new foundation might also be required. Registered land surveyors are the most qualified to provide accurate base measurements when the extensive documentation of a historic structure is required.
REHABILITATION GUIDELINES All structural engineers should obtain a copy of The Secretary of the Interior’s Standards for Rehabilitation. Under these standards, rehabilitation means “the process of returning a property to a state of utility, through repair or alteration, which makes possible an efficient contemporary use while preserving those portions and features of the property that are significant to its historic, architectural, and cultural value.” Minimum alteration of the building, its environment, and its distinguishing architectural qualities is required for a project to qualify as a “certified rehabilitation” benefiting from the provisions of the tax act. Archeological resources must be protected, as well as significant historical, architectural, or cultural material. An understanding of the historical significance of a building must be obtained to enable the engineer to provide an acceptable solution to a particular design problem while following the “secretary’s standards.” The guidelines for applying The Secretary of the Interior’s Standards for Rehabilitation recommend recognition of the “special problems inherent in the structural system of historic buildings, especially where there are visible signs of cracking, deflection, or failure.” In addition, “stabilization and repair of weakened structural members and systems when damaged or inadequate” are recommended. “Historically important structural members” are to be replaced “only when necessary.”1
BUILDING CODES AND HISTORIC STRUCTURES The structural engineer must make a realistic judgment when applying modern building code live-load requirements to a historic structure. For example, how much snow can adhere to a steeply pitched slate or tin roof? How does one rationalize the successful service of a hundred-year-old church roof structure when the forces obtained from the frame analysis appear too great for the
The Structural Evaluation
3
connections involved? As in the review and evaluation of any structure, the engineer must make a judgment, based on available information, of the safety of such a structure. Should the engineer call for the reinforcing of a timber floor structure with steel beams when it is safe in bending and shear but exceeds deflection requirements when loaded with a required minimum live-load based on occupancy? The 2006 North Carolina State Building Code, which is the Standard Building Code with North Carolina amendments, includes several provisions for historic structures. In Section 1009, “Historic Buildings for Public Display or Exhibition” and Section 1010, “Historic Buildings for Adaptive Use,” the definition of historic buildings is as follows: General (a) Historic buildings means buildings designated as historic properties. (1) By the state historic preservation officer acting on behalf of the North Carolinian Historical Commission in accordance with the provisions of G.S. 121.8 and NCAC 46.0600. (2) Or by a local historic properties commission constituted in accordance with G.S. 160A.399.2 subject to review and approval by the Building Code Council.2
Included in the code are provisions regarding repairs, additions, sprinkler systems, means of egress, and the moving of historic buildings. In recent years several codes have adopted the innovations and principles of the New Jersey Rehabilitation Subcode commonly know as the New Jersey Rehab Code which was first published in 1997. Chapter 34, Existing Structures in the 2003 International Building Code also includes Section 3407 entitled Historic Buildings states that, “The provisions of this code relating to the construction, repair, alteration, addition, restoration, and movement of structures, and change of occupancy shall not be mandatory for historic buildings where such buildings are judged by the building official to not constitute a distinct life safety hazard.”2
THE STRUCTURAL EVALUATION Structural engineers have been reluctant to become involved with historic preservation projects, often because of the potential liability imposed on the engineer. By merely providing a structural evaluation of a historic structure, the engineer may become “the engineer of record” for a building constructed
4
Historic Structures: The Role of the Structural Engineer
with “primitive” methods and materials. Many historic structures were not rigorously analyzed, but proportioned by the eye of an experienced builder or simply built as was the custom. If the engineer becomes involved in even a small portion of a historic preservation project, there must be adequate compensation for the assumed liability. The engineer must be completely satisfied that a structure meets the loading requirements for its intended occupancy, as well as all external forces. Structural evaluations usually include a determination of the ability of a floor or roof system to support these service loads. An existing structure might have to be monitored in order to obtain data for such an evaluation. Testing programs may have to be designed to aid in determining the strength of component materials or complete assemblies. Methods may consist of destructive or nondestructive testing of component materials or load tests of structural members such as beams or assemblies such as trusses. It will likely be necessary to adapt current testing methods for field use on historic structures. Accurate field measurements are essential in defining the structure and its condition. Surveying methods have been successfully utilized in determining the stiffness of deflected beams and trusses. A topographic plan of the floor surface of a historic structure will yield a useful visual representation of an irregular floor if the contour interval is small. Irregular floors in a historic structure could be caused by movement in the supporting soils, timber decay or shrinkage, or deflection of structural components. The ability to interpret the response of a structure to background vibrations and induced vibrations has made vibratory testing a valuable historic preservation tool. X-ray, liquid penetrant, nuclear particle density meters, and ultrasonic techniques are being used to evaluate various construction materials. The correct interpretation of masonry cracks may yield accurate information regarding the location and amounts of settlement or thermal movement. Monitoring such cracks is possible with “telltales” such as glass slides epoxied to the wall surface on each side of a fissure. Even slight movement can be detected by using such a strategy. Accurate monitoring of cracks is possible with calibrated telltales accurate to within one millimeter and electronic strain gauges. Load testing a historic structure may be the only reasonable way to justify conditions or materials that are difficult to analyze. In designing a load test, the engineer must call for the application of realistic loads carefully applied. Great care should be taken before applying twice the design live load, as required by many building codes, to a historic structure. For timber structures it may be unrealistic to apply full live load plus an increase for a period such as 24 or 48 hours, when the structure actually will never reach that service loading for
Materials Research
5
FIGURE 1-1 This load test utilized water to determine the average stiffness of a series of recycled joists.
that length of time. Applying a known, safe load to a historic structure is an excellent method for determining the stiffness characteristics of various materials. This is of special value when evaluating timber structures. It is important to realize that because of the variation in the strength characteristics of timber, a load test of one member of a structure may not be indicative of the true capacity in other areas of the building. For any material, before a load test is undertaken, the engineer must be certain that all lateral bracing and slenderness requirements are satisfied. A preliminary analysis must be performed to ensure that the structure will not be loaded past the elastic limit or further to destruction. The application of strain gages and other instrumentation is highly desirable in monitoring a load test. Through the use of monitoring techniques, testing, measurements, observation, and structural calculations, an accurate interpretation of the structural capability of a historic structure can be presented in a carefully written report.
MATERIALS RESEARCH Research may yield information useful in the evaluation, rehabilitation, or renovation of the historic structure. Original plans, construction photographs, and written or oral accounts may provide clues to the original design or construction methodology. Old textbooks or materials handbooks may provide design methods and design strengths of various materials.
6
Historic Structures: The Role of the Structural Engineer
The structural engineer must be familiar with the properties of materials such as timber, steel, cast iron, wrought iron, stone, brick masonry, terra cotta, and reinforced concrete. Patented floor or roof systems composed of various materials might appear only in manufacturer’s literature, with little or no design information available.
THE EVALUATION OF CONCRETE Reinforcing steel in older concrete buildings may be square, round, or hexagonal in cross-section with various types of deformations and exhibiting various physical properties. Early reinforcing steel was produced as plain and deformed steel in structural, intermediate, and hard grades. Structural grade was normally used unless specified otherwise. Structural engineers should obtain a copy of CRSI Engineering Data Report, no. 11, titled “Evaluation of Reinforcing Steel in Old Reinforced Concrete Structures.”3 The first specifications for reinforcing steel were developed in 1910 by the Association of American Steel Manufacturers. In 1911, the American Society for Testing and Materials adopted standard specification A15 for billet steel concrete reinforcing bars. Minimum working stresses and yield strengths for these and other early specifications are presented in the CRSI report. The most difficult problem in evaluating historic reinforced concrete structures is determining the size and location of the reinforcing steel. Various instruments now available may be used for such purposes, but should be verified by exposing the reinforcing steel in noncritical locations to visual inspection. Development lengths, bending and cutoff details, and effective depths must be determined. The material properties of both the steel and concrete should be determined by testing. Samples of reinforcing steel suitable for testing can usually be obtained without affecting the structural adequacy of an existing structure if the locations are carefully selected. A preliminary structural analysis aids in locating areas of low stress suitable for sampling. Nondestructive load testing of complete flexural members can be employed to verify calculated deflections. Accurate methods are still needed to aid engineers in evaluating the effects of voids, cracks, and deteriorated reinforcing.
BRICK MASONRY RESTORATION Lime-sand mortar, commonly used in structures located above water level, is of great importance in the repair and restoration of historic buildings. The structural engineer interested in historic preservation should be familiar with masonry restoration specifications.
Brick Masonry Restoration
7
Mortar for face brick should match the original mortar in color, texture, density, and porosity. It should have strength equal or less than that of the original mortar. New mortar should have hardness equal to or less than that of the original brick, as determined by testing. The color of mortar used for repointing should be matched to the original by matching the color of original aggregates and mortar components as closely as possible. An archeological search may uncover ingredients of the original job mixed mortar, such as oyster shells, in the soil strata at the site in the builder’s trench, which contains other construction debris. The density and strength of historic brick units are a function of their position in the kiln and how well they were fired. Salmon brick, which are lightly burned, were typically reserved for the center of a wall and the harder, better burned, brick used as exterior face brick. Because of the extreme variations in their strength and durability, the use of salvaged brick should be discouraged. There are manufacturers who can match old brick very accurately and several manufacturers who are making bricks by the old methods. These bricks and a compatible lime mortar design mix are what is required to match the brick masonry of historic buildings. Repointing brick masonry is a waterproofing procedure and not a solution for structural problems. The repointing process is a critical procedure that should be done in carefully selected areas with great care.4 Materials engineers should become familiar with the components of historic mortars, and in that light review the methods for sampling and testing of masonry. The Brick Institute of America, Technical Notes on Brick Construction, no. 39A, reviews procedures for testing brick prisms.5 The standard ASTM methods of tests for masonry assemblages are especially applicable to the testing of historic masonry because of the possible variation in the mortar and brick strengths. The performance of historic mortar and brick can be evaluated in this way, not as individual components, but as they would perform together in the wall. Of course, obtaining suitable undisturbed samples for testing can be a problem with fragile materials. Once a replacement brick is selected and the original mortar approximated, prism testing of replacement masonry should yield information regarding allowable stresses that may be used in design. Mortar analysis and mix design should be accompanied by strength tests that can be evaluated by a materials testing engineer. There has been a tendency in the field of historic preservation to select brick and mortar so that they merely “look” right when placed alongside original masonry. The structural engineer can best determine that strength characteristics of replacement masonry materials are as compatible as the color and texture.
8
Historic Structures: The Role of the Structural Engineer
FIGURE 1-2 The entrance gates for Camden (Railroad) Yards in Charleston, South Carolina, were restored and the stucco was renewed.
The use of grinders, sandblasting, sanding discs, or other abrasives normally are not permitted in the cleaning of brick. Irrevocable damage has been done to historic masonry by abrasive cleaning. For example, removal of the outer surface of old brick may expose the more porous inner portion of the brick, which may lead to spalling due to moisture penetration and subsequent freezing.
TIMBER DESIGN AND HISTORIC PRESERVATION Often, the proper analysis and evaluation of a historic structure requires that the structural engineer have extensive timber design experience. Many historic structures in the United States are timber framed. Masonry construction is generally used for foundations, exterior wall support, and building enclosure. A thorough knowledge of the physical and mechanical properties of wood is necessary. Many historic structures were constructed of green timber because of the considerable time required to air dry large timbers. In the seasoning process, timber gives off or takes on moisture from the surrounding atmosphere with changes in temperature and relative humidity until it attains a balance relative to the atmospheric conditions. Historic structures have had time to reach this point of balance, known as the equilibrium moisture content.
Timber Design and Historic Preservation
9
Moisture content is the weight of the water contained in wood, expressed as a percentage of the weight of the oven-dried wood. As wood loses moisture, the water in the cell cavity evaporates first. The condition at which the water in the cell cavity has been evaporated but the cell wall is still saturated is known as the “fiber saturation point.” This point is usually assumed to be at approximately 30 percent. When the moisture content is reduced below this point, shrinkage will occur.6 Builders of heavy timber structures usually made allowances for shrinkage in the design of members and connections. The amount of shrinkage may be calculated using tables that give amounts of radial, tangential, and volumetric shrinkage from green to the oven oven-dried moisture content for various species. A moisture meter is an important tool for the structural engineer. What has been misinterpreted as deflection or settlement in historic structures may be due to the across-the-grain shrinkage of large timber girders that were installed in a green condition and subsequently dried to low moisture content. An increment borer can be used by the structural engineer to obtain core samples 0.2 of an inch in diameter, which can be used to determine the species, the number of growth rings per inch, the oven-dried weight, the moisture content, and the specific gravity of the wood sampled. Often, certain parts of a structure will indicate a moisture content that is considerably higher than the equilibrium moisture content determined by the dry bulb temperature and relative humidity. Usually, close contact of timber with moisture-containing masonry or earth will cause elevated moisture content at the bearing points of timber purlins, joists, beams, columns, or trusses. The moisture is most readily absorbed through end grain. Once the moisture content rises above 20 percent, decay will probably occur. Strength-reducing effects of decay and termite infestation commonly occur at support points. Repairing these areas of high shear is a challenge to the structural engineer involved in historic preservation. The structural engineer evaluating the heavy timber frame of a historic structure should be intimately familiar with the causes and significance of checking and the structural considerations. The structural engineer evaluating a timber structure should become familiar with the grading rules of the various species of wood that he may encounter. A familiarity with timber-grading rules and the strength reduction properties of various natural growth characteristics can be obtained from The Wood Handbook of the U.S. Forest Products Laboratory.7 Obviously, the purpose here is not to transform the engineer into a grading-rules expert, but to provide sufficient knowledge so that the engineer is comfortable in assigning a particular grade to the timber framing under consideration in order for the engineer
10
Historic Structures: The Role of the Structural Engineer
to assume reasonable design values to be used in the analysis. Certainly, in historic structures, species and density play a most significant role in determining the strength of a particular timber. Of course, the timber’s history is critical also. Wood that appears to be of a superior grade may have been subjected to overstressing, cyclic loading, elevated temperatures, or other environmental conditions. The true capacity of a historic timber is often less than one would expect based on a visual inspection. The testing of representative samples to destruction is the surest way to determine reasonable design values. Results from such tests can be used to establish appropriate design values in a simplified manner or through statistical analysis of the results. Certainly, the old-growth, dense, clear timber found in many existing structures built before World War II, in North America, should be judged on the quality of the wood and not on published design values assigned for timber cut today. In spite of the insistence of the forest products industry that today’s timber is in every way equal to previously cut old-growth timber, I have observed a consistent difference in the density of today’s timber used for construction and that of the past. FIGURE 1-3 Cutting through the floor joists at Market Hall in Charleston, South Carolina, revealed the material to be dense southern pine.
The past practice of excessively notching floor or roof joists into carrying members must be reviewed by the structural engineer using the end-notched beam formulae presented in various timber design manuals and textbooks.8
Historic Highway Bridges
11
A joist might be perfectly adequate in bending and deflection and be critical in horizontal shear at a notched support. This condition may be easily remedied by installing custom-sized nailed joist hangers to transfer vertical forces from the joist to the supporting member.
THE TIMBER TRUSS COMPUTER MODEL Slippage, rotation, shrinkage, or the lack of continuity in a timber joint is difficult to allow for in a computer analysis of a timber truss. Multiple-chord trusses will invariably appear stiffer when analyzed, even when all joints are free to rotate in the computer model. Structural engineers are aware that it is very difficult to produce a true hinge or a true fixed joint in the actual structure. Joints in timber trusses may act somewhere between the two, causing a very different distribution of forces than produced by the analysis. How does one model a half-lapped and notched joint in an indeterminate frame? What about the problem of describing the intersecting member of a multiple chord truss where half of the member section in each direction passes through a joint and all pieces nailed together with wrought iron nails?
HISTORIC HIGHWAY BRIDGES Highway bridge inspection, rehabilitation, and replacement programs have involved many structural engineers in the evaluation of older, sometimes historic, highway bridges. Many times these bridges are found deficient because of deterioration of structural elements, the increased magnitude of service loads, inadequate lane width, or a geometry or configuration of the highway or the bridge itself that makes the passage of vehicles unsafe at normal speeds. The structural engineer plays a pivotal role in the determination of possible methods to retain a historic bridge structure. Many two-lane bridges have been converted to one-lane bridges with addition of an adjacent span to carry traffic in the opposite direction. The lacing and cover plates of built-up members and the eyebolts and pinned connections of older steel truss spans provide the structural engineer with the opportunity to study design details that are uncommon today. Repairs and reinforcement can be made to deck, abutments, and superstructure. When this cannot be justified, truly historic spans may be removed from service by rerouting traffic to a replacement span. Many historic bridges have been successfully adapted for reuse for pedestrians in areas such as parks and downtown redevelopment projects.
12
Historic Structures: The Role of the Structural Engineer
DISMANTLING HISTORIC RIVETED STEEL STRUCTURES There is a method for carefully dismantling a historic riveted steel structure. Rivets may be removed by drilling a pilot hole into the center of the rivet head, reaming the head to the same diameter of the rivet shank, and chipping the head off by means of a chisel or cutting tool held in a pneumatic hammer. The remaining portion of the rivet may then be driven from the hole with a drift pin and sledgehammer. Although this method is not as fast as torch cutting and resplicing by welding, it preserves the original configuration of connections, does not require splice plates, and does not subject the steel to excessively high temperatures. Field rivets can usually be identified by their heads, which may not be as well formed as shop rivets. Field splice locations can be determined so that a structure can be dismantled in much the same way it was first erected.
FIGURE 1-4 The presence of field bolts provide an opportunity to dismantle a historic bridge in the same way it was assembled.
Reassembly in the original manner of construction is possible, with rivets, if a source for rivets, rivet heaters, and other tools can be secured and if steel workers experienced in riveted construction are available.
References
13
HISTORIC STRUCTURES PROVIDE RESEARCH OPPORTUNITIES Historic structures can provide a “laboratory” for engineering research. They provide an opportunity to evaluate the longevity of materials and the result of various construction practices. The causes of masonry deterioration and timber decay can be observed. The causes and consequences of masonry cracks can be determined. Failure modes of various materials may be observed, as well as the effects of moisture penetration and thermal movement. Creep deformations in materials such as timber or concrete can be studied, as well as other time-related properties such as fatigue strength. Someday, we may understand better the effects of load duration because of historic structures research. This research will provide useful information to designers of contemporary buildings.
CONCLUSION As the movement towards the preservation, restoration, rehabilitation, and adaptive reuse of historic structures expands, structural engineers will find themselves playing an ever-increasing role. To be successful, they must apply their engineering knowledge and skill in a sensitive manner providing a safe environment while preserving the significant historic, architectural, and cultural value of historic structures and places.
REFERENCES 1. U.S. Department of the Interior, The Secretary of the Interior’s Standards for Rehabilitation and Guidelines for Rehabilitating Historic Buildings (Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Office, 1979). 2. The North Carolina Building Code Council and the North Carolina Department of Insurance, North Carolina State Building Code, vol. I (Raleigh: The North Carolina Department of Insurance, 2006). 3. Concrete Reinforcing Steel Institute, Engineering Date Report, no.11, “Evaluation of Reinforcing Steel in Old Concrete Structures,” (Chicago: Concrete Reinforcing Steel Institute: 1981). 4. Harley J. McKee, F. A. I. A., Introduction to Early American Masonry: Stone, Brick, Mortar and Plaster, National Trust for Historic Preservation and Columbia University, Washington Preservation Press, 1973.
14
Historic Structures: The Role of the Structural Engineer
5. Brick Institute of America, Technical Notes on Brick Construction, No. 39A (City: Publisher: 1975). 6. American Institute of Timber Construction, Timber Construction Manual 2nd ed. (New York: John Wiley and Sons, Inc.: 1974). 7. U.S. Department of Agriculture, Forest Service. Forest Products Laboratory, Handbook, no. 72, Wood Handbook (Washington, DC: U.S. Government Printing Office, 1974). 8. National Forest Products Association, National Design Specification for Wood Construction (Washington D.C.: National Forest Products Association: 1977).
CHAPTER
2
Preservation and Public Safety: Structural Safety of Historic Timber Structures
eeting the requirements of the building code is not the same as assuring the public of a safe structure. Structural engineers have the training and experience to make the necessary judgments needed to keep a historic structure in service when parameters appear to fall short of minimum code requirements.
M
TIMBER MISUNDERSTOOD Timber is the primary structural component for most historic structures in the United States and Canada. Although the structures might also include brick and stone masonry, iron, steel, or concrete, timber is often the most misunderstood construction material of all. Part of the misunderstanding lies in our educational system. Many structural engineers earn degrees in structural engineering without ever taking a course in timber design. It is unfortunate that in North America, with our tremendous stock of timber-framed buildings and our strong forest products industry, more structural engineering curricula do not include at least introductory courses in timber design.
Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
15
16
Preservation and Public Safety: Structural Safety of Historic Timber Structures
In today’s residential market, timber is primarily of importance as dimension lumber. Most timber production consists of dimension framing, prefabricated trusses, stress-rated panels, and other components. The size of residential framing members is dictated by building codes for various spans and conditions. Manufacturers provide the design for prefabricated components such as wood trusses and joist substitutes. As a result, the glued laminated timber industry is one of the few areas where structural engineers are practicing the design of heavy timber structures on a daily basis.
PRESERVATION PHILOSOPHY It is hoped that by learning more about timber design, structural engineers will develop a preservation philosophy that demands rigorous analysis in order to justify “doing nothing” to a historic timber structure that has been performing satisfactorily for many years. Buildings that analysis (and observation) clearly indicate are unsafe would be reinforced in the most sensitive manner in an attempt to retain as much historic fabric as possible. Buildings that require extensive modification or reconstruction would be restored in a way that is in keeping with the original construction if possible, while fulfilling safety requirements. Often, engineers are asked to evaluate framing members to determine the capacity of an existing floor structure in a historic structure. This review process differs considerably from design.
STRUCTURAL REVIEW Members in the horizontal plane—such as floor sheathing, joists, purlins, and beams—are stressed principally in bending. The resisting bending moment is a measure of the strength of such an element. This measure, stiffness, and horizontal shear make up the three qualities that are normally checked during the process of selection that we call design. Because timber is available in certain standard lumber sizes, the designer selects from the available sizes, grades, and species those that most economically meet the predetermined standards for bending stress, deflection, and horizontal shear. When the engineer reviews the capacity of an existing member, many parameters complicate the process of selecting appropriate lumber. Size, span, and spacing of members are dictated by the structure. It is the engineer’s task to determine the size, orientation, species, grade, and end condition of all of the structural elements in a building that already exists. Between the factors of limited availability of types of lumber,
Load Duration and Historic Structures
17
economic considerations, existing standards, and the structure of the building itself, freedom of choice is eliminated.
ENGINEERING JUDGMENT Often, the structural engineer must pass judgment on a structure that has endured far beyond what we consider to be a normal period of service. The timbers of such a structure were not selected on the basis of modern engineering analysis. They certainly do not bear inspection marks attesting to their grade and species. It should be obvious to the engineer that a safe floor structure should not fail in bending due to the actual loads imposed. But it is important to recognize that excessive deflection, excessive vibration, or a lack of stiffness, should not automatically categorize a floor structure as “unsafe”. Strict deflection limitations should be set for floors that support plaster ceilings in lieu of wood or tin ceilings, or no ceilings at all. But for comfort, the deflection limitation set in most building codes for floors, no matter what the ceiling, is 1/360th of the span. It must be said that overstressed structural members may also be perfectly safe. It is important for the engineer to evaluate the basis for his conclusion regarding the safety of the structure. When making such an evaluation, the loads assumed for design should be reconciled with the actual loads that will occur in service. The design values that we assume are critical to the computed capacity of some floor systems include factors of safety of 2.5 to 3.0. For structures such as mill buildings, average design values yield results that fall well above the minimum code requirements for adaptive reuse occupancy, such as residential, office, or retail. The actual distribution of loads in a structure, similar to live load reduction factors for tributary area, can account for the continued service for heavily loaded members such as stair and fireplace headers, and summer beams that may appear to the engineer to be grossly undersized. Many times, these members deflect more than is desirable for comfort.
LOAD DURATION AND HISTORIC STRUCTURES The concept of load factor design is currently making its way into the field of timber design. This concept is most appropriate for application to timber design because of the long history of the concept of live load duration. Early timber research found that timber reacts quite well to short applications of
18
Preservation and Public Safety: Structural Safety of Historic Timber Structures
load. The duration of load was found to be as critical as the magnitude of the load. Presumably, this sensitivity to the duration of load is a result of the natural composition of timber, which consists of a tightly bound bundle of cells that tend to stretch or elongate with time. The larger and more constant the load, the more stretching of fibers occurs. The effects of this creep can be seen in many timber structures through excessive deflection. For short durations of load, allowable design values are increased substantially. Research into this time-versus-stress relationship is of paramount importance. Only through evaluating historic timber structures can we solve this puzzle, which is complicated by cyclic loading, original moisture content, member size, span, species, grade, temperature, humidity, and magnitude of stress.
REPLACEMENT-IN-KIND Often, replacement-in-kind is not economically feasible. More advances are being made in the field of timber design than in any other area of structural engineering. Recent products include laminated veneer lumber and numerous other beam and joist substitutes. The most important benefits of these reconstituted wood products is the availability of long lengths, higher design values, and greater stiffness. Preservationists and preservation engineers must determine the appropriateness of these materials to each case.
CASE HISTORIES Presented here are several projects that required us to determine the load capacity or safety of an existing floor structure. The Montague Building is discussed further in Chapter 6.
Chowan County Courthouse In a 1988 structural evaluation report, we concluded that the large second floor assembly hall of the Chowan County Courthouse in Edenton, North Carolina (c.1767), could be used for public occupancy if the area would be posted to limit the number of people to 200. A deflection limitation of 1/360th of a span governed the design, producing a bending stress as high as 2,292 psi in large, dense southern pine timber floor joists and beams.
Walker Building Sometime later, we reviewed the floor structure of the 1917 Walker Building at the State Hospital in Concord, New Hampshire. Assuming a reasonable set of
Conclusion
19
design values equivalent to No. 1D SR southern pine, based on examination of a wood sample obtained from the building, and a visual inspection of the framing, we concluded that the existing 7½ ⫻ 11 timber beams were adequate to support a live load of 86 psf. This is well within the 50 psf required for office occupancy with fixed partitions. The live load deflection limitation of 1/360th of the span controlled the design. Of course, we concluded that this was a safe structure that met minimum code requirements. The calculations were based on reasonable assumptions of design values.
Montague Building In 1985, at my direction, six floor joists from the 1903 Montague Building in Raleigh, North Carolina, were tested to destruction. Of the five joists tested (of six joists selected; one was found not suitable for testing), the average bending stress at rupture was in excess of 5,000 psi. The average modulus of elasticity was 1,295,000 psi. These measures of strength and stiffness were used to evaluate the capacity of the floor structure. To meet tenant loads for possible retail occupancy in this speculative office building, I recommended that all of the existing floor joists be reinforced. (The Montague Building is also discussed in Chapter 6).
Moorfields At Moorfields, a 1792 house in Hillsborough, North Carolina, the excessive deflection of a summer beam was evaluated by measuring offsets in the floor surface above the beam. Based on field measurements and computer analysis, I was convinced that the summer beam had failed. Indeed, when exposed to view during construction by removing the ceiling plaster, the summer beam contained a severe fracture consistent with a typical bending failure. The only replacement beam available of sufficient stiffness and strength that would fit between in the space between the floor sheathing and the ceiling was a steel tube section approximately equal to the original timber beam in size.
CONCLUSION Only through specialized knowledge and experience can structural engineers make the necessary judgments needed to properly evaluate historic timber structures. The engineer must be convinced that the structural model in the computer is an accurate representation of actual conditions. Once that is clear, the application of rigorous analysis, testing, and engineering judgment may be necessary to explain why the historic timber structure in question has performed adequately for many years.
CHAPTER
3
Simplified Engineering*
INTRODUCTION he field of structural engineering has grown more complex as we begin the twenty-first century. The profession of structural engineering evolved from principles first developed in the 1840s by American pioneers such as Squire Whipple (1804–1888) and Herman Haupt (1817–1905). These men were among the first to publish engineering pamphlets and textbooks based on rational mathematical or graphical analysis of simple structures. At that time, the unparalleled growth of the railroads required that reliable methods of analysis be invented for bridge construction. In the last few years, events and certain attitudes have combined to produce a highly complicated world for practicing engineers. Methods of analysis have grown more complex. For many years, the fundamental principles necessary for the design of simple structures did not change. Now, advances in computer technology, applications, and usage, stronger materials, composite and orthotropic materials, and plastic or load [resistance] factor design applications have changed the ways buildings and bridges are designed. Other requirements, such as continuing education, peer review, and changes in registration laws are thrust upon the engineer in an effort to obtain more accountability.
T
* This paper was originally written for the Fall 1995 Lecture Series, Sponsored by The Structural Group Boston Society of Civil Engineers, Section American Society of Civil Engineers. Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
21
22
Simplified Engineering
In order to be more productive and efficient in the areas that we can control, engineers might consider the concept of simplified engineering.
WHAT IS SIMPLIFIED ENGINEERING? Simplified engineering is a method of reducing the complexity of a problem by exercising the engineering judgment of an experienced designer in order to eliminate unnecessary procedures and methods not essential to arriving at a solution. When pressed, designers are tempted to take shortcuts in order to produce an acceptable set of plans and specifications in the shortest length of time. In recent years, consulting structural engineers have, during the design process, received fewer dimensions, details, wall sections, and building sections produced by architects. The consulting structural engineers are filling in some of the gaps, because we have no choice but to describe the complete structure. There are few shortcuts to producing a complete set of structural design documents. As a result, many engineers are practicing simplified engineering. Many in the engineering profession look toward the medical and legal professions as a gauge of our success. Unfortunately, engineers are rapidly losing ground in the one area that offers a quantitative comparison: monetary compensation. Unlike medical and legal fees, which are cumulative, engineering fees are usually based on fixed financial considerations and represent a slice of a pie. In most instances, owners, developers, financial institutions or architects decide what size the pie will be and how it will be divided among the consultants. In certain projects, the slice for the structural designer becomes even thinner when complexity dictates that additional consultants be added. A project may have building code, seismic, geotechnical, acoustical, lighting, roofing, landscape, waterproofing, theater, natatorium, security, curtain wall, sprinkler, and other specialty consultants. Not only can the limits of responsibility become ambiguous, but also, coordination between the various specialties is often difficult or nonexistent. For most ordinary buildings, analysis is a very small part of the effort. The production of a fully coordinated set of plans and specifications employs most of our time. Often, a project is drawn first, and then engineered. At a time of rising expectations and diminishing returns, engineers need methods of expediting their work without reducing quality. By rapidly advancing the production of plans and specifications through the initial stages of design, simplified engineering may be one method of reaching the goal of producing a design that
What is Simplified Engineering?
23
meets all of the requirements of the project. This can be a shortcut to a solution based on sound engineering judgment, resulting in the appropriate effort applied to various tasks. Simplified engineering becomes a critical issue when it is practiced as a response to unwieldy or difficult computer software. To use most structural software, the designer requires a block of uninterrupted time. If this time is not available, the designer may abandon the software in favor of a less accurate hand calculation. In some cases simplification may actually yield more accurate final results. For example, a plane frame analysis of a three-dimensional steeple structure may afford the engineer an opportunity to “get the feel” of the structure when compared to a three-dimensional analysis with its complicated coordinate system, which results in reams of pages of output. The cost of increased accuracy in engineering calculations is a decreased sense and understanding, or feel for the numbers—particularly, the results. It is reasonable to expect that the design engineer will have a sense of an expected range of results prior to performing the calculations. The computer industry lags far behind in the production of efficient userfriendly software for structural engineers. Although great advances have been made in the development of faster general plane frame analysis programs with more capacity, design programs for individual beam and column members are often unwieldy. For example, some Composite Steel Beam Design programs require two pages of printout for each beam analyzed. Traditionally, structural engineers have “batched” tasks, analyzing all columns at one time, or all similarly loaded beams together. One 8½ ⫻ 11 sheet of printout should be sufficient to display the output for 12 to 24 beams or columns. Anton Tedesko pointed out in a recent issue of Civil Engineering magazine that computers have not “diminished the value of back-of-an-envelope calculations.”6 Computer analyses are of great help when used in the proper context, when modeling of the structure is correct, when the actual boundary conditions are taken into account and the output is examined and interpreted by an experienced engineer. It is a misconception, however, that sophisticated computer analyses through greater accuracy will lead to better designs. The quality of a design is not a function of the exactness of the calculations, and it is not necessary to strive for great accuracy in a numerical analysis when the accuracy of the assumption is not known. Many of the calculations made today are not necessary. Sometimes calculations are produced because the analyst is fascinated with the program or is taken in by the sheer beauty of the analysis. At other times, someone wants to show how many pages of calculations have been produced; sometimes this is done to impress a client.
24
Simplified Engineering
A complicated analysis performed on a computer may not necessarily be an accurate model of the structure to be designed. The engineer must use judgment to decide what elements should be removed from the overall structure in order to simplify the problem. Computer analysis allows the designer to search for various solutions in a matter of seconds. Boundary conditions such as springs can be tried. The computer allows us to achieve a very reasonable model in a short period of time. Our best designs may still be simplified versions of parts of a structure with added opportunities to input nonprismatic sections and sophisticated boundary conditions. Antonio M. Garcia, P.E., described this state of affairs in an August 1993 issue of Civil Engineering magazine: With available structural design software, we can represent any structure on a screen, apply any load in any direction, and receive output on stresses at any or all nodes. We can also pictorially represent the deflected structure or, by use of color variations, picture the intensities of tensile and compressive stresses. In essence, much of what used to be intuition or “feel” based on experience has been replaced by highly sophisticated software and extremely fast hardware: Anyone with funds and little experience can achieve what once took years of training. The fallacy lies in believing that reams of output providing every bit of incredibly accurate information are enough to solve the problem. Experience cannot be purchased; it must be acquired. The fact that an answer is achieved does not necessarily mean that it is the right answer. No matter how sophisticated the computer, the engineer needs to understand the materials and construction methods used. The finished plans represent the designer’s intentions, and they must be realistic.1
The computer, used by an experienced designer, becomes a powerful tool. Carelessly used, it can result in a dangerous sense of well being and satisfaction in a design that may have serious shortcomings. As the computer reduces calculation time, it also reduces the time spent on a project, thereby reducing the time we spend thinking about the project with all of its intricacies and details. We thus lose the time spent “sleeping on it” that can give us a clearer picture of a project and its idiosyncrasies.
HOW CAN SIMPLIFIED ENGINEERING BE PRACTICED? Simplified engineering is practiced every day on thousands of projects when we choose what to analyze and how to approach the analysis. The more experienced an engineer is, the greater the latitude should be.
When is Simplified Engineering a Valid Method?
25
Engineers have simplified their work for many years through the use of handbooks. Often the use of handbooks requires the engineer to interpolate between tabulated values. In many cases a code mandated requirement will govern the design. For example, in concrete, #4 reinforcing steel spaced 12 inches on center may be the minimum reinforcing recommended by the American Concrete Institute for a specific application. A designer might make the minimum steel beam size a W10x14 to allow sufficient depth for clip angle connections with space for a minimum of two rows of bolts. The Underwriters Laboratory might require a minimum composite beam size of W8x28 to obtain a certain fire resistance rating. With minimum requirements in place, the design effort is simplified by omitting the design of elements, which, by inspection, exceed the minimum requirements for stiffness and strength. The Hyatt-Regency walkway collapse in Kansas City and recent economic forces have changed the way structural engineers work. Previously, the engineer of record had more back-up. Steel companies were then staffed with complete engineering departments. The steel company’s engineers would review a project prior to bidding and construction, adding their input to the estimating and detailing efforts. Now, with steel companies employing minimal engineering staffs consisting of contract drafters located at remote sites, the engineer of record does not benefit from “another pair of eyes” looking at a project. The profession and the steel industry have redefined the roles of the various parties. From connection design to “standard details,” the steel fabricator assumes no responsibility. Many fabricators do not check shop drawings prior to submittal, thus shifting more of the burden onto the structural designer of record.
WHEN IS SIMPLIFIED ENGINEERING A VALID METHOD? Simplified engineering is a valid method to use when the result produces an adequate design. If the engineer is responsible when designing, there is not a problem with this method as it has been used traditionally. Our natural tendency has been to simplify everything into a model that is complex enough to accurately describe the structure to be designed, yet is simple enough to be analyzed. For example, truss analysis for many years assumed members to be prismatic sections with pinned joints. This facilitated analysis by such means as the method of joints. Now that we can create more complex models by computer, introducing some rigidity at joints and continuity in individual pieces, are we irresponsible when we abandon the computer and do a quick hand calculation?
26
Simplified Engineering
WHO CAN PRACTICE SIMPLIFIED ENGINEERING? Any engineer can practice some form of simplified engineering. Even the newest EIT (Engineer-in-training) can be faced with a problem, for which his education did not prepare him, the first day on the job. Ideally, he would be working under the direct supervision of a more experienced engineer who would guide him toward a simplified approach. The more experience an engineer has, the more ability the engineer would obviously have for simplifying calculations based on knowledge of the subject and feel for the numbers and expected outcome.
ADVANTAGES, DISADVANTAGES AND POTENTIAL PROBLEMS Percival White wrote the following in the July 1920 issue of The Atlantic Monthly: Efficiency is fondly regarded in the American mind as the greatest contribution of this age to civilization. It is deemed an agency for good, a thing one cannot have too much of. Efficiency is a lightning calculator, by which you may convert time into anything you like, and read the answer in percentages, to the third decimal place. By its means, for example, you may change minutes into dollars, which is, after all, the thing most of us are trying to do. Yet there is danger in these glib conversions. Money is a tangible thing. The more you save, the more you have. But time is far more subtle stuff. Saving it does not imply having it. As soon as a man seriously starts saving time, make up your mind that he will no longer have a moment to spare.2
The greatest advantage of simplified engineering is the time it saves. The greatest disadvantage is that the solution may not be accurate. Potential problems may arise when drawings or calculations are reviewed at a later date. Simplified engineering may cause great difficulty to a peer reviewer unable to follow the thinking of the engineer of record or not in agreement with the methodology. Certainly, if the design has to be defended because of an observed problem in the field during construction or after completion, simplified engineering can result in lawsuits on the basis of negligence. Simplified engineering, practiced as a response to outside pressure such as fee or time constraints, does a great disservice to the project. Most clients are concerned with schedule. However, quality is infrequently discussed. It is assumed that any structural engineer will produce basically the same design.
Historical Perspective: Rules of Thumb Versus Analysis
27
Does the client care whether the columns in a building frame are to be designed by computer considering bi-axial bending due to possible eccentricity, or merely selected from a handbook? Discussion of simplified engineering with owners, clients, and non-engineering professionals is risky. The decision of whether to simplify a portion of the analysis should be left to the engineer of record. Discussion with nonengineering professionals of simplified engineering may lead them to think that engineering design is simple or that it can be simplified. The client’s natural conclusion would be that they should expect a quick turnaround for a reduced fee.
HISTORICAL PERSPECTIVE: RULES OF THUMB VERSUS ANALYSIS In American structural engineering, analysis as we know it today grew out of the work of many engineers practicing in the first half of the nineteenth century. They attempted to determine accurate methods of analysis to solve problems that had previously been solved using rules of thumb. Rigorous mathematical methods of analyzing the forces and stresses in framed structures, such as bridges, were unknown until the 1840s. Structural engineers Squire Whipple and Herman Haupt independently developed mathematical truss design methods. In 1842, Haupt produced a small pamphlet, Hints on Bridge Construction by an Engineer. Whipple is credited with developing the scientific basis of bridge design in the United States with his 1847 publication, “A Work on Bridge Building.” In 1851, Haupt produced his major work, General Theory of Bridge Construction. Earlier bridge builders such as Timothy Palmer, Theodore Burr, Lewis Wernwag, and Ithiel Town very likely used various methods to determine stresses and strains. It is not now known whether their methods of proportioning members were based on mathematics or rules of thumb. However, in 1820, Town advertised his patent for the plank lattice truss by inviting potential investors to “examine the model and the mathematics.”
Code of Design Often, mandated code requirements force engineers to design beyond the limits of good engineering judgment. For example, it may be obvious to the designer that certain loading conditions will not be necessary because of the configuration, construction type, location, or occupancy of a building. We have seen wind-, snow-, and seismic-mandated code requirements increase in complexity in recent years. Wind load factors, snowdrift coefficients,
28
Simplified Engineering
and seismic analysis methods have greatly increased the complexity of structural design for the typical building. Supposedly, complicated and unwieldy loading conditions are a result of more accurate scientific or engineering research. But, at the same time, the coefficients provided in the current building codes often result in less snow, wind, or seismic force being applied to a structure compared to what the previous codes would have required. Most practicing engineers, if given the choice, would opt for the simpler series of loads, knowing full well that they might be conservative. From a structural engineer’s standpoint, there should be provisions in the code for alternate simple load provisions for wind, snow, and seismic design at this time when fees for architectural and engineering services are shrinking, and the expectations of our clients are rising. It is debatable whether the design community is designing safer structures today because of the complicated snowdrift, wind loads, and seismic requirements than we did with the earlier codes.
Timber Design Although wood is a very complicated building material, for 150 years it has been simple to design. The 1991 National Design Specification for Wood Construction (NDS) changed what was for many years a simple column formula into a more complex mathematical expression—an example of increased complexity in timber design. The previous design procedure shown in the 1985 edition of the Timber Construction Manual and earlier editions of the NDS was recently revised to include a column-stability factor based on a procedure proposed by A. Yline in 1956. This method permits estimation of the buckling stress and the required cross-sectional area for concentrically applied loads on straight columns in the elastic and inelastic ranges. The column stability factor is a complicated equation. Bruce Pooley, director of technical services for the American Institute of Timber Construction, admits, “Calculating Cp is lengthy when done by hand, but quickly computed with a programmable calculator, a computer spreadsheet, or any one of a number of software programs developed for wood design.” He indicated that the new design method was “equation based,” meaning that it was assumed that practicing engineers would program the equation into their computers, thus reducing the pain of dealing with such a complicated set of mathematical expressions.7
Load Resistance Factor Design For many applications, load factor design seems to be a design methodology that overly complicates the design process for the average engineer. Some proponents
Historical Perspective: Rules of Thumb Versus Analysis
29
believe that now that we have computers, it does not matter how complicated the math is. Programs are viewed as a black box, a sort of mixing bowl, where the ingredients are placed without regard to the internal process but with complete confidence in the results. To the practicing engineer, LRFD is an unwieldy method of design promoted by the academic community and various large engineering firms. Allowable stress design gives the designer “real” numbers for use in a simple world where the design is either “OK” or “no good.” Working stress design is simple and commonly understood. Stress is proportional to strain below the elastic limit. Why would an engineer want to delve into that domain above which elastic materials begin to yield? Ultimate strength design, which originated for concrete in the 1956 and 1963 American Concrete Institute specifications, required nearly a quarter of a century to replace working stress design.
Vibratory Analysis Several years ago, the issue of floor vibration was considered by the North Carolina State Building Code Council for incorporation into the building code. This came at a time when the expectations of consumers were rising. In North Carolina, complaints regarding excessive floor vibration in residential structures caused the Structural Committee of the Building Code Council in 1991 to consider making vibratory analysis part of the building code at roughly the same time that the CABO code was being adopted. At the time, some argued that the Building Code Committee should not recommend that a vibratory analysis, by a professional engineer, be a required part of the code because the vibratory response of a floor is independent of its structural capacity. The vibratory response of a floor is difficult to quantify, and requiring a vibratory analysis in the building code would lead to increased litigation for real or imagined problems that are not a measure of safety. A suggestion was made to simplify the problem by placing in the code minimum depth-to-span recommendations that have been shown to minimize vibratory problems. That advice was not implemented, and code mandated vibratory analysis was avoided for the time being.
Seismic Design In light of the earthquakes in Northridge, California, and Kobe, Japan, engineering researchers are rethinking the current approach to seismic design. Research undertaken at the present time will result in almost immediate changes in the building codes. Seismic design is a market to exploit. Grant monies for studies and research is flowing from Washington in response to
30
Simplified Engineering
major earthquake activity. Large design firms armed with grants can target areas of the country susceptible to seismic activity and market their specialized expertise, filling a void the local consultants may have discounted. Seismic damage makes great television press. Municipal, hospital, school, and other administrators cannot ignore the risks associated with a major earthquake. The more complicated the analysis needs to be, the more important it is to hire specialists to design seismic resistant foundations and buildings, and to determine how to modify the underlying soils or isolate the foundations of existing buildings. Will the academic community and code officials recommend simple methods of analysis that can be applied easily to new and existing buildings in order to reduce the risk of damage during a seismic event? Probably not. Several questions should be asked before we adopt complicated or excessive seismic requirements into our building codes. First, what is the risk of injury, death, or property damage in the United States due to a seismic event? Second, how much will seismic provisions add to the cost of rehabilitating or adding to existing structures? Third, how much will a seismic analysis add to the cost of engineering and architectural fees for new or existing structures? Fourth, how many clients will be willing to pay extra for a seismic analysis? History since 1750 indicates that in most of the United States, the risk of death or property damage from a seismic event is extremely small. There are many reasons for the low seismic mortality rate. Population density, construction methods and materials, geotechnical conditions, and climate are some of the factors that affect the number of deaths that may occur as a result of a seismic event. North American building codes and zoning ordinances limit population density in our cities. Cultural factors tend to limit the number of children living in single-family dwellings in North America. Construction methods in North America tend to limit the risk of earthquake-related deaths. One of the methods worth mentioning involves the use of mortar and unit masonry, which is far superior to the unit masonry used in many less-developed countries today or in any country in the past. Joint reinforcing is included in most commercial masonry walls built in North America. Many residential buildings in North America are framed with dimensional lumber, which is light and strong. Except in certain regions, North American builders tend to not roof buildings with heavy concrete or clay tile products. Buildings constructed in North America today are required by building codes to bear on properly proportioned footings resting on an adequate subgrade. In many overpopulated parts of the world, housing is constructed on steep slopes or filled in land not suited for agriculture or other activities. In American cities, such as Charleston, Boston, and San Francisco, which are underlaid with soft clays, pile, or caisson foundations are typically provided for large buildings.
Historical Perspective: Rules of Thumb Versus Analysis
31
All of the existing buildings in North America are new when compared to many of the buildings found in other parts of the world. But the most important single factor pertaining to absence of property damaged or deaths during past seismic events is the absence of large seismic events. The East Coast has, no doubt, experienced many earthquakes, although the Appalachian mountain chain is one of the oldest, seismically inert ranges in the world. Records dating from 1750 indicate that although 2,750,000 people have died as a result of earthquakes worldwide, the record in the United States is very good and most states have not yet recorded a fatality.
Table 3-1 Major Earthquakes in the United States Since 1750
State
# of major earthquakes
Largest number of deaths in one event
Alaska
4
131
March 27, 1962
10
667
April 18, 1906
1049
Idaho
1
2
Oct. 28, 1983
2
Hawaii
2
173
April 01, 1946
234
California
Date
Total # of deaths 134
Massachusetts
1
0
Nov. 18, 1755
0
Missouri
3
10
Dec. 16, 1811
10
Montana
3
2
Oct. 11, 1936
30
Nevada
3
0
Dec. 16, 1954
0
Oregon
2
2
South Carolina
1
83
Dec. 4, 1993
Texas
1
0
August 16, 1931
0
Utah
1
0
March 12, 1934
0
Total
32
Aug. 31, 1886
2 83
1544
The total number of deaths from earthquakes since 1750 in the United States is 1544. The earthquake-related deaths in Hawaii were the result of tidal waves. The 1886 earthquake in Charleston, South Carolina, is the only major earthquake to be located on the East Coast. The deep layer of marl beneath Charleston is one reason for the heavy damage. St. Philip’s and St. Michael’s Churches in Charleston, South Carolina, were both badly damaged. Although the heavy steeples of both churches settled almost a foot, both buildings were repaired and have continued in service since 1886. Similarly, they were repaired after tornadoes and hurricanes such as Hugo in 1989. In the Winter 1990 issue
32
Simplified Engineering
of Wood Design Focus, Ario Ceccotti presented an earthquake performance challenge to researchers, code writers, and designers: It is evident that thorough knowledge and planned balance of the positive and negative aspects will yield a proper design that guarantees structural safety at a reasonable cost. Researchers have the challenge of quantifying the factors that yield ductile behavior and energy dissipation in the structure. They can determine how to design and detail connections that lead to ductile systems, rather than brittle failures. Code writers have the challenge of combining the often-disparate results of research. They must present a few relatively simple and conservative design rules, which are easy to apply, for the most common structural forms (those with known ductility and dissipation levels). Yet, for less common structures, for which experience has demonstrated good structural performance, code writers must provide simple rules or guidelines based on the engineering judgment. Designers have the challenge of finding the best solution among the various ductility classes, creating the most convenient design from technical and economical points of view.3
The application of complicated seismic requirements, which are subject to wide interpretation, will only cause the demolition of many existing buildings. For example, to accurately determine the seismic resistance of an existing building, the unit weight and shear capacity of the existing masonry must be known. This requires expensive testing in the field to obtain design values to be used in the analysis, which owners are often not willing to pay for. Proposed seismic provisions for building additions will affect the historic preservation and the renovation and rehabilitation segments of the construction industry. Many owners faced with rehabilitating or adding to an older or historic structure will elect to demolish when faced with engineering fees for evaluation, or potentially unknown construction costs, required to bring a building into conformance with seismic provisions. For example, to construct a structurally independent stair and elevator tower addition is a difficult and expensive task. Usually, part of the new elevator lobby is supported by the existing structure at each floor level. Upcoming changes to the seismic provisions of the building code should exempt existing one-story buildings with wood framing or unit masonry loadbearing walls from the seismic provisions of the code and all other buildings in the Seismic Hazard Exposure Group I category. However, structures with precast concrete structural systems or unusually heavy roof systems should be included in a special hazard category. Certain elements such as architectural
Historical Perspective: Rules of Thumb Versus Analysis
33
stone cladding, large chimneys, and masonry parapets above a certain height should be subject to seismic review in all cases. Based on the limited risk of a seismic event in most of the United States, it is in the best interest of the public, the construction industry, and architectural and engineering professions, to limit the complexity of the seismic code and its application to existing buildings. When California and Hawaii are excluded, we have suffered a total of 261 deaths from earthquakes in 245 years. More structural engineers in the United States will die from heart attacks due to stress—caused, in part, by an effort to implement a complicated seismic code—than all of the earthquake victims combined.
Code versus Creativity In the movie Brazil, Robert De Niro’s character, Harry Tuttle, is a heating engineer illegally providing mechanical repairs outside the government’s inept Central Services branch. When Sam Lowery questions why he chose to work outside the system, Harry Tuttle replies that he “couldn’t stand the paperwork . . . you can’t make a move without a form.” “Get in, get out, travel light . . . a man alone . . . ” is his philosophy as he provides much-needed emergency repair services, which are considered by the government to be sabotage. As we dictate methodologies in our building codes in an effort to ensure uniformity in approach, do we stifle creativity? Do we remove humanity from the design process as mandated design is implemented? Are mandated design methods an attempt by some in the design community to ensure that designers conform to a certain analysis-based ideal? In the future, will we have to depend on the Harry Tuttles, working outside of the system, to keep the system running?
Legal Implications The greatest legal implication of using simplified engineering methods is the potential needed to defend our designs should they be challenged for whatever reason. Unfortunately, modern-day structural engineering is so complex that it is very easy for a sharp attorney armed with the testimony of expert witnesses to prove negligence.
Engineering Judgment: Engineer of Record The engineer of record should have some leeway with regard to analysis methods used for a particular problem. At this time, we in the design professions are faced with the rising expectations of our clients, as well as a reluctance on their part to pay for professional engineering services. Schedules are often
34
Simplified Engineering
compressed, leaving the designers very little time to produce documents, let alone time to cogitate and coordinate. The engineer of record has the ultimate responsibility for the design. Sufficient time must be provided in the schedule for a thorough final check and review of all the documents prior to bidding.
Third-Party Review Simplified engineering can result in real problems in a project with third-party review if the reviewer does not understand the methodology or does not agree that the simplified model is sufficiently accurate to produce a correct result. Simplified engineering can be a valuable tool for checking or verifying a design by others.
EXAMPLES OF SIMPLIFIED ENGINEERING: BUILDINGS Residential structures constructed in the United States today are an example of simplified engineering. The great majority of residential structures are not engineered, but built to minimum code standards that are based on standard tables developed for timber and masonry elements. The standard tables are often the results of empirical data derived from observing the behavior of structures over time. As a result of Hurricane Andrew, we have complicated our codes with various wind-load factors and unrealistic loading conditions in order to prevent future damage from a similar storm as if a deficiency in the code were the problem. Studies have shown that the code in South Florida was more than adequate, if followed, to produce buildings constructed well enough to resist wind forces generated by Hurricane Andrew. The obvious deficiency was in the execution of the design by the building contractors. Endwalls of gable-roofed buildings were pushed in by high wind forces because of the absence of endwall bracing required by code. Roof trusses lacked sufficient tiedowns in spite of code requirements. In many damaged buildings, plywood sheathing was insufficiently attached and blocked to resist uplift and shear forces due to wind. The conclusion of the 1992 American Plywood Association report, no. T92-21, is not that we need to change the design requirements, but that a more thorough inspection is required during the construction phase to ensure that fasteners are installed as specified: Within a week after Hurricane Andrew battered the southern Florida region on August 24, 1992, American Plywood Association technical and field promotion staff visited the region to inspect damaged and evaluate structural performance of residential and low-rise commercial structures.
Bridges
35
The inspections were conducted in conjunction with inspections carried out under the auspices of a Damage Assessment Team, coordinated and arranged by the Florida Concrete and Concrete Products Association and endorsed by the state of Florida, Department of Community Affairs. The 45-member team consisted of structural engineers, government and university scientists, building code officials and technical representative of the building construction industry. Conventionally built residential structures constructed with wood systems performed satisfactorily when the structures were built to meet building code provisions. Residential structures constructed with masonry block walls also performed well, in general. Failures involving plywood or oriented strand board (OSB) roof sheathing or wood-framed roof or wall systems could be traced to improper or inadequate fastenings of connections to other components. Although extensive use of steel tension straps connecting roof-wall-floor framing was observed, the structural advantages offered by such connectors could not overcome deficiencies caused by omission of other code-required connections between building components.4
When, as a consulting structural engineer, have you walked a deck prior to roofing, to count the number of fasteners and verify their correct attachment to the structural system below? To reduce wind damage during a meteorological event, all buildings should be given a structural review to verify that the correct fasteners were properly installed in sufficient quantity. Is this task the responsibility of the building official, an independent consultant, the contractor, or the designer of record? It is obvious that code-mandated inspections that complicate the design or construction process for the engineer of record will not solve the problem. It is unlikely that fees for structural engineers will increase to cover additional code mandated assurances placed on the designer. An example of simplified engineering with which few would argue is the analysis of an unequal-sided suspended two-way flat concrete slab by assuming a square or rectangular shape with roughly the same proportions as the polygon. By setting a minimum thickness to ensure deflection control and obtaining reinforcing steel size and spacing to resist the bending forces, an adequate slab can be designed. At no time would the exact long-term deflection or exact maximum bending moment at any location be calculated. A serviceable design can thus be obtained without performing a sophisticated analysis.
BRIDGES Bridges are built using simplified engineering when components such as prestressed, precast concrete are selected from tables for short standard spans.
36
Simplified Engineering
Of course, the tables are produced by the most rigorous analysis methods. This type of simplified engineering is often used at the Type Study Phase of bridge design as a tool for comparison of structure types and costs. Simplified engineering, however, is not likely to be used in the final design phase of a bridge. The standard code for bridges published by the American Association of State Highway and Transportation Officials (AASHO) has, like the building codes, increased in complexity. One example of the increased complexity can be found in the change of the distribution factor for wheel loadings on interior bridge girders. The spacing factor of S/11 will soon be changed to a much more complex expression. Fortunately for the designer, computer programs can be used for the calculation. However, the “feel” for the number becomes lost, if not nonexistent.
DESIGN PHILOSOPHY: DESIGN OF STRUCTURES As present-day designers, we often are so immersed in our day-to-day operations that we seldom have the opportunity to formulate a rigorous design philosophy. We know how to perform our services, but do not always think much about the process. If asked, most of us would describe the methods we use in order to illustrate our philosophy. Most of us design structures from the top to the bottom for vertical loads first. Then, after the horizontal and vertical members are selected, we determine which system to use to resist lateral forces. Although most engineers have three-dimensional design capability, we design buildings through analysis by separating orthogonal systems into components.
ENGINEERING EDUCATION In the 1960s, the computer became the modern tool for analysis, and many practical courses disappeared from the structural engineering curriculum. First, Surveying was eliminated. Then, Mechanical Drafting and Freehand Drawing were combined into Graphic Analysis. Some design and drafting courses were dropped from the curriculum in favor of basic computer programming. The Maxwell diagram, the string polygon, and Bow’s notation are unknown to the younger generation of engineers. Yet, what simple but beautiful methods of analysis these were! Graphical analysis was so simple and logical that many truss manufacturers employed drafters to do this work. Pier Luigi Nervi remarked, “I believe that graphical statics should play an important role in this last educational phase, since its procedures give a direct
Analysis of Existing Structures
37
understanding—much better than that afforded by analytical methods—of force systems and their composition, decomposition, and equilibrium.”5 Nervi is well known for his ideas regarding mathematical analysis in building design. In the early 1950s, he wrote: It is highly regrettable that some of the highest qualities of the human mind, such as intuition and direct apprehension, have been banned from our schools and have been overwhelmed by abstract and impersonal mathematical formulas. We cannot forget that in the distant past intuition allowed the execution of works which cannot be analyzed today by the most modern theoretical methods, and before which we must bow in reverent and humble admiration. We cannot deny that the potentialities of mathematical methods are soon exhausted, even when their application is difficult and complex. Special, skinresistant, and highly indeterminate structures cannot be analyzed by mathematical theories, although they are extremely efficient from a technical, economical, and architectural viewpoint. Moreover, the most advanced chapters of theory of structures, which deal with the solution of statically indeterminate systems, can be used only to check the stability of a structure. They can be used only to analyze numerically a structure already designed, not only in its general outline, but in all its dimensional relations. The formative stage of a design, during which its main characteristics are defined and its quality and faults are determined once and for all (just as the characteristics of an organism are clearly defined in the embryo), cannot make use of structural theory and must resort to intuition and schematic simplifications.5
The essential part of the design of a building consists in conceiving and proportioning its structural system; in evaluating intuitively any dangerous thermal conditions and support settlements, in choosing materials and construction methods best adapted to the final purpose of the work and to its environment; and, finally, in seeking economy. When all these essential problems have been solved and the structure is thus completely defined, then and only then can we and should we apply the formulas of the mathematical theory of elasticity to specify with greater accuracy its resisting elements.
ANALYSIS OF EXISTING STRUCTURES The analysis of existing structures, such as in the field of historic preservation, requires that we have an appreciation for traditional methods of construction that may have been based on simplified engineering. It is only through testing, observation, and measurement that we can gather enough information to build an accurate model of the structure.
38
Simplified Engineering
DESIGN OR MODIFICATION TO EXISTING STRUCTURES Most historic structures are constructed of timber and masonry. Simplified engineering is justified in dealing with these materials when accurate design values cannot be ascertained. The absence of construction documentation and quality control in the manufacture and construction of the component elements requires that analysis be based, at least in part, on judgment. Of course this being the case, one’s analysis can only be as good as one’s judgment, as well as the initial assumptions that are made. A thorough testing program can narrow the range of applicable design values, but engineering judgment must still be applied. Many historic structures will often times not stand close engineering scrutiny, yet they survive, providing adequate service for many years.
CONCLUSION It is now time to pause for a moment and study how structural engineering will be practiced in the twenty-first century. The engineers of record must be allowed some leeway to determine load criteria and methods of analysis, free from third-party interference. We should demand the freedom to simplify our work in order to satisfy our own requirements for structural safety while meeting increased client expectations of time, quality, and cost. If we are not careful, practicing structural engineers will become mere technicians designing structures with prepackaged software written by programmers, on the basis of methods and formulas developed by academics and prescribed by code officials, in accordance with criteria set by architects who have little to no knowledge of structure whatsoever. Now, it is not enough just to do the design and bear the responsibility; we must also perform the analysis in a prescribed manner to the satisfaction of others, all the while assuring them of our continued professional development.
REFERENCES 1. Antonio M. Garcia, “Computers, Creativity, and the Engineer,” Civil Engineering, 63 (8) (August 1993): 6. 2. Percival White, “The July Almanac,” The Atlantic Monthly, 276 (1) (July 1995). 3. Ario Ceccotti, “The Earthquake Performance Challenge,” Wood Design Focus, 1 (4) (Winter 1990).
Bibliography
39
4. Edward L. Keith and John D. Rose, “Hurricane Andrew,” American Plywood Association (APA), APA Report T92-21, Tacoma, WA, September 1992 5. Pier Luigi Nervi, Structures Aesthetics & Technology in Building (New York: McGraw-Hill, 1956). 6. Anton Tedesko, “Computer Analysis No Substitute for Experience,” Civil Engineering, 64 (2) (February 1994). 7. Bruce D. Pooley, “Design of Glued Laminated Timber,” Wood Design Focus, 5(1) (Spring 1994): 3–8.
BIBLIOGRAPHY American Association of State Highway and Transportation Officials (AASHTO), Standard Specifications for Highway Bridges, 15th ed. (Washington, D.C.: AASHTO, 1995). American Concrete Institute (ACI), Building Code Requirements for Reinforced Concrete (Detroit: ACI, 1956 and 1965). American Institute of Timber Construction (AITC), Timber Construction Manual, 3rd ed. (New York: John Wiley & Sons, 1985). American Society of Civil Engineers, “American Wooden Bridges,” ASCE Historical Publication no. 4, 1976. ASCE Standard: Minimum Design Loads for Buildings and Other Structures (ASCE 7-95). Public Ballot Draft Copy. ASCE Washington, D.C. Conrad P Roberge and Glenn R. Bell, “Regulated Structural Peer Review,” Civil Engineering Practice (Fall/Winter 1994). Gerry Gilliam, Brazil, Movie by Embassy International Pictures, starring Jonathan Pryce, Robert De Niro, Catherine Helmond, Terry Gilliam, MCA produced. 1985. Herman Haupt, Reminiscences of General Herman Haupt (July 1901). Wright, John W. ed. The Universal Almanac. Kansas City: Andrews & McMeel Publishing, 1995. pp. 566–567. National Forest Products Association (NFPA), National Design Specification for Wood Construction (Washington, D.C.: NFPA, 1991), pp. 103–104, and 125. National Forest Products Association, National Design Specifications for Wood Construction, (Washington, D.C.: National Forest Products Association, 1991). Squire Whipple, A Work on Bridge Building: Consisting of Two Essays (Utica, NY: H. H. Curtiss, Printer, Devereux Block, 1847).
CHAPTER
4
Conservation and the Specialty Contractor
PRESERVATION PHILOSOPHY proper preservation philosophy requires that repairs to timberframe structures respect the work of the original framer. Through observation, measurement, testing, and analysis the structural engineer must select and design a repair that is appropriate to the task. It is often the structural engineer who makes the decision to repair or replace. Sometimes that decision is a response to the desires of the architect working in concert with the owner or a requirement of the contract, based on state or federal funds, or based on a particular grant, or the necessity to obtain tax credits for historic preservation. How the design is communicated to owner, architect, and general contractor often determines whether a project is successful. It is important to persuade stakeholders that craftpersons with specific skills are required, as well as materials that may not be readily available. Suggestions for temporary shoring and bracing, must be transmitted to those doing the work when such bracing has structural implications. Specific solutions involving traditional connections and materials must be thoroughly detailed and specified.
A
Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
41
42
Conservation and the Specialty Contractor
My preservation philosophy starts with structural safety and stability, with the realization that providing a structurally safe building may be independent of satisfying building code requirements. Second, repairs should be in the same fashion as the original construction as much as possible. If traditional methods will not provide adequate strength, then reinforcing may require other technologies in order to preserve the maximum amount of historic fabric. Timber structures should be rehabilitated as timber structures. Reinforcing and repairs should deal directly with the inadequacies in a way that would be easily understood by the original builder.
SPECIALTY CONTRACTORS We have caused various owners and general contractors to engage specialty contractors and conservation professionals to accomplish tasks that are not common in today’s construction market. We have recommended manufacturers of handmade brick, restoration masons, timber framers, structural movers, stone masons, specialty lumber suppliers, glued laminated timber manufacturers, foundries, preservation architects, testing laboratories, surveyors, historians, wood scientists, grant writers, marine contractors, specialists in ground modification and the installation of mini or pipe pile foundations, and other conservation professionals. These days, many general contractors are uncomfortable with aspects of projects that involve jacking, shoring, or underpinning. Often, the only answer is to engage a specialty contractor to undertake this work. For many projects, we have provided qualification-based specifications causing the general contractor to obtain the services of such contractors. Certainly, the standard specifications for shoring and bracing are applicable for projects involving patent scaffolding used in the typical applications. In these cases, engineers working for the scaffolding firms expect to receive from the engineer of record a tabulation of the loads to be supported by the patent scaffolding system. They are very uncomfortable when approached for a project that involves jacking as well as shoring, or the use of patent scaffolding in unusual ways, such as in a condition that will require the system to be braced to resist lateral loads. Although the engineer of record should not become responsible for means and methods at the construction site, enough information must be provided in the contract documents to describe the work in sufficient detail for it to be accomplished. We have received pressure from owners, who should know better, such as state departments of transportation, to provide shoring and bracing details in the structural drawings. In other cases, we decided to include “suggested” information regarding shoring and bracing in the plans, with a
Specialty Contractors
43
disclaimer stating that “means and methods of construction, shoring and bracing shall remain the responsibility of the general contractor and that the details shown in the drawings are suggestions only.” In several cases, we have specified that the specialty contractor be a member of the International Association of Structural Movers. Members of IASM are well versed in shoring, bracing, jacking, and cribbing and the effects on buildings and their components.
Trinity United Methodist Church We saved several owners considerable expense by simply requiring the general contractor to either perform these tasks themselves or engage a structural mover. Trinity United Methodist Church in Darlington, South Carolina, originally contained a roll-up partition that separated a Sunday School annex from the main portion of the sanctuary. In this flexible scheme, the Sunday School annex could be opened to the main sanctuary for overflow seating. Unfortunately, the sight lines were not ideal, with many of the congregants unable to view the chancel platform, choir, or the pulpit. Since, the operation of the rollup partition had long ceased, the building committee was interested in expanding the main sanctuary into this area. Unfortunately, the floor of this ancillary space was flat with a step dividing it from the sanctuary, which had a sloped floor. This made a smooth transition between the two floor areas impossible without major reframing. As an alternate to demolition and reframing, we suggested that the flat floor be reorientated to match the main floor of the sanctuary. Inspection of the crawl space beneath this area revealed that the floor framing was supported by brick piers in the interior and a four inch brick ledge at the perimeter. After observing these conditions, we issued a brief report that included the following: In the sanctuary, a step separates the sloped floor from the flat floor. It is original to the building, and is required to form a closure for the pull down roll-up partition. The 2 ⫻ 12 framing of the flat floor can be sloped to match the main floor by removing the floor sheathing, removing the floor joists, cutting down brick piers and adjusting bearing conditions of beams and joists. The existing 2 ⫻ 12s can be reinstalled. The existing floor sheathing can be re-installed, supplementing the existing with new to replace the damaged. Care should be taken not to damage the sheathings and joists to be reused. Alternately, it should be possible to cut the boundary of the floor so that the flat floor can be dropped in one piece to match the slope of the main floor. Piers would need to be cut down, temporary support jacks added, and the mechanical ducts would need to be removed during construction. The crawl space height of 46 inches would be reduced by approximately 13 inches in the chancel area. This solution would require pier work to occur in the crawl space with its limited headroom.
44
Conservation and the Specialty Contractor
Fortunately, we were able to convince the general contractor that the floor could be separated from its supports, and the supporting conditions modified in such a way, that with very little effort, the existing floor structure could be reused. It helped that the crawl space had sufficient headroom and that the perimeter-wall baseboards were easily removed prior to jacking the floor. Incorporating the Sunday School annex into the sanctuary increased the square footage by 75 percent. Existing floor joists that were embedded in the pockets in the exterior brick wall had to be cut along the face of the wall so that a double pressure-treated nailer could be inserted as support for the joists. Joist hangers were supplied to reattach the joists to the nailer, which was bolted to the brick masonry wall. The structural aspects of this project included plans and specifications to describe structural engineering requirements for the new chancel platform; to design solutions to eliminate the step at the existing roll-down and sloping the floor of the Sunday School annex; to design miscellaneous framing at a new pipe organ as well as engineering tasks related to creating an opening in the existing archway, to address raising the lintel above the arch and cutting the second floor of the education wing; and to revise walls and openings at the chancel wall/choir loft. To accommodate a new pipe organ, a Gothic archway had to be created and the chancel platform enlarged. For all of this to work, the discontinuity between the sanctuary and Sunday School annex had to be removed. At Trinity United Methodist Church, the local general contractor was able to adjust the slope of the flat floor to match the main floor, once we explained what we had in mind. Fortunately, very little input was required by us during construction of this portion of the project. With the church located approximately 120 miles from our office, extensive jobsite observation and consultation would have been difficult.
United Church of Chapel Hill The sanctuary of the United Church of Chapel Hill, North Carolina, had structural issues that caused the church leaders to make the decision to sell the property. The roof-framing system consisted of lightly framed, nail-connected, scissors trusses that, over time, had deflected horizontally, causing the top of the wood-framed east wall of the nave to translate toward the east five and one half inches. The wood-framed wall was actually an interior wall that supported a choir loft located between it and the exterior brick masonry wall. Obviously, scissors trusses, in similar fashion to all scissors trusses and pitched roof trusses with raised bottom chords, tend to deflect in the horizontal direction. In this case,
Specialty Contractors
45
because the interior wood-framed wall was less stiff than the opposite brick masonry wall, all of the deflection occurred in the easterly direction. It was my understanding that the church leaders, rather than soliciting a condition assessment from an architect or structural engineer, responded to the building inspector, who was concerned that the deflection was an indication of great weakness in the superstructure that had to be repaired. The building inspector went so far as to say that the building was unsafe. Apparently, rather than obtaining second and third opinions, they decided to sell this fairly valuable property consisting of the church sanctuary, fellowship hall, parking lots, and educational and administrative spaces. Faced with unknown expenses associated with replacing of the roof system and reframing the choir wall, choir loft, and narthex, they felt justified in selling, at below market value, the property to a developer team consisting of several real estate investors. We became involved when the developer, upon the recommendation of a local architect, decided that we might be able to determine how to repair or replace the roof system. Our initial contact was a phone call from one of the investors. The following phone memo was in my “in” box: “Just bought a historic church in Chapel Hill wants you to look @ the extent of the roof damage.”
We met several of the investors at the church. After a brief inspection, we discussed the finer points of horizontal deflection in scissors trusses and how the roof could be fixed. I had no idea whether or not they understood a word I said. Almost two years had passed when they called again. By then, they had received their Zoning Compliance Permit and approval from the Historic District Commission and had selected an architect and contractor and construction work was underway. After measuring the trusses, we performed a plane frame analysis. The 29 scissors trusses that frame the roof were built with 2" ⫻ 5¾" chords and 1¼" ⫻ 8" collar ties. The pitch of the top chord was approximately 10 to 12 and the pitch of the bottom chord was approximately 7 to 12. The design span used for analysis was slightly less than 32 feet. The spacing between trusses averaged about 19 inches. We compared the calculated deflection against field measurements and reviewed the capacity of the nailed connections against the calculated member forces. Surprisingly, the analysis indicated that the member sizes and connections were adequate. The actual horizontal deflection was compared to the long-term calculated deflection. The total load deflection in the horizontal direction at the right support was calculated to be 7.47 inches, assuming the left support hinged and the
46
Conservation and the Specialty Contractor
right support provided with a roller bearing in the x (horizontal) direction. Horizontal deflection due to dead load only was equal to 3.77 inches. This compared well to a measured deflection of 5.5 inches. When one considers that for a 30-foot span, the long-term dead load deflection of a timber structure is taken as 1.5 times the calculated dead load deflection. For trusses, the actual measured dead load deflection often exceeds the calculated deflection by a factor of three or four. With a small amount of resistance added to the roller in the horizontal direction, of 2 kips per inch, the total load horizontal deflection dropped to 0.41 inches. Obviously, the analysis indicated that the deflected shape of the roof truss was dependent on the boundary conditions, which in this case included support on a wood partition able to yield in the horizontal direction. The roof trusses were carefully modeled in the computer using section properties calculated for the actual dimensions of the truss components, and a modulus of elasticity of 1,600,000 psi. Lapped members were modeled as lapped members with a link connector to provide for continuity through the member intersection as well as rotation. Long-term deflection in timber scissors trusses is often magnified for a number of reasons. As in all wood-framed trusses in attics, the reduction in moisture content over timber affects the members and the joints. Normal creep is magnified if the roof structure was built from green timbers and high stresses were sustained over time due to dead loads only. Also, the types of connections have an effect on amount of deflection experienced. Shrinkage across the grain and the elongation of metal fasteners and the relaxation of wood fibers all contribute to movement in roof trusses. At the same time, the developer indicated that he was planning to demolish the sloped floor of the sanctuary because he was renovating the church as office space to be used for research. He had obtained as a tenant, a private scientific laboratory. They could only utilize the sanctuary as office space if the floor was not sloped. Again, we observed that the floor was simply framed and supported in the partial crawl space and basement on brick walls and piers. The floor joists of the sanctuary were 2" ⫻ 9 ¾" southern pine joists spaced approximately 18 inches on center. This floor area was approximately 30 feet by 43 feet in size, with half of the floor sloping down to a 15-inch step at the chancel platform. At the time of our first visit we recommended that the developer obtain the services of one of two specialty contractors. We explained to the structural moving firm of Blake Moving Company of Greensboro, North Carolina, what we had in mind. The idea was to shore the roof trusses, separate them from their supports at the top of the wood partition, plumb up the partition and then reattach the trusses. We also explained what would be required to level the sloping
Timber Framer Selection
47
floor of the sanctuary in one piece. Charlie Blake of Blake Moving Company understood exactly what to do, and accomplished the task in short order. So the adaptive reuse of this historic church facility into laboratory and administrative office space required very little new material, although 1,096 days passed from the first contact to completed project, most of the construction involved things other than the structural aspects of the work. We were able to certify the “adjusted” roof structure as structurally adequate and the building retained its historic floor structure. One interesting note occurred at the dedication of the new laboratory facility. The developer invited the church membership to attend the dedication. Several of them were less than happy to see their old sanctuary in like-new condition with the old millwork, flooring, and ceiling still intact. Apparently, one of the investors described to them how little was required to “fix” their former church sanctuary. At the United Church of Chapel Hill, it was fortunate that we were contacted early enough in the process to recommend a solution, and in particular, a specialty contractor capable of doing the job. In both of these cases, considerable historic fabric was retained, and money was saved for the owners by providing a unique solution to those capable of executing the design.
TIMBER FRAMER SELECTION Our most successful projects have been ones where we were able to select the timber framer in advance, or where we proposed several qualified bidders for consideration, or where we were able to insert prequalification language into a technical specification prior to bid. These have included new structures as well as the restoration and rehabilitation of existing buildings.
Tohickon Aqueduct For the rehabilitation of the Tohickon Aqueduct in Point Pleasant, Pennsylvania, we first designed the structure as a timber-frame Burr arch-truss system with mechanically laminated two-hinged arches. Bill Collins and I consulted with Jan Lewandowski to predetermine the constructability of the three span continuous timber system on site. As an aqueduct structure with an impervious liner, because of possible condensation and splash issues on the underside, we specified the material to be pressure treated. The original structure, which carried the Delaware Canal over Tohickon Creek, was a Town lattice truss. It was replaced with a riveted iron truss, which collapsed in 1931. The replacement steel and concrete aqueduct deteriorated to the point where it had to be
48
Conservation and the Specialty Contractor
replaced to maintain the viability of the canal. Bill Collins proposed that the latest incarnation be built as a Town lattice structure, similar to the original. For several reasons, I determined that a Burr arch structure would be preferable. We courted several timber-frame companies as possible bidders, including Blue Ridge Timberwrights and Pocopson Industries. When the project bid, neither of the two firms that we were counting on turned in a price. Apparently, construction of the three-span structure in the field, within the right-ofway of the canal, was problematic. This was the single issue we had wrestled with during the initial stages of the design. In a value engineering process, we converted the timber-frame arches to glued laminated timber and deleted the saw-tooth splices resulting in three identical simple spans that could be shop fabricated, preassembled, and shipped to the site in sections. From a philosophical standpoint, we deviated from the original system to ensure a better structure and a longer service life. Although the Town lattice is a tough system because of its redundancy, we concluded that a wet environment would cause shrink swell problems in the tightly pinned lattice connections. If the chords and lattice were to be treated, moisture content would also be an issue for the pinned connections. From a maintenance standpoint, we concluded that the Burr arch would allow easier replacement of primary elements. (See Chapter 18 for additional discussion of the Tohickon Aqueduct.)
Market Hall The restoration of the 1841 Market Hall in Charleston, South Carolina, required that the general contractor hire craftsmen with timber-frame skills. MBM Construction of Charleston insisted that its carpenters were fully capable of executing the work described in the plans, in spite of its reluctance to submit qualifications as required by the specifications. Eventually, we prevailed. It was necessary for us to obtain a list of timber framers willing to travel to Charleston for the duration of the work. I played matchmaker between Mike Goldberg and Peter Bull and MBM Construction. Within a few days of the initiation of work, I received a phone call from the superintendent. He said, more or less the following: “Dave! You were right. These guys are fast. Our carpenters would have not been able to do this.” (See Chapter 8 for further description of the Restoration of Market Hall.) There is a tendency for general contractors to think that there is nothing special or difficult about timber-frame work. It is precisely what cannot be easily seen that is critical to the structural engineer. Square and tight joints with critical surfaces fully bearing are what the typical timber-frame demands. Trunnels and pins must be properly installed without damage to them or the
Timber Framer Selection
49
members joined. Obviously, connections that rely on multiple surfaces being engaged at the same time, such as saw-tooth or bolt-o-lightning splices, require great precision. Of course, prior to scribing and cutting the first joint, the proper grade of timber must be obtained and properly seasoned. Often, it requires a timberframer’s eye to determine the actual quality of the timber in spite of the specified lumber grades, which may be quite stringent. In most cases, fees to the structural engineer fall quite short of allowing for the complete detailing of all the connections in a new structure or the repair details in a restoration project. Certainly, there are a few clients willing to pay an engineer’s fee to thoroughly study over a period of time, an existing building with problems.
Bunker Hill Covered Bridge For the repairs to the Bunker Hill Covered Bridge in Catawba County, North Carolina, we convinced the Catawba County Historical Society to allow us to obtain bids from two qualified timber framers or bridgewrights based on a site visit where we would all agree on the scope of work. I arranged to meet Arnold Graton and Jan Lewandowski at Douglas Airport in Charlotte and drove them to Catawba County. In that way, based on an analysis and a minimum set of plans, after and informal bid process, we were able to engage lower bidder Arnold Graton to restore the only remaining covered bridge built in accordance with Herman Haupt’s patent for the improved lattice. (See Chapter 15 for additional discussion of the Bunker Hill Covered Bridge.)
Yates Mill Both Jan Lewandowski and Arnold Graton worked on various stages of Yates Mill (ca. 1778) in Raleigh, North Carolina. As a member of the Yates Mill Associates, I did not have a contract for structural engineering plans and specifications. In an advisory role, I prevailed upon Yates Mill Associates to hire Jan and Arnold for various portions of the work. When Hurricane Fran destroyed the sawmill portion of Yates Mill, we were engaged by North Carolina State University to design the repairs. Again, we inserted prequalification language into the specifications. My preservation philosophy was enhanced while following Jan’s work around the mill as he cut out deteriorated wood and inserted all sizes and shapes of inserts and Dutchmen into posts and beams. At one, point I asked Jan about some notchedend cuts at some new floor joists that did not appear terribly good. He replied that those end cuts looked that way because his crew was mimicking the work of the original framer. I thought, of course! The original builder was a miller interested in grinding some corn as soon as possible. He was not a timberwright.
50
Conservation and the Specialty Contractor
FIGURE 4-1 Yates Mill required the services of a timber framer.
A Tale of Two Plantations Two very different projects, involving two similar historic structures, illustrate the impact that a structural engineer can have on a project, only if the owner is willing to act on the advice of the engineer. For Burnside Plantation, in Henderson, North Carolina, at my recommendation, the owners agreed to hire Arnold Graton to replace a 26-foot-long portion of a white oak sill in the traditional manner, using a timber cut from a very large white oak tree on the property previously knocked down by Hurricane Fran. In contrast, in Wake County, North Carolina, the relocation of Midway Plantation (ca.1848), the house, and all of its dependencies, had sills replaced by “carpenters” using pressure-treated 2 ⫻ 8s scabbed and nailed together. For the Midway project, we were able to recommend Michael Blake as the structural mover but had no influence with the owners with regard to the timberframe aspects of the work. From a philosophical standpoint, total replacement of a badly deteriorated sill in a traditional manner or scabbing a piece onto a partially decayed sill is much more satisfying than merely nailing a bunch of boards together in place of missing sill material.
Connecticut Barn One of our most satisfying projects was the reconstruction and expansion of a barn in Connecticut. The client desired an indoor space sufficient in size to accommodate basketball. Our solution was to span the large space with two Town lattice trusses.
Timber Framer Selection
51
FIGURE 4-2 The Barn was greatly expanded by adding two Town lattice trusses parallel to the ridge.
The architect selected me to assist with the design, and I recommended Arnold Graton as the best craftsman to undertake the project.
FIGURE 4-3 The 73-foot-long Town lattice trusses provided a clear span of almost 45 feet.
52
Conservation and the Specialty Contractor
Miles Brewton House In spite of a lack of control, sometimes we have been pleasantly surprised by the skill that craftsmen previously unknown to us have brought to a project. I met Tommy Graham of McClellanville, South Carolina, at the Miles Brewton House (ca. 1769) in Charleston in 1988. The two-story portico of the Miles Brewton House features four columns of Oxford (England) limestone. It was thought that cracks in the columns were the result of the corrosion of the iron pins between drum sections. We determined by a review of historic photographs that the cracks more likely were caused by the 1886 earthquake. A survey of earthquake damage included a historic photograph of damage to the capital of one column. A subsequent historic photograph showed a newly installed iron band, most likely made by a blacksmith. There was considerable damage to the second level portico. A lack of bracing indicated that with movement in the north-south direction, during a seismic event, the portico could easily rack. Analysis indicated that the Oxford columns contained enough mass to produce a large lateral force when accelerated during an earthquake. Examination of nearby properties indicated that movement was in the northsouth direction. Damage to nearby parapets, chimneys, garden walls, storefronts and porticos indicated that this was true. Tommy Graham and his crew brought timber frame, carpentry, and painting skills to the Miles Brewton House.
St. Michael’s Episcopal Church In the steeple of St. Michael’s (ca. 1756–1761), Charleston, South Carolina, Tommy Graham provided the necessary craftsmen to rehabilitate a steeple constructed of cypress timbers. Initially, we proposed that several of the 6 ⫻ 8 framing timbers be replaced. Tommy pointed out that although he could mine large dense cypress timbers in nearby rivers, lakes, and swamps, acquisition of dry cypress timbers might be problematic. He instead proposed epoxy repairs to the steeple framework. In response, we instructed him to have his crew prepare a dozen lap joint samples under field conditions that could be tested in a laboratory. With segmental in-fill and the installation of Dutchmen we were able to rehabilitate the deteriorated timbers in a systematic way while maximizing the retention of historic fabric.
Darrah Hall After our experience at St. Michael’s, we recommended Tommy Graham to undertake the rehabilitation of Darrah Hall at Penn School (ca. 1882) on St. Helena Island, South Carolina. Darrah Hall had totally collapsed due to an unchecked long-term roof leak.
Timber Framer Selection
53
FIGURE 4-4 Darrah Hall in St. Helena’s Island, South Carolina, had totally collapsed.
Again, using epoxy techniques, we restored the structural system of the building with a minimum loss of the original material.
FIGURE 4-5 Darrah Hall was restored using 90 percent of the original material.
54
Conservation and the Specialty Contractor
Bloomsbury We also recommended Tommy Graham to rehabilitate a pair of two story porch columns at Bloomsbury in Camden, South Carolina. This home was the city home of Sarah Chesnut (1813–1889) during the Civil War. Tommy transported each column, in turn, to the shop where they were rehabilitated by segmental infill while controlling the moisture content of the pie shaped Dutchmen inserts and the solid timber cypress columns.
Montpelier Recently, we provided design to Mesick, Cohen, Wilson, and Baker, Architects of Albany, New York, for the restoration of James Madison’s Montpelier in Orange, Virginia. Although the array of craftsmen included several with timber-frame experience, most considered themselves furniture makers. Three tasks required special know-how that generated uncertainty among the assembled crew. Again, we recommended Arnold Graton to underpin the 1750s chimney, providing space for underground mechanical ducts to make a transition to the vertical space within the chimney. Also, leveling the floors required some expertise with shoring that the staff was not prepared to undertake. With a topographic map of the surface of the floors in hand, Arnold installed towers of 6 ⫻ 7, by 4 foot long, spruce cribbing. Floors were leveled starting at the attic floor, moving downward in stages, in one portion of the building at a time. Montpelier consists of a central portion with wings added on both sides. Between theses sections are masonry walls that served as the division between the phases in the floor leveling effort. We also asked Arnold to provide a price to rehabilitate a 12" ⫻ 16" deteriorated first floor timber by routing out the decayed wood in its core and replacing it by segmental infill with laminated veneer lumber. The advantages of using laminated veneer lumber are similar to glued laminated timber in that the timber possesses considerable strength and the moisture content is strictly controlled. We also brought wood scientist Ron Anthony to the project to do some investigative resistance drilling. His work in the basement was critical in finding this deteriorated beam, which felt hard to the touch and appeared to be sound. (See Chapter 10 for additional discussion of James Madison’s Montpelier.)
PLAN STAMPING You would think that the ideal project for a structural engineer is one that the timber framer initiates. Unfortunately, most of timber framer work involves the requirement that the shop drawings for new timber-frame buildings bear
Plan Stamping
55
the seal of a professional engineer attesting to the design. In those cases, the engineer is hired after the fact. In some cases, it is an afterthought, or seems to be, or it was simply a requirement of the project from the beginning, but the general contractor and timber-frame company chose to ignore it, hoping that it would go away. In these cases, it is important to provide the specialty structural engineer with all of the project requirements. It is not sufficient to provide only the shop drawings in the expectation that they will be sealed without much of a review. Besides live loads, the structural engineer should be informed of the grade and species of the wood and of any unusual conditions such as fragile finishes, deflection requirements at large openings such as above-glass partitions, or retractable folding doors, or unusually heavy roofing or flooring materials. Standard practice should involve providing a full set of plans and specifications to the specialty structural engineer. Without complete information, the structural engineer can review the design on the shop drawings based only on what is provided. It is then the timber framer who is responsible for transmitting the project requirements. Structural engineers and timber framers alike should be aware of stringent requirements place on specialty engineers by the building code and the engineer’s board of registration in such states as Florida. It is becoming increasingly more difficult to practice as a registered professional engineer in multiple states. Variations in the method of sealing a sheet of drawings and what information must be provided are becoming more complicated. Many states require the engineer’s corporation to be registered as a business entity and/or pay license. In Tennessee, it is not possible to hire an engineer to seal shop or submittal drawings after the initiation of the project. The board of registration has consistently interpreted this section of the law to mean that a registrant is prohibited from sealing or stamping any document for which the registrant was not responsible for the original design. To merely review and seal or stamp drawings is most commonly referred to as plan stamping; the board’s discipline for plan stamping ranges from a warning or reprimand, to the imposition of civil penalties, to the suspension or revocation of a certificate of registration. Ironically, it is often the large engineering firms that initiate specifications requiring the timberframe or glued laminated timber manufacturer to produce the final design, the design of connections, and an engineer’s seal on the shop drawings. In many cases, calculations must be submitted for approval. Of course, the board of registration members who are horrified at the thought of “plan stamping” are usually principals of these same large firms. So, in an era of globalization, the states are becoming more provincial in a rigorous effort to eliminate “plan stamping.” Unfortunately, they don’t recognize
56
Conservation and the Specialty Contractor
the timber engineer as a rare individual willing to review drawings for timber structures serving the timber frame and glued laminated timber industries where other engineers are not. The best projects initiated by timber framers are the ones requiring the engineer to exercise his skills in developing a design solution in the initial stages. In the preliminary design effort, the engineer often can produce a unique solution. This is a valuable service that provides the engineering designer great satisfaction; it also may provide the timber framer with a competitive edge.
BLUE RIDGE TIMBERWRIGHTS AND AL ANDERSON We utilized the services of Blue Ridge Timberwrights and Al Anderson for several projects. Blue Ridge Timberwrights provided the superstructure for the New Covered Bridge at Old Salem and two, two-story replicated buildings at Somerset Place State Historic Site in Washington County, North Carolina. Blue Ridge Timberwrights were one of several firms that met the prequalification requirements of the specifications. Al Anderson also provided timber-frame services for Single Sisters House in Old Salem and White’s Mill in Abington, Virginia.
CONCLUSION To ensure success of many of our projects, we have had to prevail upon the owner, architect, contractor, and others in decision-making roles to engage subcontractors and craftsmen with specific skills. Structural engineers must take this proactive role to ensure that the work has the best chance to be completed in accordance with the engineer’s intent. In cases where this process was derailed for one reason or another, the results were less than satisfactory. For all concerned, it is best for the engineer to simply walk away from these projects if contractual relationships will permit him to do so.
CHAPTER
5
Historic Timber Structures
INTRODUCTION hrough specialized knowledge and experience, engineers can make the judgments needed to properly evaluate historic timber structures. The structural engineer may also be called on to utilize his or her skills to reinforce, rehabilitate, or restore historic structures. This chapter will deal with timber as the primary structural component for most historic structures in the United States and Canada. Although timber is but one component of a historic structure, which may consist of brick and stone masonry, iron, steel, or concrete; it often is the most misunderstood construction material of all. The engineer must be convinced that the structural model is an accurate representation of actual conditions. Once that is clear, the application of rigorous analysis, testing, and engineering judgment may be necessary to explain why the historic structure in question has performed adequately for many years. Structural engineers must play an integral role in historic preservation efforts. Although architects, planners, art historians, city officials, real estate developers, investment bankers, politicians, and conservators have been in the forefront of the preservation movement, it is the structural engineer who
T
Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
57
58
Historic Timber Structures
FIGURE 5-1 Hurricane Fran destroyed the sawmill portion of Yates Mill in Raleigh, North Carolina.
possesses the knowledge and skills necessary to solve many of the problems associated with renovation, restoration, rehabilitation, and adaptive reuse of historic structures. The structural engineer is best qualified to measure, monitor, analyze, and evaluate historic structures. The Economic Recovery Tax Act of 1981 eliminated an economic bias in favor of new construction. Tax incentives for rehabilitating older buildings were simplified and substantially improved, especially in the case of historic buildings. The tax act gave impetus to the historic preservation movement. Structural engineers found themselves more involved in historic preservation projects as owners and developers discovered the benefits of the 1981 tax act.
TIMBER DESIGN AND HISTORIC PRESERVATION Often the proper analysis and evaluation of a historic structure requires that the structural engineer have extensive timber design experience. Many historic structures in the North America are timber framed. Masonry construction is generally utilized for foundations, exterior wall support, and building enclosure.
Timber Design and Historic Preservation
59
A thorough knowledge of the physical and mechanical properties of wood is a necessity. Many historic structures were constructed of green timber because of the considerable time required to air dry large timbers. In the seasoning process timber gives off or takes on moisture from the surrounding atmosphere with changes in temperature and relative humidity until it attains a balance relative to the atmospheric conditions. Historic structures have had time to reach this point of balance known as the equilibrium moisture content. Moisture content is the weight of the water contained in wood, expressed as a percentage of the weight of the oven dry wood. As wood loses moisture, the water in the cell cavity is evaporated first. The condition at which the water in the cell cavity has been evaporated but the cell wall is still saturated is known as the fiber saturation point. This point is usually assumed to be at approximately 30 percent. When the moisture content is reduced below this point, shrinkage will occur. Builders of heavy timber structures usually make allowances for shrinkage in the design of members and connections. The amount of shrinkage may be calculated by utilizing tables that give amounts of radial, tangential, and volumetric shrinkage from green to oven-dry moisture content for various species. A moisture meter is an important tool for the structural engineer. What has been misinterpreted as deflection or settlement in historic structures may be due to the across-the-grain shrinkage of large timber girders that were installed in a green condition and subsequently dried to low moisture content. An increment borer can be utilized by the structural engineer to obtain core samples 0.2 of an inch in diameter, which can be used to determine the species, the number of growth rings per inch, the oven-dried weight, the moisture content, and the specific gravity of the wood sampled. Many times in old, dry buildings with dense wood, the increment borer is ineffective because the wood is too hard to penetrate or the sample crumbles upon extraction. In those cases, larger samples can be cut out that, upon testing, will yield more accurate test results. Many times, certain parts of a structure will indicate a moisture content that is considerably higher than the equilibrium moisture content determined by the dry bulb temperature and relative humidity. Usually, close contact of timber with moisture containing masonry or earth will cause elevated moisture content at the bearing points of timber purling, joists, beams, columns, or trusses. The moisture is most readily absorbed through end grain. Once the moisture content rises above 20 percent, decay may occur. Strength-reduction effects of decay and termite infestation many times occur at support points. Repairing these areas of high shear is a challenge to the structural engineer involved in historic preservation.
60
Historic Timber Structures
The structural engineer evaluating the heavy timber frame of a historic structure should be intimately familiar with the causes and significance of checking and the structural considerations. A familiarity with timber-grading rules and the strength-reduction properties of various natural growth characteristics can be obtained from The Wood Handbook of the U.S. Forest Products Laboratory.1 The structural engineer must review the past practice of excessively notching floor or roof joists into carrying members using the end-notched beam formulae presented in various timber design manuals and textbooks. A joist might be perfectly adequate in bending and deflection and be critical in horizontal shear at a notched support. This condition may be easily remedied by installing custom-sized nailed joist hangers to transfer vertical forces from the joist to the supporting member. Checking is caused by the difference in the moisture content between the inner and outer wood fibers of timber members. As timber dries from the fiber saturations point (approximately 30 percent moisture content) to zero moisture content, it shrinks. As the outer wood fibers dry, large stresses form between the inner and outer wood fibers. Checking is merely the separation of the wood fibers that occur as shrinkage stresses are relieved. In general, shrinkage is greater in larger timbers than in small timbers of the same species and greater in hardwoods than in softwoods. Although season checks affect the horizontal shear strength in timber, the design values for various grades and species have to be set up anticipating season checking in excess of the grading limitations. Season checks at middepth of a beam near a support are important to shear strength. Compression or tension members are normally not affected. In Japan, a common practice is to cut a saw kerf, or artificial check, along the centerline of one face of a large timber half the depth of the timber (to the pith) in order to relieve stresses due to differential shrinkage before they cause checking.
TIMBER MISUNDERSTOOD AS A CONSTRUCTION MATERIAL Almost all buildings constructed during the first 300 years of settlement in the New World were of timber-frame construction. Even brick, stone, and log buildings had timber-framed roof and floor systems. This form of construction is characterized by the use of substantial pieces of timber, of square and rectangular sections, fabricated into a braced frame. The timbers in the frame are connected to each other by timber joints such as the mortise and tenon, half lap, dovetail, wedged half-dovetail, birdsmouth, and scarf. Joints may be pinned with wood pins, sometimes called pegs, treenails, or trunnels.
Traditional Timber Joinery
61
Although timber is but one component of a historic structure, which may consist of brick and stone masonry, iron, steel, or concrete; it often is the most misunderstood construction material. Part of the misunderstanding lies in our educational system. Many structural engineers earn degrees in civil engineering without ever taking a course in timber design. It is unfortunate in North America, with our tremendous stock of timber-framed buildings and our strong forest products industry, that more civil engineering curricula do no include mandatory courses in timber design. In the 1990s, timber in most important to the residential market as dimension framing, prefabricated trusses, stress-rated panels, and other components. The size of residential framing members is dictated by building codes for various spans and conditions.
TRADITIONAL TIMBER JOINERY The key to timber frames and timber-framed trusses is the connections between members. The Achilles’ heel of timber joinery is tension connections. Early truss builders learned to provide iron straps at connections that were susceptible to failure. Consider the king post connection of a simple truss. Many postto-bottom-chord connections in king post trusses were furnished with iron straps and pins, especially where the bottom chord carried a suspended plaster ceiling or attic floor. Engineers evaluating timber frames and trusses should pay particular attention to tension joints. Sometimes the orientation of members is perpendicular, parallel, or of some angle in between. Usually, timber frames include braces that are oriented close to a 45-degree angle between posts and beams. It is important to consider the connection of the braces in the analysis of a frame. If a plane frame analysis results in high-tensile forces at brace end joints that appear inadequate, it may be appropriate to reanalyze without the tension braces included or provide a certain amount of slip in the joint. In many frames it can be assumed that only knee braces in compression are capable of resisting lateral loads. Joints may rely on pins (hardwood or iron), bearing surfaces, or side plates to transfer load. Tension splices of large timbers may be lapped or scarf joints with shear blocks, keys, shear pins, splice plates, fish plates, iron dogs, or a combination of two or more elements. The modern engineer can learn much from historic timber splice joints. Today’s shear plate, split ring, and spike grip timber connectors can maximize the capacity of a splice because a relatively small cross-section is removed in
62
Historic Timber Structures
FIGURE 5-2 At James Madison’s Montpelier, a simple fork and loose tongue connection provided sufficient strength.
FIGURE 5-3 Simple scarf joints were provided to extend the ends of the ceiling joists at Montpelier.
order to install such connectors. Only in recent years has the design code recognized that long lines of connectors may result in unequal sharing of load due to drilling and punching tolerances.
Structural Evaluation
63
Connection of posts and beams in many buildings may contain mortise and tenon joints of various configurations. Continuity in the frame may be accomplished with long tie beams with splines and pins. Rafters may be tenoned into a ridge member, a supporting plate, a tie beam, or a post. Joints, purlins, and beams may be connected to girders, rafters, beams, or trusses with mortise and tenon joists or housed or unhoused dovetail joints.
STRUCTURAL EVALUATION Engineers are most commonly asked to examine the timber frames of public structures, such as courthouses, churches, and bridges. Although wall posts, interior columns, sills, and plates are usually found adequate to their tasks according to modern engineering criteria, roof systems and trusses, bracing, joists, and tension joinery, when quantitatively analyzed, often appear barely able to carry their own dead load. Since most of the frames being examined have been successfully carrying dead and live loads for a hundred years or more, the conclusion that they will not work indicates that there may be something wrong with our analysis. Accurate field measurements are essential in defining the structure and its condition. Surveying methods have been successfully utilized in determining the stiffness of deflected beams and trusses. A topographic plan of the floor surface of a historic structure will yield a useful visual representation of an irregular floor if the contour interval is small. Irregular floors in a historic structure could be the result of movement in the supporting soils, timber decay or shrinkage, or deflection of structural components. Obtain accurate measurements. Apply some engineering judgment when standard procedures do not fit the situation. For example, you might assume that the original wood in use in a historic structure, unless inspection tells you otherwise, has design values that are as high as possible for the species. The straight-grained timber from the old-growth forest, with its small and scattered knots, was almost always much better material than the samples that modern design values are based on. Keep in mind that quality may be more important than species. Most of the great railroad bridges built in the northeast in the nineteenth century were of white pine, which is not favored for structural purposes today, but was favored then because it was available in great quantity as clear and dense growth. Structural evaluations usually include a determination of the ability of a floor or roof system to support service loads. Monitoring of an existing structure may be required in order to obtain data for such an evaluation. Testing programs
64
Historic Timber Structures
may have to be designed to aid in determining the strength of component materials or complete assemblies. Methods may consist of destructive or nondestructive testing of component materials or load tests of structural members (such as beams) or assemblies (such as trusses). Adaptation of current testing methods for field use on historic structures will be necessary. Computer models used to analyze steel trusses may not be totally appropriate for analyzing wood trusses. A timber member is often moved away from its ideal point of bearing in order that there be room to construct the joint. The original builder was building a truss, and it probably functions like one. The problem for us today is to model it correctly. Obtain the advice of an engineer with experience evaluating timber structures, particularly in cases where maintaining the historic integrity of a frame was a parallel goal to ensuring structural stability. Ask your state Historic Preservation Office or the National Park Service, or a timber framer, for recommendations to locate an engineer qualified to undertake the structural evaluation.
LIVE LOAD DURATION AND HISTORIC STRUCTURES This is a most appreciated concept to apply to timber design because of the long history of the concept of live load duration. Early timber research found that timber reacts quite well to short applications of load. The duration of load was found to be as critical as the magnitude of the load. Presumably, the natural composition of timber consists of a tightly bound bundle of cells that tend to stretch or elongate with time. The larger and more constant the load, the more the stretching of fiber occurs. The effects of this creep can be seen in many timber structures through extensive deflection. For short durations of load, allowable design values will be increased substantially. This timber verses stress relationship is a most important research area. Only through evaluating historic timber structures can we solve this puzzle, which is complicated by cyclic loading, original moisture content, member size, span, species, grade, temperature, humidity and magnitude of stress.
ENGINEERING JUDGMENT Members in the horizontal plane such as floor sheathing, joists, purlins, and beams are stressed principally in bending. The resisting bending moment is a measure of the strength of such and element. This, together with stiffness and
Load Tests
65
horizontal shear, are the three qualities that are normally determined during the process of selection we call design. Because timber is available in certain standard lumber sizes, the designer selects from those available, the size, grade, and species that most economically meets the preordained standards for bending stress, deflection, and horizontal shear. When the engineer reviews the capacity of an existing member, many parameters complicate this process. Size, span, and spacing of members are dictated by the existing structure. It is the engineer’s task to determine the size, orientation, species, grade, and end condition of all the structural elements in a building that already exists. The freedom of choice afforded by design is therefore reduced in the review process. Often, the structural engineer must pass judgment on a structure that has served far beyond what we consider to be a normal period of service. The timbers were not selected on the basis of modern engineering analysis. They certainly do not bear inspection marks attesting to their grade and specie. It should be obvious to the engineer that a safe floor structure should not fail in bending due to the actual loads imposed. But it is important to recognize that excessive deflection, excessive vibration, or lack of stiffness, should not automatically categorize a floor structure as “unsafe”. Strict deflection limitations should be set, however, for floors that support plaster ceilings in lieu of wood or tin ceilings, or no ceilings at all. But for comfort, the live load deflection limitation set in most building codes for floors, no matter what the ceiling, is 1/360th of the span. It must be said that overstressed structural members may also be perfectly safe. It is, however, important to evaluate the basis for the conclusion. The loads assumed for design should be reconciled with the actual loads that will occur in service. The design values that we assume are very critical to the computed capacity of some floor systems. For structures such as mill buildings, average design values yield results that fall well above the minimum code requirements for an adaptive reuse occupancy such as office or retail.
LOAD TESTS Load testing a historic structure may be the only reasonable way to justify conditions or materials that are difficult to analyze. In designing a load test, the engineer must call for the application of realistic loads carefully applied. Great care should be taken before applying twice the design live load, as required by many building codes, to a historic structure. For timber structures, it may be
66
Historic Timber Structures
unrealistic to apply full live load plus an increase for a period such as 24 or 48 hours, when the structure actually will never reach that service loading for that length of time. Applying a known, safe load to a historic structure is an excellent method to determine the stiffness characteristics of various materials. This is of special value when evaluating timber structures. It is important to realize that because of the variation in the strength characteristics of timber, a load test of one member of a structure may not be indicative of the true capacity in other areas of the building. For any material, before a load test is undertaken, the engineer must be certain that all lateral bracing and slenderness requirements are satisfied. A preliminary analysis must be performed to ensure that the structure will not be loaded past the elastic limit or further to destruction. The application of strain gages and other instrumentation is highly desirable in monitoring a load test. Through the use of monitoring techniques, testing, measurements, observation, and structural calculations, an accurate interpretation of the structural capability of a historic structure can be presented in a carefully written report.
THE TIMBER TRUSS COMPUTER MODEL Slippage, rotation, shrinkage, or the lack of continuity in a timber joint is difficult to allow for in a chord-plane frame analysis of a timber truss. Multiple chord trusses will invariably appear stiffer when analyzed, even when all joints are free to rotate in the computer model. Structural engineers are aware that it is very difficult to produce a true hinge or a true fixed joint in the actual structure. Joints in timber trusses may act somewhere between the two causing a very different distribution of forces than produced by the analysis. How does one model a half-lapped and notched joint in an indeterminate frame? How about the problem of describing the intersecting member of a multiple chord truss where half of the member section in each direction passes through a joint and all pieces nailed together with wrought iron spikes? When analyzing a timber structure, the structural engineer must remember that wood is a orthotropic material with unique properties parallel and perpendicular to grain. Not only are properties in tension, compression, and shear unique for various species, but also the modulus of elasticity varies with grain direction. The moduli of elasticity along longitudinal, radial, and tangential axes of wood vary between species and with specific gravity and moisture content. A computer program for the analysis of wood structures should include the
A Repair Philosophy
67
12 constants needed to describe the elastic behavior of wood. Three moduli of elasticity (E), three moduli of rigidity (G), and six Poisson’s ratios can be found in the Wood Handbook for some common species. For timber design and analysis, today’s computer programs should be using the relationships between stress and strain, which have been worked out for homogenous, orthotropic materials. The ideal timber analysis program would input species, specific gravity, and moisture content. Obviously, with such a tool we could vary the moisture content to reflect the drying out of a timber frame or truss during a long period of service. We could then better understand the effects of shrinkage in members and joints.
A REPAIR PHILOSOPHY When repairing timber trusses it is better to reinforce than replace members or connections. Epoxy has been used with success to fill and consolidate areas of decayed wood. If it is necessary to replace individual members, it is important to not modify the configuration of the existing truss unless the action of the truss is easily understood. In many timber structures it is not the members themselves which are critical elements but rather the connections. Connections made with cut or wrought nails are difficult to evaluate. Hardwood dowels, iron pins, cast iron seats or keys, saw-tooth splices, scarf joints, mortise and tenon joints, shear connectors, metal hangers, and anchors vary in capacity, depending on the direction of the load with respect to the angle of the grain. A review of the lateral bracing of historic roof trusses in many cases will indicate that although the members and connections can withstand very high forces, the mode of failure would be buckling of the truss at much lower stress levels. The addition of appropriate bracing may be the only required repair. Because of its availability, controlled moisture content, and known design values, glued laminated timber should not be overlooked as a replacement for large timber members. Pressure-treated wood should be specified as replacement material for timbers in contact with masonry or in an area susceptible to moisture. In reinforcing members or connections, the structural engineer must be very familiar with the National Design Specification for Wood Construction of the National Forest Products Association.2 Design values, edge distances, and installation procedures are specified for shear plates, split rings, nails, screws, lag screws, and bolts.
68
Historic Timber Structures
The reinforcement or repair of a historic timber truss should be treated with sensitivity and care. The ideal reinforcement or repair would involve the fewest modern fasteners and utilize ring-shank nails and lag screws instead of bolts, if possible. In many cases, supplemental structural framing has to be introduced into a historic structure in order to relieve the original structural framework, which may be deficient. Not only must methods and locations of support for the new structure are determined, but also methods and locations for support of the existing structure, and the effects of the interaction of the two. The problem of erecting the new framework within the confines of the existing structure may present the most difficult challenge to the structural engineer.
REPLACEMENT-IN-KIND Of course “modern” timber products should not automatically replace traditional timber framing and joinery. Replacement-in-kind of members with mortise and tenon, dovetail, tongue and fork, slotted, or oak-pinned joint connection is a possibility that must be considered. In recent years many designs for new post-and-beam frames have been produced containing little or no metal connectors. Traditional technology is available through timber framers located in many areas of the United States and Canada. Often, replacement-in-kind is not economically feasible. More advances are being made in the field of timber design than any other area of structures. Recent products include laminated veneer lumber and numerous other beam and joist substitutes. The most important benefits of these reconstituted wood products is the availability of long lengths, higher design values, and greater stiffness. Preservationists and preservation engineers must determine the appropriateness of these materials to each case.
PRESERVATION PHILOSOPHY All structural engineers should obtain a copy of The Secretary of the Interior’s Standards for Rehabilitating Historic Buildings. Under these standards, rehabilitation means “the process of returning a property to a state of utility, through repair or alteration, which makes possible an efficient contemporary use while
Summary
69
preserving those portions and features of the property which are significant to its historic, architectural, and cultural value.”3 Minimum alteration of the building, its environment, and its distinguishing architectural qualities are required for a project to qualify as a “certified rehabilitation” benefiting from the provisions of the tax act. Archeological resources must be protected, as well as significant historical, architectural, or cultural material. An understanding of the historical significance of a building must be obtained to enable the engineer to provide an acceptable solution to a particular design problem while following the “secretary’s standards.”3 The guidelines for applying the Interior Department’s standards for rehabilitation recommend that the “special problems inherent in the structural system of historic buildings, especially where there are visible signs of cracking, deflection, or failure” be recognized.3 “Stabilization and repair of weakened structural members and systems when damaged or inadequate” are also recommended. “Historically important structural members” are to be replaced “only when necessary.”3 The actual distribution of loads in a structure, similar to live load reduction factors for tributary area, can account for the continued service for heavily loaded members such as stair and fireplace headers, and summer beams, which may appear to the engineer to be grossly undersized. Many times, these members deflect beyond comfortable amounts. These excesses are often dismissed because “this house is old.” The failure rate of historic structures form sudden structural collapse is very small. Even when deterioration due to decay or termites is accounted for, the sudden collapse of an old timber structure is rarely reported. The reports usually involve accidents, such as collision of an automobile with a cast-iron column in the storefront of a commercial structure.
SUMMARY By learning more about timber design, engineers will develop a preservation philosophy that demands rigorous analysis in order to justify “doing nothing” to a historic timber structure that has been performing satisfactorily for many years. Buildings that analysis, testing, and observation clearly indicate are unsafe should be reinforced in the most sensitive manner in an attempt to retain as much historic fabric as possible. Buildings that require extensive modification or reconstruction should be treated in a way that is in keeping with the original construction if possible, while fulfilling safety requirements.
70
Historic Timber Structures
FIGURE 5-4 The sawmill portion of Yates Mill was replaced in kind, except that positive anchorage of the timber frame was added.
REFERENCES 1. U.S. Department of Agriculture, Forest Service. Forest Products Laboratory Handbook, no. 72. Wood Handbook. Washington D.C.: U.S. Government Printing Office, 1974. 2. National Forest Products Association, National Design Specification for Wood Construction, Washington D.C.: National Forest Products Association, 1977). 3. U.S. Department of the Interior, The Secretary of the Interior’s Standards for Rehabilitation and Guidelines for Rehabilitating Historic Buildings. Washington D.C.: U.S. Government Printing Office. 1979.
CHAPTER
6
Watauga Hall and the Montague Building
ver the years I have noticed, or maybe simply imagined, that there appeared to be incredible leeway given by state preservation offices regarding the acceptability of certain architectural and structural decisions involving historic structures. As the structural consultant on many design teams, it often appeared that “the other guy,” usually a developer with minimal professional design input, was allowed to do certain things that our team was not. Was it because our team, headed by a competent and conscientious architect, was able to deal with various requirements while the developer could plead ignorance? Did the developer have more political pull, or was the success of his project more important for the community than ours? Most of the controversies seem to involve architectural decisions such as whether to replace or restore the windows. Although I cannot present a situation where a controversy regarding a similar issue occurred on two different projects, I can present two similar projects with very different outcomes. The Montague Building and Watauga Hall were both built in the early twentieth century with exterior load-bearing brick masonry walls and an interior load-bearing structure of wood. The floors of Watauga Hall consisted of 2 ⫻ 12 framing supported by load-bearing wood studs. The Montague Building was not much different, with floors consisting of 2 ⫻ 12 joists supported by a timber post and beam system.
O
Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
71
72
Watauga Hall and the Montague Building
The rehabilitations of the two buildings were different in that Watauga Hall was a university project administered in part by the North Carolina Department of Administration with no oversight by federal officials. The Montague Building was a privately owned building restored by a developer with oversight by the United States Department of the Interior acting through the state preservation office (SHPO).
OVERVIEW OF WATAUGA HALL AND THE MONTAGUE BUILDING Sometimes decisions regarding the existing structural system of a building are made of the basis of issues other than structural. Upgrades required to address fire safety concerns may be due to changes in occupancy or the need to separate tenants by a enhanced fire rated wall or floor system. The restorations for Watauga Hall and the Montague Building can be judged by The Secretary of the Interior’s Standards for Guidelines for Historic Preservation, last amended in 1983, and the Standards for the Treatment of Historic Properties, dated 1995. The Standards are not technical or prescriptive, but provide a philosophical basis for the decisions that structural engineers should make regarding historic properties. Whether or not Watauga Hall and the Montague Building are on the National Register of Historic Place is irrelevant. They both are certainly old enough to qualify, and important enough from a cultural standpoint. Deterioration, damage, and defects should, more often than not, be mitigated through reinforcing, or the replacing-in-kind critical elements, or by supplementing the original structure. The standards for preservation, rehabilitation, and restoration require that the historic character of a structure including, distinctive materials and examples of craftsmanship, be retained or preserved, repairing deteriorated features rather than replacing them. Although Watauga Hall and the Montague Building are similar in size, age, and type of construction, their histories are quite different. In 1985, the renovation of Watauga Hall was completed at a cost of $2.5 million. The renovation of the oldest dormitory on the campus of North Carolina State University, in Raleigh, North Carolina, has been judged a success. The project converted a 1903, three-story, wood framed, underutilized building into a noncombustible, four-story, steel and concrete dormitory for graduate students at a cost almost 8 percent below budget. The renovations to Watauga Hall may have been somewhat heavy handed with regard to the recommendations of The Secretary of the Interior’s Standards
Overview of Watauga Hall and the Montague Building
73
FIGURE 6-1 The attic of Watauga Hall was converted into dormitory space by raising the elevation for the new roof structure.
for Guidelines for Historic Preservation. As a design team, we did what was necessary to stabilize the building and accommodate the needs of a modern graduate student dormitory. At Watauga Hall we demonstrated that historic timber-frame buildings can be renovated using a cast-in-place two-way flat plate concrete floor system. Historic timber-frame buildings can also be rehabilitated by reinforcing, with steel, every undersized joist and beam if testing and analysis require this. The service life of these two methods of construction can be vastly different, with the former proving more satisfactory in the long run, and the latter barely meeting current building codes in the short term. The challenge for structural engineers is to advise owners, architects, and developers about the aspects of each solution. Although the latter method will certainly not jeopardize the tax credits so necessary in converting a historic structure into a serviceable building, the resulting building may not be the best system for the building.
74
Watauga Hall and the Montague Building
Obtaining historic certification from governmental agencies that administer the tax credit status of the project is crucial to the success of a project.
WATAUGA HALL Watauga Hall reflects much of the character and tradition of North Carolina State University, as it is named for the Watauga Club. The Watauga Club was a small but influential group of North Carolinians who were instrumental in the establishment of the land grant agricultural and mechanical arts college commonly known as “State College,” which is now North Carolina State University. Watauga Hall, originally constructed in 1896, was destroyed by fire during Thanksgiving weekend in 1901. The existing Romanesque Revival building was constructed in 1903 on the foundations of the original building. It is the only survivor of several dormitory structures built in 1896 to serve an expanding student body. Watauga Hall functioned, at various times, as the kitchen and dining hall, laundry, and office space for Campus Planning, Personnel, and Information Services. It functioned as a dormitory until 1968. For its last years of use as a dormitory, it provided the first housing on campus for women. Watauga Hall remained empty, between 1968 and 1983, when renovation began.
Watagua Hall Structural Evaluation Conditions inside of the long vacant Watauga Hall were discouraging. The interior was wood framed, including a monumental wood-framed stairway between the first and second levels. The room layout, governed by the location of load-bearing stud walls, was not ideally suited for a modern dormitory containing suites to house graduate students. The square footage was limited for the minimum number of beds that the university housing officials were requiring for efficiency. The architectural and structural response to the limitations of Watauga Hall included replacing the wood-framed floor system, raising the level of the roof to provide an additional floor in the former attic, and converting some of the crawl space to basement for ancillary functions. This was accomplished without underpinning and without extensive shoring and bracing. The original structure for Watauga Hall consisted of 3 ⫻ 12 floor joists spaced at 16 inches on center in some areas and 2 ⫻ 12 floor joists spaced at 18 inches apart in the great majority of the building.
Watauga Hall
75
FIGURE 6-2 Watauga Hall was a wood-framed dormitory building.
The roof structure consisted of 2 ⫻ 12 rafters, 18 to 24 inches on center. Although the upper floors were supported by timber-stud corridor walls at interior locations, the basement and crawl space support consisted of 10 ⫻ 10 timber girders on iron pipe columns or brick masonry piers. A computer-aided analysis was used to evaluate floor joists in an area where the 10 ⫻ 10 timbers and iron columns supported the parallel corridor walls above. Opposing 3 ⫻ 12 floor joists lapped each other as they cantilevered over the central timber beam support below. Analysis indicated that the existing floor joists were capable of supporting a 40 psf live load in rooms and at least 100 psf live load in corridor areas. The 10 ⫻ 10 timber beams beneath the first floor were generally inadequately sized, supporting an average floor live load of no more than 20 psf on the floors above. Interestingly, the center of each portion of the building exhibited considerable settlement in the floor system. This settlement increased in amount from the first floor upwards. At the same time, the perimeter of the floor at each level varied by less than three one-hundredths of a foot in elevation on any one floor. I determined that the settlement in the center of each floor area was due to the cumulative vertical shrinkage across the grain of load-bearing beams, joists, headers, and plates. This contradicted a previous report from a geotechnical/structural engineer, who indicated that the depression in the floor system was due to subsurface settlement in the soils.
76
Watauga Hall and the Montague Building
The moisture content of the existing timber framing was measured in the field with a Delmhorst J-1 moisture meter. The moisture content registered 5 percent or less in all areas. The total amount of shrinkage was calculated assuming average 19 percent initial moisture content for the 66.0 inches cumulative depth of joists, beams, and girders for the full height of the building. The total shrinkage across the grain for all these members computed to be 4.158 inches. A 19 percent initial moisture content was assumed because of the tendency of large timbers to retain moisture for a long period of time. In fact, the larger 10 ⫻ 10 timbers were probably installed close to a green state (30 percent moisture content). Obviously, the load-bearing timber structure shrank while the exterior brick masonry bearing walls did not. The computed value agreed closely with the 4.0 inches of settlement measured by a Registered Land Surveyor on the fourth floor. For Watauga Hall, samples of the timber framing were obtained with a 0.20-inch-diameter incremental boring tool. Laboratory tests consisting of moisture content, unit weight, and specific gravity were performed on each sample. The specific gravity values of the wood samples were somewhat erratic because of the variations to the size of the specimens, which often broke or crumbled when removed from the hollow auger of the incremental borer. The use of an incremental borer proved less acceptable than merely obtaining larger samples cut from the structure in noncritical locations. Typically, the incremental borer is a tool foresters use to obtain samples from living trees. Advancing such a tool into dry wood is much more difficult and is not recommended.
Brick Masonry Evaluation Several large cubes of brick masonry were obtained from Watauga Hall with a hammer drill from an abandoned masonry pier in the crawl space. Two prism sections were sawed from the cube sample in the laboratory and compressive strength tests were performed. Seven individual bricks were tested in accordance with ASTM C67-80a for compressive strength and modulus of rupture (flexure test). The compressive strength tests of the brick masonry from Watauga Hall indicated that the existing bricks complied with the compressive strength requirements set forth in ASTM C62-80, standard specifications for building brick, Grade SW brick. The compressive strength tests performed on the prism samples indicated that the masonry specimens exceeded the ASTM strength requirements for Type S mortar. In both Montague Building and Watauga Hall the pullout capacity of epoxy capsule bonded 3/4-inch diameter threaded rod anchors placed into the interior
Watauga Hall
77
wythes of brick of the exterior wall was evaluated by testing in the field. A calibrated hydraulic jack, anchored to the floor surface, was utilized to apply incremental loads. The average pullout force of less than 600 pounds indicated that satisfactory anchorage to the walls would require that the ties extend through the walls to be fastened to large washers placed on the exterior face of the building.
The New Structural System for Watauga Hall The rehabilitation of Watauga Hall was bid on December 5, 1983, with eight general contractors participating. The low bid for general construction was $1,440,550, with all bid alternates taken. The general, plumbing, electrical and mechanical low bid total was $2,016,209, or approximately 8 percent below the architect’s estimate. The new structural system selected for Watauga Hall consisted of a twoway flat-plate cast-in-place reinforced concrete slab supported by steel tube section columns with shear heads. The concrete slab was placed on the existing timber floor surface to be used as a temporary form. FIGURE 6-3 Column splices and shear heads were positioned at the existing floor level.
The steel columns were threaded through openings cut into the existing floors and braced prior to placing reinforcing and concrete. The existing timber joists were also supported with additional shoring placed at mid-span locations. The steel columns were carried down to new isolated column footings in the basement or crawl space.
78
Watauga Hall and the Montague Building
FIGURE 6-4 New steel columns were set on new isolated footings in the crawl space/basement.
Almost the entire suspended floor load for the renovated structure was supported by the steel columns, while the edge of the floor slab provided lateral bracing to the original exterior brick walls. Replacing the existing floor system with a two-way flat-plate structure had structural advantages in that a 6-inch-thick slab could easily support a 100 psf live load with the spans anticipated. An important advantage was the three-hour fire rating easily obtained between floors of the building to be used as a dormitory. The major construction advantage of this system is that once the columns, which are spliced with a simple connection at each floor level, are erected and braced, the other construction materials are easily fabricated and placed. Concrete placed for the floor slab can take any shape contained within the exterior walls without a lot of field measurements required to verify that fabricated components will actually fit into the space to be reframed. The typical reinforcing in the floor system consisted of straight #4 bars. Cast-in-place concrete was conveyed into the building by pumping. Construction was simple in the horizontal direction in that large prefabricated structural shapes, difficult to erect inside an existing building, were not required. Although accurate steel column placement was required for the new structural steel roof system to fit, perimeter dimensions between the columns and the periphery of the building were not critical. The most important advantage is that erection of a new structural system within the brick envelope did not require the complete “gutting” of the building,
Montague Building
79
which would have required the introduction of extensive temporary bracing and shoring to protect fragile, laterally unbraced exterior brick masonry walls. This reduced the risk to the contractor during construction. The major disadvantage with the flat plate structural system utilizing the existing floor as a form is that the new floor surface is 6 inches higher than the original floor surface. This changed the relationship of the floor level to architectural details, door heads, and fenestration. Construction was unique in that concrete placement proceeded from the upper levels downward. After each concrete slab reached the required strength, the timber sheathing and joists for that floor were removed as well as the load-bearing studs from the floor below. FIGURE 6-5 The load-bearing stud walls were stripped from the floor below after the slab above cured sufficiently.
This provided an unobstructed floor surface to be used as a form for the next floor below. The only vertical structural elements remaining at each floor level were the exterior masonry walls and the new steel columns. The structural solution selected for Watauga Hall was unique because it involved the systematic removal of the existing timber structure as the steel and concrete structural system was retrofitted.
MONTAGUE BUILDING A few years later, and across town, the 1912, three-story Montague Building was undergoing a $1.8 million renovation, the goal of which was to bring new
80
Watauga Hall and the Montague Building
life to a wood-framed office building that had been vacant for at least 15 years. The Montague Building is on the National Register of Historic Places. Located in the central business district of Raleigh, it had been the subject of several architectural and engineering analyses during prior years because of the potential value of leasible office space in the rapidly growing Sunbelt city. FIGURE 6-6 The south face of the Montague Building contained severely deteriorated brick masonry.
The three-story Montague Building was constructed in 1912. The first floor was divided into six retail bays with storefronts on the north side. The upper two floors were, for the most part, office space separated by a double-loaded central corridor. Architectural features included tin ceilings in all areas except the basement. Glass sidewalk prisms allowed natural light into the basement area on three sides of the building. The basement area extends to approximately 4 feet beyond the outside face of the building below the glass prism grates. The glass prisms on the north side had an unusual purple tint. The magnesium content of the glass prisms reacted with the ultraviolet rays in the sunlight to provide the purple color, according to information obtained from the Corning Glass Museum in Corning, New York. The builder of the Montague Building, Benjamin F. Montague, built in a developing section of downtown Raleigh, near the new City Sanitary Farmers Market and Tabernacle Baptist Church on Moore Square. It never reached its potential as an income producing property because Mr. Montague could not find enough satisfactory tenants.
Montague Building Structural System Reinforced
81
The upper floors of the Montague Building were used as office space until the 1950s. The lower retail bays were in use until the mid-1960s. Insufficient egress and the absence of a sprinkler system and a fire-rated floor system prevented the upper floors of the Montague Building from being used in more recent times.
MONTAGUE BUILDING STRUCTURAL SYSTEM REINFORCED On February 14, 1986, we forwarded the following report to the developer of the Montague Building: Based upon our observation on January 25, 1985, February 4, 1986, and several other times, we have performed a design analysis of the existing floor joists which frame the floor structure of the Montague Building. The Montague Building structural system is a three-story timber post and beam structure consisting of 6 ⫻ 6 timber columns, 8 ⫻ 10 beams and 1 5⁄8” ⫻ 11 5⁄8” timber joists, 12 inches on center, which span 19’-6” between frames. There is considerable deterioration of the structural system due to roof leaks. A fire damaged a portion of the floor system in the basement area in the east end of the building. Utilizing a dead load of 23 psf which includes the addition of one inch of Gypcrete topping, a sprinkler system, and a layer of sheetrock to the underside of the joists, it appears that the floor joists cannot safely support a live load of 50 psf in accordance with the 1978 edition of the NC State Building Code. Allowable live load for the floor joists was computed to be 36 psf. We utilized a modulus of elasticity of 1400 ksi and an allowable bending stress of 1400 psi for repetitive member use in accordance with the tabulated design values for Southern pine as found in the 1982 edition of the National Design Specification for Wood Construction. These values were modified by the test results of Froehling and Robertson, Inc. report number RM66-079 date February 1985. Froehling and Robertson’s geotechnical exploration and materials testing report indicates the following:
1. The basement floor slab is inadequate. The thickness of the basement floor slab is 3/4 to 1 ¼ inches. There is no vapor barrier beneath the slab. 2. The underlying soils are stiff, providing and allowable bearing capacity of 3,000 psf. The site is dry with the water table located probably at an elevation of 30 feet below grade.
82
Watauga Hall and the Montague Building
3. Pull-out tests of masonry anchors indicate that the existing masonry is quite soft with a low bearing capacity. The condition of the south wall is critical. Masonry deterioration due to water damage and the number of large window openings combine to make the south wall a critical structural element. 4. The six timber joists tested indicate that the existing floor joists are equivalent to No. 2 southern pine except in deflection. Note that the following minimum uniformly distributed live loads will require reinforcement or replacement of the structure in certain areas: • Office (fixed partitions) 50 psf • Office (movable partitions) 80 psf • Retail, first floor, 100 psf • Lobbies, office buildings, 100 psf • Corridors, above first floor, 80 psf • Business machine equipment, 100 psf • Library stack rooms, 150 psf • File Room, 80 psf • Rest Rooms, 60 psf • Public Rooms, 100 psf Also note that the 36 psf allowable live load for the Montague Building is less than most of the uniformly distributed live loads tabulated above. As in many historic buildings, modification to this structure will be necessitated by fire code requirements as well as the inability of the structure to support minimum required design live loads in all floor areas. Joists, columns, and beams are all undersized for minimum office occupancy live loads. We have made a full exploration of options resulting from an in-depth investigation which, in the judgment of this engineer, justifies structurally reconstructing the interior of the building.
After providing a detailed description of the new interior structural concrete flat-plate system that we proposed, we concluded our report with the following: Reinforcement of the very deficient structural system, in a building which has been vacated for 15 to 20 years, is a difficult, risky and costly endeavor. With no question, the existing structural system of the Montague Building should be replaced.
Montague Building Structural System Reinforced
83
It is hoped that the recommended structural solution will be seriously considered during the evaluation for integrity by the United State Department of Interior and that the 25% tax credit status will be maintained. We would not want the issue of the loss of tax credits to affect what we believe to be our best judgment as professional engineers when that decision affects the life, health, and safety of the public.
In the Montague Building, this same system of flat-plate concrete slabs and steel columns could have been used to an advantage in that the original noteworthy tin ceilings could have been reinstalled at their proper elevations, close to the existing window heads, while the space previously occupied by the flooring, subfloor, and joists could have accommodated mechanical ducts. In order to accomplish this, the tin ceiling would be taken down, cleaned, paint primed, stored, and then reinstalled on a ceiling framing system suspended from the completed concrete floor structure above. The original structural system for the Montague Building was a three-story post and beam structure consisting of 8 ⫻ 8 timber columns, 8 ⫻ 10 beams, and 2 ⫻ 12 timber joists, spaced at 12 inches on center. Considerable deterioration to the timber structural system was due to roof leaks and fire damage. Although I recommended the flat-plate concrete structure with steel columns for the Montague Building, the developer argued that the replacement of the existing structure would jeopardize the 25 percent tax credit incentive for a certified rehabilitation. The reinforcement of the existing structure of the Montague Building for minimum office occupancy live loads required the reinforcement of every joist and every floor beam. The floor beams were reinforced by applying steel side angles to the outside face of each member with hardened annular threaded, ring shank nails. Reinforcing the joists required the application of a composite metal cover plate to the underside of all joists. The design of this reinforcing was based on transformed section combining the wood joists with the steel cover plate acting in tension. To ensure composite action, the installation of the straps required the contractor to jack the joists above level and fasten the straps to the underside of the joists in a sequential and symmetrical manner starting from mid-span of the joists. The carpenters were less than happy, having to drive thousands of screws, overhead, into the underside of the joists using 1980s-era (very heavy) screw guns. Two types of screws were tested at the North Carolina State University Department of Wood and Paper Science Laboratory to obtain reliable design values in shear for the threaded fasteners. Thirteen assemblies were prepared using 14 gauge by 2-inch-long slotted hexhead screws. Twelve specimens were assembled with 14 gauge by 1 ¾-inch hexhead self-tapping screws. The specimens were fabricated by the general
84
Watauga Hall and the Montague Building
contractor under jobsite conditions using wood samples from the Montague Building and then transported to the laboratory. The tapping screws were selected based on test results and ease of installation.
GEOTECHNICAL EVALUATIONS Testing of the existing building components prior to design was a part of the structural assessment for both the Montague Building and Watauga Hall. Subsurface evaluation at each building included test (or observation) pits dug by hand to establish footing depth and configuration, hand auger borings, and test borings drilled with a truck mounted drill rig. Geotechnical testing at Watauga Hall consisted of seven standard penetration test borings drilled to a depth of 25 feet, one hand-auger boring drilled in the crawl space to a depth of 10 feet, and five test pits dug around the perimeter of the building. With respect to underlying geology, both Watauga Hall and the Montague Building are located in the Piedmont physiographic province of Wake County, North Carolina. The in-place chemical weathering of the mica gneiss of the parent bedrock has produced an upper mantel of residual soils with clayey soils confined to the upper stratum. For the Montague Building, a total of six hand-auger borings with dynamic cone penetration tests ranging 2 to 8 feet in depth were made in the basement area. Eight test pits were hand excavated to determine footing configuration, elevation, dimensions, and soil consistence immediately below the footing base. To the exterior of the building, a truck-mounted drill rig was used to advance borings made in accordance with ASTM Specification D-1586 utilizing a hollow stem auger. Soil samples were obtained with a split-barrel sampler driven to a depth of 18 inches or to a blow count of 100 blows with a 100-pound hammer falling 30 inches. The standard penetration resistance N, denoting the number of blows per foot, is an indication of the in-place density strength and foundation support capacity. The soil samples were placed in glass jars, sealed, transported, and visually classified in accordance with ASTM D-2488. In the basement, where access was prohibited to the truck-mounted drilling machine, hand augers were utilized. Handheld penetration testing was performed through the augured holes with a portable dynamic cone electrometer which utilizes a 15-pound steel ring weight falling 20 inches on an “E” rod slide guide. The blows for 1 ¾-inch increments were recorded. These cone resistance values were correlated to the standard penetration values to
Timber Materials Evaluation
85
determine the stiffness of the underlying soils. At the time, the use of the portable dynamic cone penetrometer had shown to be most reliable in four geologic regions, including the sandy or clayey sandy micaceous silts of the Piedmont geologic province of the southeastern United States. In addition, relatively undisturbed soil samples were obtained by hydraulically forcing sections of 3-inch diameter, 16-gauge steel, thin wall, or Shelby tube samplers into the soil at desired sampling levels. The samples were removed in the laboratory by a hydraulically operated extrusion press, measured, sampled in accordance with ASTM D-1587, “Standard Method for ThinWalled Tube Sampling of Soils.” The tabulated laboratory test data for the various soil samples included the percentage of natural moisture, Atterberg limits, grain size analysis, the unified soil classification, and a cyclic shear stress versus strain curve for one sample. I requested that the Raleigh office of Froehling & Robertson, Inc. provide materials testing and geotechnical exploration for both Watauga Hall and the Montague Building. Included were geotechnical exploration as well as wood and masonry materials testing. The geotechnical exploration consisted of borings, test pits, and laboratory analysis. The two geotechnical evaluations indicated that the Montague Building and Watauga Hall were both constructed on underlying soils that were stiff, providing a bearing capacity of 3,000 psf. Both sites were dry, with the water table located at an elevation of 30 feet or more below grade
TIMBER MATERIALS EVALUATION Evaluation of the timber joists in the Montague Building required the sampling of six full-length joists selected at random. Field-obtained moisture meter readings were compared with the oven-dried moisture content measurements made in the laboratory on 4-inch square samples in accordance with ASTM D-2016. Tabulated data included specific gravity measured in accordance with ASTM D-2395, annual timber growth rings per inch, of the slope of grain, unit weight of the timber samples, and cross-sectional dimensions of each sample. The 2 ⫻ 12 timber joists were tested to failure in a laboratory utilizing a calibrated hydraulic jack that applied a concentrated load at the midpoint of an 11-foot span. The load was applied in 500-pound increments and deflection was recorded to the nearest .001 of an inch utilizing an Ames Dial Deflectometer. Although the timber samples were visually classified as one of the seven species of southern pine with a grade equal to a high quality No. 2, the test results indicated that the actual stiffness of this material was less than expected.
86
Watauga Hall and the Montague Building
The average modulus of elasticity of five samples tested was 1,395,600 psi or approximately 7 percent less than the published modulus of elasticity used for No. 2 southern pine at the time the tests were conducted.
TAX CREDITS The potential loss of historic integrity and the subsequent loss of tax credits in the latter stages of a project could prove disastrous to a developer. A structural engineer’s report should represent a full exploration of options for structurally reconstituting the building. In exercising professional judgment, the designers should consult with the reviewing agency to determine the acceptability of the various options as they relate to historically significant features. The tax status of the Montague Building was retained because the reinforcement option was selected. It appears that if the preferred structural solution for the Montague Building had been a suspended two-way concrete floor slab, the project would have been decertified and not eligible for preservation tax incentives. Although there is a need to develop methods of evaluating the probable service life of structural solutions, we must also be able to identify the other decision-making factors inherent in rehabilitating buildings. Designers must walk a narrow path with regard to renovation options so as to not cause the decertification of a historic property and the loss of tax credits. They must deal sensitively with the feeling of the building so as not to destroy the quality of the building that evokes an aesthetic or historic sense of a past period of time. This feeling may depend on the presence of surviving physical characteristics such as timber-framed floors or exposed roof trusses. Historic authenticity can be lost through extensive replacement of historic material and cannot be recaptured by reconstruction with new material in the rehabilitation. The U.S. Department of Interior has issued interim guidelines for evaluating deteriorated building in order to amplify previously published National Park Service requirements and guidance for the Preservation Tax Incentives Program. How will the serviceability of the reinforced Montague Building compare with the restructured Watauga Hall? The steel and concrete structure within Watauga Hall is a complete structural system supported by new column footings, while the three-story reinforced wood frame of the Montague Building is supported on its original corbelled brick and rubble stone fill column footings and exterior brick masonry walls. The Montague Building is an example of a project in which the original structural system was reinforced in order to meet minimum design load requirements.
Subsequent Flat-Plate Applications
87
I proposed a solution similar to the successful flat-plate system used for Watauga Hall, but it was rejected by the owner. The State Historic Preservation officer did not render a clear judgment with regard to the acceptability of the proposed concrete floor system. Although the general contractor preferred the flat-plate approach, sufficiently accurate cost estimates of the two alternate systems were not generated prior to construction. Clearly, our preservation philosophies need to recognize the potential liability inherent in the difficult decisions made by design professionals such as structural engineers. Aesthetics weighs heavily in the decision-making process utilized by governmental agencies administering tax act preservation projects. A solution that requires the designer to reinforce a marginal timber structure, rather than replace the structure with a new system, involves additional risk to the owner, designer, and contractor. The structural engineer is responsible for the structural adequacy for the renovated building through its service life no matter the solution. Reinforcing a structure requires utilization of existing materials, which may not be reliable. The reinforcement of existing structures is more difficult, requiring innovative solutions. When the renovation of a building requires reinforcing of the existing structure, adequate testing of the existing materials is critical. Unfortunately, it is not always possible for the structural engineer to make the best decision with regard to future serviceability and building safety. Constraints imposed by owners and lenders, eager to obtain tax credits, may sway an engineer toward the solution of meeting minimum code requirements for the short term. Success of an historic preservation project depends on many related and unrelated factors. The engineering judgment of the structural engineer should be given considerable weight in making decisions that affect the desired result. Time will tell which solution was best. At the present time, Watauga Hall is fully occupied, limiting space to graduate-level students based on an application process. The Montague Building now houses Café Luna, several offices, and a branch office of a large consulting engineering firm.
SUBSEQUENT FLAT-PLATE APPLICATIONS I have recommended that use of the existing floor framing as a form to support a two-way cast-in-place flat-plate system on five occasions. We used it for the Garrett Hotel in Ahoskie, North Carolina, and more recently with great success at the Eagle Block Hotel in Newport, New Hampshire.
88
Watauga Hall and the Montague Building
FIGURE 6-7 Floors were replaced in the Eagle Block (ca. 1835) in similar fashion to Watauga Hall. (See color insert.)
The structural system utilizes the existing wood-framed floor structure as a form for a flat-plate (two-way) concrete floor system. Steel-tube section columns on isolated spread footings support the concrete floor slabs. These are installed and braced prior to placement of concrete. Shear heads transfer the floor loads to the steel columns at each level. Cast-in-place perimeter angles connect the concrete floor slabs to the exterior masonry walls. There are many advantages to this structural system for a renovation such as this. The most important advantage is that the existing floor system can be used as formwork. It is not necessary to deal with tall, unbraced masonry walls during construction. The Concrete Reinforcing Steel Institute states the following advantages of a flat-plate structural system: The two-way flat plate is one of the most efficient structural systems for economy. Flat plates can be constructed in minimum time with minimum field labor because the flat plate utilizes the simplest possible formwork and reinforcing steel layout. Flat plates result in minimum story height for required clear headroom, and provide for most flexibility in layout of columns, partitions, small openings, etc. Where job requirements permit direct application of the ceiling finish to the flat plate soffit, elimination of ceiling construction permits additional substantial cost and construction time savings compared to other structural systems. Flat plates have become increasingly economical and widely used as the cost of field labor has increased relative to materials.
Subsequent Flat-Plate Applications
89
They have been applied with particular advantage to multi-story motel, hotel, hospital, dormitory, and apartment buildings 1
As in many historic buildings, modification to the Eagle Block Hotel was necessitated by fire code requirements, as well as the inability by the structure to support minimum required design live loads in certain areas. There are many advantages of a solid two-way flat-plate concrete floor system for the renovation of historic structures. The use of a flat-plate system enables the contractor to utilize the existing floor framing and sheathing as formwork and existing load-bearing walls as shoring. Steps in this process would be as follows: 1. Remove of plaster and millwork from the interior stud walls and ceilings. 2. Construct interior column footings and erect new steel columns with shear heads through the existing floors. 3. Brace the steel columns and apply additional shoring and bracing to the formwork and original structure as needed. 4. Install continuous shelf angles with masonry and concrete tie systems between the perimeter of the flat slab and the existing exterior masonry wall. 5. Place reinforcing steel on the upper level floor structure. The process of setting reinforcing steel, and placing the slab, proceeds, by stages, downward until all levels are in place. At all times the structure is laterally braced by existing or new floor systems. Removal of original vertical supports proceeds from the top floor downward as each concrete slab above reaches sufficient strength. A flat-plate system works well in historic buildings because of the short spans involved. A flat-plate system gives considerable flexibility to the contractor with regard to actual field dimensions that can be a problem when utilizing a framing system of shop-fabricated components. Rectangular or odd bays of varying dimensions can be easily accommodated. The advantages of pumped concrete can also be utilized. This will minimize the amount of vertical floor load transferred by the floor system to the existing walls by providing for cantilevers wherever possible. Usually the use of a flat-plate system eliminates the need for a fire-rated ceiling or spray-on fireproofing. The south wall of the Eagle Block Hotel in Newport, New Hampshire, had a considerable bow in it that had been reinforced early in its history by bolting
90
Watauga Hall and the Montague Building
two channels to the outside face of the wall. We described how the steel and concrete system could be used to pull the south wall into alignment so that the existing reinforcing channels could be removed. When the contractor priced this operation as an add alternate of $150,000, it was very quickly deleted from the project by the developer as too costly. In conclusion, the two-way flat-plate system provides a structural system to accommodate the requirements of a modern building without the risk of working within an open masonry shell requiring considerable temporary bracing. This structural system will satisfy all floor live-load and fire-separation requirements. The existing timber roof and attic framing systems can remain in place, as they did at the Eagle Block.
REFERENCE 1. Concrete Reinforcing Steel Institute (CRSI). CRSI Design Handbook, 9th ed. Schaumburg, IL: Concrete Reinforcing Steel Institute, 2002.
BIBLIOGRAPHY Froehling & Robertson, Inc., “Subsurface Exploration & Materials Testing of Watauga Hall,” Report #RJ66-179, July 9, 1982. Froehling & Robertson, Inc., “Supplementary Report, Watauga Hall Renovation,” July 23, 1982. Froehling & Robertson, Inc., “Geotechnical Exploration and Materials Testing of the Montague Building,” Report #RM66-079, February 11, 1985. Froehling & Robertson, Inc., “Tension Test, Restoration of the Montague Building,” Report #RN66-195, June 11, 1986. United States Department of the Interior, National Park Service, Interagency Resources and Reservation Assistance Divisions and Office of the Solicitor, “Interim Guidance on Evaluating Damaged/Deteriorated Buildings in Registered Historic Districts for Purposes of the Preservation Tax Incentives Program.” U.S. Forest Products Laboratory, Wood Handbook: Wood as an Engineering Material, (Washington, DC: USDA Agr. Handbk. 72, Rev. 1974).
CHAPTER
7
The Restoration of St. Helena’s Church
he restoration of St. Helena’s Episcopal Church in Beaufort, South Carolina (1724), grew out of a preliminary structural evaluation we provided regarding the deterioration of one end of one queenpost roof truss. The deterioration occurred next to a sidewall chimney flue, which penetrated the roof. A leak in the vicinity of this roof penetration caused severe deterioration to the heel of one of the roof trusses where the top and bottom chords engage each other at the sidewall bearing point. Shortly after the completion of the structural report regarding the roof truss, George T. Fore, Materials Conservator of Raleigh, North Carolina, was engaged by the vestry to study the exterior of the church. Concerns raised in George Fore’s November 1994 “Conditions Analysis and Conservation Studies” report became the focus of additional study and debate.1 They included a question regarding settlement of the sidewalls due to the bearing capacity of the underlying soils. Planned repair of the roof trusses based on the 1993 study needed to be expanded to include repairs to individual truss connections in other locations and the lateral support of some individual truss members that had bowed out of alignment.
T
Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
91
92
The Restoration of St. Helena’s Church
FIGURE 7-1 The end of one queenpost truss was badly deteriorated.
Fore pointed out that tower work including repair of millwork, the bell support frame, and miscellaneous bracing of several elements was also required. Replacement of the Portland cement stucco at the base of exterior walls with a lime based stucco was identified in the Fore report as a task sensitive to seasonal changes in temperature. Stucco repairs required in areas affected by structural repairs to the truss would be a part of the stucco portion of a large construction contract anticipated by the vestry. In 1997, we provided a more thorough structural evaluation of the masonry and timber structure, including tabby foundations, balcony, framing, steeple, and roof structure, based on information obtained on April 7 and 8, 1997. We also included additional findings based on our inspection with George Fore in August 1994 and our previous work in 1993 with regard to the roof trusses. We described repairs that emphasized the use of traditional materials compatible with the original construction. In this way, the interaction of dissimilar materials would not be an issue. We pointed out that the use of reinforced concrete, structural steel, and epoxy-reinforcing methods have all been shown to result in less than perfect structural systems when combined with timber, brick masonry, and lime-based stuccos and mortars. By utilizing traditional materials, a certain sensitivity is achieved that is more in the spirit of The Secretary of the Interior’s Standards for Rehabilitation and Guidelines for Rehabilitating
Roof Trusses
93
Historic Buildings. We argued that building systems such as St. Helena’s Church can be made structurally sound by applying the usual engineering principles to those materials and the existing building geometry.
DESCRIPTION St. Helena’s Episcopal Church is a building with a timber-framed roof, balcony, and second-floor level supported on load-bearing brick masonry exterior walls and interior timber columns. The main floor is framed with joists that run across in the transverse direction. The major expansions to the original 1724 building was an 1817 reconstruction of the sanctuary in brick and a large side balcony expansion in 1842, which included sidewalls, balconies, and a new roof structure, resulting in a sanctuary plan approximately 66 feet square with projections at each end for a narthex and sacristy. The steeple was rebuilt in 1940. A steel structural system was added to the steeple at that time. The underframing and platforms of the side balconies were reworked in 1969 to accommodate air-conditioning ducts.
OBSERVATION In August 1994 we measured a relative humidity of 72.3 percent and a temperature of 76.3˚F inside the church at the balcony level. The principle balcony beams 8 by 11 inches in size had a moisture content of 10 percent. We observed the framing of the bell tower and revisited the attic to observe the condition of the queenpost trusses. We observed the condition of the steel beam above the choir loft.
ROOF TRUSSES The condition of the roof-framing system had not changed since our previous inspection. We concentrated our efforts in determining the condition of the exterior load-bearing walls that supported the balconies and roof trusses. We verified overall dimensions and wall thickness. It was determined that, based on marriage marks, the truss numbers ran from I to VI. Upon closer examination, it appeared that the roof trusses had suffered some recent wind damage. Besides the repairs to truss number IV, which had a deteriorated bottom chord, there were other members and connections that deserved attention.
94
The Restoration of St. Helena’s Church
FIGURE 7-2 At this time the roof structure appeared unchanged from our previous visit.
BALCONIES In August 1994, with Mr. B.J. Pinckney of the church, George Fore and I opened the sidewall balcony framing for observation by removing some boards. We were able to observe the condition of the bearing seat at the upper end of the balcony framing beams. The principal framing of the balconies consisted of sloped 8-inch by 11-inch timbers that ran from the interior columns to the exterior wall where they rested on a 10 ¼- by 10 ½-inch sill plate supported and enveloped by the exterior wall. The exterior sidewalls had deformed outward over time. The maximum movement was at the balcony sill beam level. George Fore’s report showed that the maximum horizontal deformation of the wall was 2 5⁄8 inches on the north side and 3 9⁄16 inches on the south side. A horizontal crack had formed that ran along the full length of the sidewall, except at the ends where the masonry was tied back into the corners of the building. The great concern with regard to the adequacy of the balconies was based on the deformation shown in George Fore’s report. Two disturbing possibilities were put forward by others regarding this movement. First, the underlying soils might be overstressed, allowing the sidewalls to settle and rotate about the toe of the footing. This appeared to be a possibility because of the settlement observed in the floor joists and the door openings in endwalls, which had deformed into a
Balconies
95
FIGURE 7-3 The balcony framing was exposed for additional examination.
FIGURE 7-4 The horizontal cracks in the sidewalls had been patched many times.
parallelogram shape indicating movement of the sides of the nave down in a vertical direction. The second explanation was that the sloping balconies themselves were exerting pressure on the exterior walls, causing them to crack at the balcony level and forcing the now-hinged wall to rotate outward. A sloped end condition would tend to push the exterior wall outward because
96
The Restoration of St. Helena’s Church
FIGURE 7-5 The sidewalls appeared to have settled, although diagonal settlement cracks were not visible.
there would be a horizontal component of the beam reaction normal to the bearing surface. The masonry wall is 27 inches thick below the balcony sill beam. If the beam was installed green, shrinkage would have occurred across the grain as much as a quarter of an inch. A small amount of shrinkage at the sill could act as a notch, causing a hinged effect in the masonry wall. The eccentricity of the notch, combined with rotation at the top of the wall due to truss defection, would be sufficient to cause the amount of rotation that was observed in the wall. This, I determined, was the principal mechanism causing the balcony wings to rotate away from the building. It was significant that the horizontal crack is located at the thinnest portion of the masonry wall at the top of the sill beam.
Balconies
97
FIGURE 7-6 The 10 ⴛ 10 sills embedded in the masonry sidewalls were somewhat decayed.
One of the two balcony beams observed had a sloped bearing surface at upper end rather than a horizontally cut seat. The stucco at the “hinge” in the exterior wall had been patched several times. This indicated that the movement of the wall had been progressive over time. In the computer, the north and south sidewalls were modeled as an integral part of the building cross-section. We utilized a low modulus of elasticity of 350,000 psi for the brick masonry. Assumed allowable design values for the masonry are as follows: • Compressive strength, 56 psi • Bearing, 100 psi • Shear, 9 psi The 12-foot spacing of the building cross-section modeled in the computer included one roof truss, a bay of balcony framing, and the masonry sidewalls with window openings. Overall building stability in the cross-section appeared tenuous, except for the balcony acting as a deep horizontal beam fastened to the endwalls. In the analysis we included the horizontal contribution of the balcony as a spring support based on the stiffness of the plywood sheathing on the balcony steps. There was evidence that the balcony, with its considerable plywood sheathing,
98
The Restoration of St. Helena’s Church
was performing well in that there was no cracking of the plaster ceiling under the balcony. Of course, all of the lateral loads applied to the sidewalls needed to be resolved through the balcony sheathing, roof sheathing, and ceiling framing into the endwalls of the nave. I argued that through jacking, the exterior wall could be forced back into alignment. In order to do this, both the balcony and roof loads would have to be temporarily relieved and the sidewall temporarily braced. All mortar joints that had opened over time and have been filled, in the vicinity of the fold, would have to be raked out in order to reverse the alignment. The gap above the balcony sill would have to be filled and the end of the balcony beam flat cut, blocked, or tied in where the sloped bearing conditions exist. The balcony sill beam would have to be replaced where deteriorated, with a dry timber that would not shrink over time.
TOWER The tower was rebuilt in 1940 in accordance with architectural drawings by architect Albert Simmons of Charleston. The 1940 architectural tracings (drawings) for the tower were stored in the Fireproof Building in Charleston in flat files. The tower as built included wood siding on diagonal sheathing on wood studs attached to a steel framing system. FIGURE 7-7 The bell tower was reframed in 1940 with wood on a steel frame.
Church Garden Wall
99
The steel frame provided great rigidity to the steeple up to the transition level where the framing changes to timber. The bell support system appeared to be much older than the 1940s work. The new tower structure was apparently designed to accommodate the geometry of the bell and its framing system. The lantern and spire sections were framed in timber in a configuration similar to St. Michael’s in Charleston. The west side of the tower rested on two cast-in-place concrete blocks supported by the original west wall. The east side of the tower rested on a 30-inch-deep steel beam that spanned the masonry opening between the narthex and the nave. Critical to the bell tower were loading conditions that included northsouth wind, which would tend to place unbalanced loads onto the supporting wall or the W30 beam. Wind in the east-west direction would impose the greatest total load on the 30-inch-deep steel beam. In the computer analysis of the tower, we applied a 120 mph wind in accordance with ASCE-7, except that a shape factor of 0.8 was used for the spire and lantern levels. The bell and bell frame were included as a 1,500-pound load. The analysis was performed in the north-south and east-west directions. The calculations indicated that the steel structure was rigid and that most of the movement in the spire is a result of the open lantern level. Diagonal sheathing was simulated in the timber-framed portion of the steeple to provide a reasonable amount of rigidity. A theoretical deflection of 4 ½ inches at the top of the spire was calculated with these assumptions. The 30-inch-deep steel beam, steel tower legs, and the steel cross-bracing appeared to be adequate in size. Critical to the performance of the steeple in a 120 mph wind load was its anchorage to the top of the outside wall and the anchorage of the 30-inch-deep steel beam to the inside wall on either side of the choir loft. The 22,000 pounds of resistance to hold the steeple legs down could be achieved by assuring that the tie-down points contained a minimum of 150 cubic feet of concrete, or 225 cubic feet of brick masonry. The bearing pressures at all support points were adequate as long as each location has 240 square inches of contact against the brick. The uplift capacity of the steeple could be enhanced by rebuilding the beam and tower bearing points with a compatible but harder brick rather than concrete and facilitating a tie that engages at least 225 cubic feet of masonry.
CHURCH GARDEN WALL The church property is surrounded by a brick wall that defines the perimeter of the block that contains the sanctuary and churchyard. This free-standing brick wall contains portions built at various times. Differences in grade causing
100
The Restoration of St. Helena’s Church
lateral earth pressure and pressure from trees have pushed the wall out of alignment. The wall contains settlement and temperature cracks, as well as shear cracks at various locations. At the time of our inspection, mortar was missing or deteriorated in areas, and bricks were deteriorated, broken, or missing. Unsuitable repairs with Portland cement mortar and stucco had been made. We recommended that a tree survey that notes not only species, size, condition, and location, but also location in regard to present or potential damage to the church wall or monuments be undertaken. This would require the services of an architect, landscape architect, structural engineer, and materials conservator working together. The condition of the garden wall varied greatly along its length and required various types of repairs.
MASONRY The masonry of the existing walls of the church consisted of a lime-based mortar and oversized bricks. The bricks appeared to be of medium hardness and the mortar medium to soft. The interior plaster and exterior stucco served to provide a finish, while protecting the wall on the exterior from the weather. Historic walls with plaster on the inside surface tend to provide better service than unplastered walls. In an unplastered wall, mortar joints tend to deteriorate at a more rapid rate with a loss of bond within the lime mortar causing the sand component to spill from the joints. Obviously, even with deterioration of mortar joints in a plastered wall, the sand component would be contained. Deterioration in a masonry wall with a plaster finish will eventually be obvious, as the plaster will crack and separate from the face of the brick wall as the wall disintegrates. In contrast, at St. Helena’s we had a building in which the existing interior plaster was well bonded to the brick walls except at a few notable locations. The service life of lime-based mortar in historic walls is dependent on the structure remaining relatively dry. The roof of St. Helena’s had been well maintained, and the crawl space was dry. The soil beneath St. Helena’s consisted of well-drained light gray or brown sands and clayey sands. In August 1995, S&ME, a geotechnical firm from Mt. Pleasant, South Carolina, reported that the water table was at 15 feet below the ground surface. Historic lime-based masonry walls can be reinforced after construction by installing pencil rod or all thread rods reinforcing into horizontal masonry joints during deep repointing. In this manner, common thermal stress cracks can be “stitched” back together at locations such as above the numerous window openings in St. Helena’s. Such stitch reinforcing, although disruptive to walls covered with plaster or stucco, work well in repairing cracks in masonry walls that have been troublesome for many years.
Masonry
101
In the past, we have also applied metal lath to historic masonry walls as a reinforcing procedure, which when plastered, acts to seal the mortar joints from extremes in moisture and temperature. The wall over the Chancel arch at St. Philip’s in Charleston was treated in this manner. Besides serving to structurally tie the wall together and bridge cracks, this system provides a “tell-tale” system to indicate future movement in the wall. The inside faces of the interior walls of one wing of the circa 1903 Kivett Hall at Campbell University, in Buie’s Creek, North Carolina, were covered with metal lath and plaster in 1976. During a recent inspection, no cracks were observed in these walls, which consisted of interior wythes of very soft brick and lime mortar. The large cracks in the endwalls of the nave of St. Helena’s Church resulted from an inadequate masonry tie between sections of walls built at various times.
FIGURE 7-8 Very little bonding connected walls built at various times.
The large cracks beneath the 30-inch-deep steel beam were the result of just such a discontinuity due to faulty construction. To properly “tooth” a wall together requires that the original and new bricks match in size, that the addition courses with the original, and that sufficient skill and effort is expended to ensure that as many of the original bricks are engaged by the new brickwork. In the large crack that was exposed between the walls constructed at different times, only one tie brick was observed. The joint between wall sections was quite wide, indicating that the tendency of the balconies to move outward
102
The Restoration of St. Helena’s Church
could not be restrained across the joint. The wildly random coursing of the brick in the two sections of wall could be corrected by reworking a sufficient width of masonry to obtain coursing, or by stitching across the crack with joint reinforcing. The clay tile in the east and west gable walls of the attic obviously did not course with previous brick masonry when used to rebuild gable ends blown out by a storm.
FIGURE 7-9 The gable walls were rebuilt in 1940 with clay tile instead of brick masonry.
This material was used because it is light, economical, and a popular method of construction in the 1940s. We recommended that the clay tile be replaced with brick units to match the original in size.
PLASTER AND STUCCO Traditional plaster and stucco applied to brick masonry is an excellent “telltale” system for crack evaluation. Any discontinuity or crack that causes movement will telegraph through the plaster or stucco system. The history of a crack can be determined by observing its progression in historic photographs and evaluating the materials used as crack fillers in the past. The fine cracks in the sidewalls above the windows were, for the most part, thermal in nature, typical
Subsurface Evaluation
103
of cracks in eighteenth and nineteenth century un-reinforced brick masonry walls with large window openings. Most of the sidewall cracks in St. Helena’s were thin hairline cracks. They were observed to be running in a vertical direction usually above or near window head locations. These cracks were located above most of the windows in the sidewalls of the nave.
TABBY Tabby is an early cast-in-place construction material consisting of sand, lime (from shells and wood ash), and water. The foundations of the 1842 addition to St. Helena’s consist of a 26-inch-deep unreinforced footing of tabby on which rested the brick masonry walls. The original foundation walls are of brick construction extending to a greater depth than the foundations of the addition. Because of its relatively low strength, tabby performs well when uniformly loaded. The support of a post or beam is problematic when concentrated loads are not distributed such as on a wood plate or brick masonry-bearing block. The computed design pressure for the combined dead load and live load of 6.8 psi was low when compared to the 350 psi compressive strength obtained by Sickels-Taves. In St. Helena’s we had a fairly uniform load. There were no cracks in the sidewalls related to settlement caused by failure in the tabby.
SUBSURFACE EVALUATION To determine the nature and consistency of underlying soils in the vicinity of the exterior wall, in 1994 we requested that the S&ME office in Charleston provide a proposal to the church for a geotechnical investigation and analysis consisting of borings, small test pits and laboratory analysis. S&ME’s proposal was accepted and field exploration occurred in August of 1995. The purpose of the soils investigation was to determine the amount of settlement that had occurred, its cause, and how much future settlement was anticipated. We also wanted to determine the probable response of the underlying soils during a seismic event. S&ME’s subsurface exploration Report No. 1131-95-034 dated August 18, 1995, presented the results of the exploration and analysis. We were in contact with Billy Camp, P.E. of S&ME, during this procedure and also consulted with George Fore prior to, and after, obtaining the results from S&ME. The purpose of the exploration work was to determine the nature and consistency of the soils directly below the balcony sidewalls of the church and the configuration of the wall at the bearing elevation. It was thought by others that this might explain the outward rotation of the walls. The question of whether
104
The Restoration of St. Helena’s Church
the movement was due to settlement or rotation in loose or unconsolidated soils was important to answer because foundation underpinning solutions are very expensive. The results of the settlement analysis indicated that the supporting soils are sands that are relatively dense. Settlement occurred during construction as load was gradually applied. The report concluded that there is no reason to believe that the foundation soils have caused ongoing settlement. In the report, S&ME proposed that a 1,500 psf allowable bearing pressure be used for design. This compared well with the calculated wall loads. At this point, we discarded underpinning as a part of the work. Monitoring was recommended to study the problem further. The results of a monitoring program would indicate whether the movement shows seasonal fluctuations due to temperature or moisture changes. This would determine how active the hinge point was. The crack and wall movement was an indication of a problem. As long as the balcony remained attached, there was no danger of collapse due to vertical loads. The weakened (open) horizontal joint was a possible problem with regard to high wind forces acting outward on the exterior wall.
SEISMIC ANALYSIS Previous comments by other structural engineers had raised the level of concern in the congregation with regard to seismic safety. As a result of those discussions, we included in the evaluation report a rather extensive discussion of seismic issues affecting St. Helena’s. We insisted that several broad questions be asked before we would recommend or adopt a complicated or excessive seismic mitigation. First, what is the risk of injury, death, or property damage in Beaufort due to a seismic event? Second, how much would seismic provisions add to the cost of rehabilitating St. Helena’s? Third, what were the current requirements of the state and federal building codes with regard to seismic reinforcing and repairs to historic structures? From this, it was apparent that the risk of death or injury in a seismic event for a person in St. Helena’s Church is extremely small. Although the building code required that higher seismic factors be used when reviewing an assembly type building such as St. Helena’s, which seats 300 or more people in one room, in reality the building is fully occupied for only a very few hours each week. As part of the geotechnical analysis, we asked S&ME to review the
Liquefaction
105
potential for the liquefaction of the soils underlying St. Helena’s in a seismic event because the greatest amount of damage is often caused by the subsidence of masonry buildings on soils as occurred in Kobe, Japan, and in nearby Charleston in 1886. To enhance the wind and seismic capacity of St. Helena’s, the exterior walls could be rehabilitated by repairing cracks. The balcony floor and roof framing had to be securely anchored to the exterior walls. Repairs had to include a positive anchorage to all of the exterior walls in accordance with the “Bolts-Plus” philosophy of seismic reinforcing. This method of seismic reinforcing relies on traditional methods to tie building elements together. The seismic (and wind) resistance of a building can be greatly enhanced by simply providing a positive connection between the floor and roof framing and the exterior walls. The earthquake anchor, developed in Charleston as a result of the 1886 earthquake, is an example of a “Bolts-Plus” type seismic repair. For “Bolts-Plus” to work, we insisted that deteriorated masonry and timber be repaired.
LIQUEFACTION Liquefaction, the loss of a soil’s shear strength due to the increase in water pore pressure resulting from seismic vibrations, is always a concern in the Charleston area. Liquefiable soils are commonly found in South Carolina, and much of the geological evidence suggests that liquefaction has occurred during past earthquakes. The potential for liquefaction depends on the nature of the soils, groundwater potential, and the magnitude of the earthquake. Using standard methods of analyzing liquefaction, based on the seismic risk of the Beaufort area, the probability of liquefaction or the liquefaction potential for a given exposure time can be predicted. The amount of ground settlement due to liquefaction can also be predicted. The S&ME report indicated that assuming an earthquake magnitude of about 5.9 and a base acceleration of 0 to 12g, the liquefaction potential of the underlying soils beneath St. Helena’s was within acceptable limits. Based on the above assumptions, factors of safety against liquefaction were calculated for the potentially liquefiable deposits. Standard Penetration data (N values) from the soil test borings indicated that the factors of safety were greater than 1.5 and, consequently, the risk of liquefaction would be acceptable by today’s standards. The report concluded that some densification of the loose sands above the water table, and therefore settlement, could occur during an earthquake even without liquefaction.
106
The Restoration of St. Helena’s Church
The liquefaction potential can be reduced in one of six ways: base isolation, deep foundations, drainage wells, chemical grouting, jet grouting, or compaction grouting. These methods range in cost from the most expensive to the least expensive. The first two are structural modifications to the foundation of the building; the others affect the subsoils. At that time, recent experience from the West Coast indicated that seismic events varied to such a degree that predicting the response of a building that has been modified or that rests on remedied soils was almost impossible. Since the costs for mediation were high and the benefits unpredictable, a reasonable solution was to not do anything if the potential for liquefaction and the amount of settlement was determined to be tolerable. Damage from a major seismic event can be controlled by ensuring that wall and floor systems are tied together and masonry is contained and reinforced. In this manner, settlement due to liquefaction can be tolerated and structural stability does not depend on soils mediation or foundation modification. In fact, the summary of S&ME’s report concluded that the underlying soils were resistant to liquefaction, and that modification to the foundation was not necessary. Based on the soil conditions encountered at the site, there was no reason to believe that the foundation soils were settling. However, settlement would be expected if the foundation loads or soil stresses were increased. Consequently, from a geotechnical standpoint, ground modification or foundation underpinning was not necessary.
RECOMMENDATIONS Based on our analysis, and by applying engineering judgment relating to other historic structures such as St. Helena’s, we offered the following recommendations for the building committee and vestry to consider: • The sidewalls of the building should be jacked into a vertical alignment and the masonry reworked, reducing the eccentricity of the wall and increasing the net section of the masonry at the critical juncture with the balcony while reestablishing vertical continuity. At the same time, the balconies should be securely tied into the masonry sidewalls in a manner often referred to as “bolts-plus” reinforcing. This will require the installation of a new balcony header sill in accordance with sketches enclosed with our report. • Roof truss number IV should be repaired by replacing the deteriorated lower chord. This will require the shoring of the curved plaster ceiling
Recommendations
107
and ceiling framing. Other repairs are required to individual truss joints and members. Additional bracing should be applied to the ceiling structure to tie the roof structure into the endwalls. Lateral bracing added to the top chord of the trusses will greatly increase their capacity to resist buckling. • The bell tower will require miscellaneous repairs to various items, such as the bell support frame. A proper paint restoration specification should be followed to renew the exterior millwork and siding, which is very important in protecting the structural system of steel and wood. To properly anchor the tower will require the reworking of the two concrete-bearing blocks at the corner of the front wall and at the bearing of the 30-inch-deep steel beam. Sufficient masonry should be reworked to ensure that an adequate amount of masonry is engaged with an anchor bolt tie to prevent the overturning of the tower by strong winds. • The greatest portion of the work will involve masonry restoration by rebuilding and reinforcing weakened or inadequate sections of wall. A masonry restoration and repair program consisting of compatible brick units and lime mortar should be implemented to repair the joints in the endwalls and the horizontal balcony level joints in the sidewalls. Minor temperature cracks should be stitch reinforced. In summary, the following items of work were required to structurally stabilize St. Helena’s Church. All of these tasks were completed, resulting in a structural shell and building envelope that should provide continued service for many years: • Protect interior plaster work. • Shore the roof structure. • Use cribbing temporarily to support balcony. • Make timber repairs to the roof trusses. • Laterally brace sidewalls. • Replace the balcony sill plate. • Jack balconies, sidewalls. • Repair masonry and stucco at sidewall cracks. • Rework brick at endwall cracks. • Repoint the brick masonry. • Paint exterior at steeple.
108
The Restoration of St. Helena’s Church
FIGURE 7-10 Lateral bracing consisting of timber poles and framing was installed on both sidewalls. (See color insert.)
FIGURE 7-11 Great care was taken to protect the monuments in the church yard.
Recommendations
109
FIGURE 7-12 JR Graton provided much of the labor required to build and set the temporary lateral bracing.
In fact, the project included several other work components, resulting in a comprehensive and coordinated project that was bid in the traditional manner. These other work items included rebuilding the floor of the narthex, anchoring the supports of the steeple to resist wind forces, and providing a lateral bracing system in the attic to ensure resistance to wind acting in the transverse direction across the sanctuary. The general contractor for the renovations to St. Helena’s Episcopal Church was Ruscon of Charleston, South Carolina. Their bid was based on a set of architectural and structural drawings compiled by architect J. Stephen Smith of Camden, South Carolina. When it was apparent that the building could be fixed by pulling the sidewalls inward to a plumb position, I recommended that the church contact Arnold M. Graton, Master Bridgewright (of covered bridges), who was engaged at the time rebuilding the Auchumpkee Creek Covered Bridge in Thomaston, Georgia, which had been destroyed in a flood. After a visit to Georgia to meet Arnold, the building committee stipulated that Ruscon include Arnold M. Graton & Associates as the subcontractor to perform this work. Temporary vertical supports of 6 ⫻ 8 spruce cribbing were installed inside the church, through the balconies, to support the roof. The sidewalls were laterally supported by braced timber frames, placed on the outside of the building, and the sidewalls were gently and carefully pulled
110
The Restoration of St. Helena’s Church
FIGURE 7-13 Cribbing consisted of 6 ⴛ 7 (actual dimension) by 4-foot-long eastern white spruce.
FIGURE 7-14 The timber frames were used to stabilize the sidewalls during the straightening operation.
inward using a large number of Griphoists® (cable ties with come-alongs) placed across the sanctuary. Arnold Graton secured the Griphoists® to timber framing secured to the outside of the sidewalls.
Recommendations
111
FIGURE 7-15 Griphoists® were used to pull the sidewalls together.
FIGURE 7-16 The Griphoists® were secured to timbers that straddled the window openings.
The renovation of St. Helena’s Episcopal Church won a 2001 South Carolina Honor Award by the Palmetto Trust for Historic Preservation.
112
The Restoration of St. Helena’s Church
FIGURE 7-17 The completed project won an award from The Palmetto Trust for Historic Preservation.
FIGURE 7-18 The underside of the side balconies were replastered.
Reference
113
FIGURE 7-19 All exterior surfaces were renewed, including the steeple. (See color insert.)
REFERENCE 1. George Fore’s November 1994 “Conditions Analysis and Conservation Studies” report
CHAPTER
8
Market Hall Rehabilitation
ot only did Charleston’s 1841 Market Hall survive war, tornados, hurricanes, fire, and the 1886 earthquake, but also it suffered underutilization and neglect forced by Reconstruction and the Depression that hit South Carolina’s economy especially hard. During the bombardment of the city from Morris Island by federal forces, an artillery shell burst through the roof, grazing the bottom chord of one kingpost roof truss. Damage by historic events such as the Civil War and the 1886 earthquake, combined with the low country’s harsh climate of sun, rain, and humidity, were abundantly evident when Phillips & Oppermann, PA obtained the architectural design contract for its restoration in 1992. This chapter will relate the design team’s struggle to apply conservation principles by integrating high-tech solutions of analysis and materials testing with simple traditional approaches of timber framing and masonry restoration. Once the strategy for structural rehabilitation was developed, it had to be defended on several occasions prior to the start of construction and through a construction period that lasted more than three years. Major items of discussion were shoring and bracing, masonry rehabilitation, and timber framing. Although Charleston, being a port city, is hardly isolated, much of the expertise for the rehabilitation was obtained at a distance from the project. The Winston-Salem– based architect Joseph K. Oppermann assembled a team consisting of a structural engineer, materials conservator, and a mechanical engineer from such diverse locations as Raleigh, North Carolina; Philadelphia, Pennsylvania; and East Norwalk, Connecticut.
N
Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
115
116
Market Hall Rehabilitation
FIGURE 8-1 The Civil War was especially hard on Charleston. An artillery shell penetrated the roof of Market Hall.
The structural engineer’s decision to pull the floor structure out and rehabilitate timber-bearing pockets was a much-debated issue. To enhance Market Hall’s resistance to wind and seismic forces, the design strategy called for the existing flooring to be temporarily removed and the floor joists lifted out to be rehabilitated or replaced. A diagonal subfloor consisting of 5/4 sheathing boards was specified to be installed between the original joists and flooring forming a structural diaphragm. Both shear and axial forces had to be transferred between the two elements of wall and floor. The number of floor joists requiring replacement or rehabilitation was a question of debate. I insisted that the contractor’s carpenters could best make that determination after the joists were pulled out and examined. The contractor wanted, in advance, to be provided with the exact number of timbers to order. Much of the masonry had to be rebuilt with loose bricks pulled out and relaid. The masonry restoration contractor questioned the scope of the work after their bid proposal was accepted. Construction management issues such as these greatly impacted the overall preservation plan. A diverse team of designers led an extensive construction team through a difficult rehabilitation tempered by constraints inherent in municipal capital projects. Through friendly persuasion, the design team ultimately prevailed in rehabilitating Market Hall as designed and detailed. The rehabilitation of the main floor system required that the original 4 ⫻ 14 floor joists be reinforced, supplemented, or replaced. The original span of 34 feet
Market Hall Rehabilitation
117
was excessive by modern standards for any application including the intended Confederate Museum. The ends of the floor joists in the masonry pockets were severely deteriorated, especially beneath the wide window openings.
FIGURE 8-2 The ends of the joists were exposed for examination.
Most of the joists were sound immediately beyond the inside face of the masonry with few exceptions. One or two joists were severely deteriorated for their full length. The original survey of the floor framing was made through gaps in the flooring where the architect had arranged to remove the first one or two floorboards on each side of the building. Access to the floor framing from below was limited by the presence of four retail establishments on the first floor that continued to operate during the design phase. The ceiling in the lower level was tongue-and-groove 134 beaded-ceiling boards nailed directly to the joists. The flooring of the main room was oneinch-thick dense pine tongue-and-groove boards nailed to the floor joists. Attachment of the floor system consisted of the simple embedment of the joist ends into the wall approximately 8 to 10 inches. The joists rested on a 3-inchthick timber plate that was severely deteriorated, especially below the windowsills. Termite tracks were visible on the face of several joists. To maximize the use of existing fabric, I recommended that the floor system of north–south joists be reinforced with two lines of support running east–west.
118
Market Hall Rehabilitation
The support would be at the third points of the joist span, greatly increasing the stiffness of the floor system. To maintain the floor system as a timber structure, the primary reinforcing members were specified to be two 8 ¾-inch-wide glued laminated timber beams. I recommended that these members be let into the floor joists rather than be set below the joists. This decision caused a great deal of concern to the architect and owner and had to be defended through several discussions and special meetings. The insertion of the floor beams provided an excellent opportunity to gain length in the soon-to-be three-piece floor joist system if each joist was first removed, end trimmed, and then cut into thirds.
FIGURE 8-3 The gaps in the floor joists to accommodate the 8 3/4-inch-wide glued laminated timber beams allowed for the deteriorated ends to be removed.
In this way, 8 ¾ inches would be gained in two places, offsetting the loss of deteriorated wood at the joist ends. The need for total structural intervention had to be defended through preliminary design and into design development, during special meetings with city project managers and department administrators. The structural design concept was subjected to an informal peer review during which alternate solutions were offered. Apparently, the city’s primary concern was that the proposed solution appeared to be too drastic, resulting in a possible loss of historic fabric and possibly excessively high construction costs. All manner of alternate concepts were suggested, including the application of load-bearing metal studs to support the floor and roof and steel channels to
Market Hall Rehabilitation
119
act as ledgers epoxy bolted to the masonry to support the floor joists and tie the floor system to the perimeter walls. My intent to transform the floor system into a diaphragm had to be explained. Floor joist removal was integral to this effort also because the application of 5/4 (1 inch thick) diagonal flooring as a subfloor was key to that effort. For the finish floor to remain at the original level, the floor joists would have to be lowered to compensate for the inch-thick diagonal floor sheathing. This could only be accomplished by temporarily removing all flooring and joists, and reworking the masonry joist pockets and bearing plates. Obviously, this would also require the installation of temporary shoring and bracing during construction to ensure stability of the masonry walls. Various forms of cross-bracing or sheathing were suggested to be installed beneath the floor system by the architect, peer reviewers and city officials. All suggestions were aimed at not disturbing the floor joists in their original state. Unfortunately, decay and deterioration had greatly impacted a severely undersized floor system, which would be required to support the display cases and exhibits of a newly minted Confederate Museum. City managers insisted that the existing flooring would be difficult to remove without destroying it. To be fair, their concerns were fueled by the advice of peer review engineers and consulting contractors. All of the suggested alternates seemed to contain either steel or plywood as a primary ingredient. Many of the suggestions were verbally transmitted without benefit of a written report or calculations. Each was required to be debunked as we progressed over many months into the construction document phase. In my opinion, the steel-stud support system would not work because it would forever change the original structural system of the building. Often, structural engineers propose this solution without considering that the stability of the building depends on the weight of the floor system resting on the masonry walls. Take that away, and the original, thick masonry walls become unstable. Their answer, to tie the masonry to the studs, further debases the original system. Although the American Plywood Association credits the ancient Egyptians with the invention of plywood by alternating the direction of grain of wood veneers in the construction of mummy cases, I did not want to use a twentiethcentury construction material in the restoration of Market Hall. One concern of using plywood for such an application is that the layers of adhesive, although thin, might act as an improved vapor barrier, retarding the movement of moisture through a building. A practical reason for resisting the use of plywood is that traditional framing rarely is at an even spacing, accommodating 8- or 12-foot sheets of plywood without trimming. This leads to waste and additional labor.
120
Market Hall Rehabilitation
Most structural engineers feel very comfortable designing steel structures. As a result, many reach for the Steel Manual when rehabilitating historic buildings. There are places where structural steel is most appropriate, and often it is the only workable solution. For Market Hall, a masonry box with a timber lid, a traditional approach utilizing technology similar to the original, was called for. FIGURE 8-4 The technology used is common to the timber period of original construction. (See color insert.)
Key to my concept was the utilization of restoration masons and timber framers in the restoration of Market Hall. The general contractor embarked on the project with the intention of utilizing his own forces to undertake the timber-frame portion of the work. Many of the timber frame tasks were unique and difficult to execute. Besides rehabilitating the kingpost trusses in a traditional way utilizing through bolted splices and shear blocks, a seismic resisting X-bracing system had to be integrated into the attic to transmit shear forces between the masonry walls and the timber structure. Timber plates were keyed into the masonry with timber shear blocks that had to be laid up in the masonry and dapped into the timber plates. This work was required both at the main floor level and at the ceiling level. Discussions between the design team, contractor, and the city managers finally resulted in subcontractor proposals being solicited from among a few qualified individuals with timber frame credentials. The project specifications attempted to pre-qualify the timber framer component by requiring membership in the Timber Framers Guild of North America or other prerequisite experience. From the start, the work of timber framers Michael Goldberg of Woodstock,
Market Hall Rehabilitation
121
Georgia and Peter Bull of Cleveland, Georgia greatly impressed project superintendent Tom Magee of NBM Construction. Once the structural design concept was accepted by the County and the contractor was on board, work a Market Hall proceeded smoothly. FIGURE 8-5 The iron work was restored to its original configuration and color. (See color insert.)
FIGURE 8-6 This completed building again houses the Confederate Museum. (See color insert.)
Timber framers and masons worked together to rehabilitate a landmark building that had suffered greatly.
122
Market Hall Rehabilitation
AWARDS The Restoration of the 1841 Market Hall received the following honors: • Restoration and Renovation 2004 Palladio Award for the Restoration of Market Hall, Charleston, South Carolina • 2003 South Carolina Historic Preservation Honor Award for the Restoration of Market Hall, Charleston, SC • 2003 South Carolina Historic Preservation Honor Award— The Palmetto Trust for Historic Preservation SC Department of Archives & History Governors Office for the Restoration of Market Hall, Charleston, South Carolina • 2003 National Preservation Honor Award National Trust for Historic Preservation for the Restoration of Market Hall, Charleston, South Carolina • 2002 Samuel Gaillard Stoney Conservation Craftsmanship Award by the Historic Charleston Foundation for work on the Restoration of 1841 for the Restoration of Market Hall, Charleston, South Carolina • 2002 Carolopolis Award presented by The Preservation Society of Charleston for the Restoration of Market Hall, Charleston, South Carolina
CHAPTER
9
Differential Settlement at St. Philip’s Moravian Church at Old Salem
ifferential settlement caused by the degradation of underlying organic materials is a common occurrence in many building sites. Often, a building is placed on marginally adequate soils without the benefit of a deep foundation or the removal of pockets of organic material. A similar occurrence often happens when an addition to a church building is placed on top of a cemetery. The consolidation of these features can produce quite dramatic amounts of differential settlement. Correcting the problems associated with differential settlement is but one aspect of the Old Salem project, which included restoration of the existing church and replication of a previous log church known only through a single photograph, church history, and archeology.
D
HISTORY The Salem community was founded in 1766 by the Moravians, a Protestant sect from Bethlehem, Pennsylvania, with origins in the Czech states of Moravia and Bohemia. How the Moravians came to North Carolina is quite interesting. In November of 1751, leaders of the Moravian church met in London to consider the offer of one of the Lords Proprietors, John Carteret, the Earl of Granville, to sell them a large tract of land in North Carolina. Under the leadership of Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
123
124
Differential Settlement at St. Philip’s Moravian Church at Old Salem
FIGURE 9-1 Historical photograph provided by Old Salem, Inc.
FIGURE 9-2 The termite damaged floor joists were removed to provide access for the archeologist.
Count Zinzendorf, the Moravians accepted the offer and directed Bishop August Gottlieb Spangenberg to lead a small exploratory expedition into the interior of North Carolina to select a suitable tract of land. After much effort, the explorers staked out a tract containing 98,985 acres to be known as Wachovia.1
Replication and Restoration
125
From almost the beginning, enslaved and free African Americans lived in Salem. The African American congregation of St. Philip’s Moravian Church in the community of Salem was formed in 1822. In 1823, the Moravians constructed for their black citizens a simple log church a few blocks south of Salem Square adjacent to the Stranger’s Graveyard. In 1861, the congregation moved into a newly constructed Greek Revival brick church, again built by the Moravians, which is now the oldest standing African American church building in North Carolina. The black church prospered so well after the Civil War that the Moravian Church agreed to enlarge the building in 1890. The 1890 addition to the 1861 St. Philip’s Moravian Church in Winston-Salem was constructed on a portion of the preexisting Stranger’s Graveyard. The addition contains two first-floor rooms, a central corridor, and a balcony above.2
REPLICATION AND RESTORATION Work at St. Philip’s included the reconstruction of a replica of the 1823 log church based on photographic and archeological evidence. Restoration of the brick church included replication of the original steeple and underpinning repairs to the 1890 addition. The other major structural issue was to provide adequate support inside the attic of the log church for the addition of a replicated belfry and the additional weight of a mechanical unit. FIGURE 9-3 The log church was replicated based on one photograph and archeological evidence.
126
Differential Settlement at St. Philip’s Moravian Church at Old Salem
FIGURE 9-4 A pair of structural steel trusses was designed to support the replicated belfry.
Between the two projects, structural engineering tasks at St. Philip’s included the design of traditional timber frames and connections, structural steel, underpinning, masonry restoration and repair, and a number of construction details. Drawings for the log church were executed by John Milner Architects, Inc. of Chadds Ford, Pennsylvania, based on review, input, and sketches provided by us. FIGURE 9-5 The log church has a false chimney and cupola. (See color insert.)
Description of The Church
127
For St. Philip’s, we provided comprehensive drawings depicting suggested underpinning, means and methods for the underpinning, and complete detailing of the steeple frame and supporting trusses.
DESCRIPTION OF THE CHURCH St. Philip’s is approximately 40 feet wide by 85 feet long with exterior brick masonry walls and first-floor framing above a crawl space.3 We estimated that the 2 ⫻ 10 floor joists, spaced at 24 inches on center in the 1861 building, were equivalent to No. 1 dense or better timber and the 1890 floor joists equivalent to No. 2 or No. 3 dense southern pine. The 1890 floor joists and floor sheathing were removed from the front portion of the building prior to construction so that archeologist could map the features without interference. The roof of the 1861 church is framed with “queen rod trusses” consisting of 5 ⫻ 8 timber top chords, double 7/8-inch square iron queen rods, 2 ¾-inch by 3 ½-inch braces (webs), and a bottom chord consisting of double 4 ⫻ 10 timbers spliced together with trunnels (wood pegs).
FIGURE 9-6 The bottom chord consists of two 4 ⴛ 10s.
128
Differential Settlement at St. Philip’s Moravian Church at Old Salem
Technically, these members constitute an assembly better described as tied and braced principal rafters with sag rods.
FIGURE 9-7 The connection at the queen rod joint appears to have been reworked during the original construction.
The exterior walls and the corridor walls of the 1890 addition are constructed of brick masonry, with very shallow footings. Obviously, when setting the bearing elevation for the walls, the builders were well aware of the numerous burial sites in the area of the addition. Subsidence of the remains within disturbed pockets in the stiff clay caused major cracks to form in the exterior walls at the northwest corner of the 1890 building addition. Numerous settlement cracks in the masonry of the northwest corner of the 1890 addition were obvious by the 1980s. The cracks extended from the base to the top of the wall on both the front face and north side of the building. The cracks were through-wall cracks as much as 1 ½ to 2 inches in width. During the exploratory phase, distance from the underside of the floor joists to the bottom of the walls was measured to be from 17 ¾ inches to 26 inches. The bases of the walls were found to be rectangular in shape without projections or footings of any kind. The foundation walls, as found, were approximately 17 ½ inches thick at the exterior locations and 8 inches thick at the corridors. The oversized brick units of the 1890 addition measured 3 inches high, by 4 inches wide, by 8 inches in length.
Recommendations for Repair
129
FIGURE 9-8 The northwest corner was temporarily braced prior to our involvement with this project.
FIGURE 9-9 The cracks extended to the top of the wall and were up to 2 inches in width.
RECOMMENDATIONS FOR REPAIR Our involvement in this “little church repair” spanned a period of more than 10 years. The original preliminary structural evaluation report was based on a January 1993 jobsite observation made for architect Charles A. Phillips of the
130
Differential Settlement at St. Philip’s Moravian Church at Old Salem
firm Phillips & Oppermann, P.A. of Winston-Salem. In a condition assessment report of that visit, we stated the following: Although the walls of the 1890 addition can be successfully underpinned, it will require considerable engineering to accomplish the task. Consideration should be given to removing the 1890 addition altogether. The two reasons for recommending this alternative are that the 1890 addition should not have been built over a cemetery to begin with, and second, replacing the steeple with the 1890 addition intact would result in a church with a steeple located at the third point of its length in lieu of directly above the narthex3.
By 1995 it was made clear to me that St. Philips would have to be interpreted as an 1890s building and the addition could not be removed. In a letter to John Larson of Old Salem, Inc., we listed “the order of tasks required to repair the front section of the church . . .”4 First, the cracks in the masonry needed to be located, in the drawings, on the building elevations. The location of the graves under the addition needed to be mapped, noting the depth of these features and the extent of undisturbed soil. With the benefit of an archeological base map and a geotechnical report, the type, number, location, and depth of the mini piles (or other ground modification techniques) would be determined so that budget prices could be derived. By this time, John Milner had been retained to execute the design of both the log church and St. Philip’s Moravian Church restoration. In 1993, we had recommended that a subsurface investigation be undertaken “to determine the relative depth and configuration of the 1861 and 1890 wall footings, as well as the nature of the soils located directly beneath the footings in both areas.”3 Successful underpinning of a wall requires that it be uniformly supported continually along its length. It was obvious that support needed to be provided along the wall by bridging the less consolidated pockets of soil without disturbing those areas. The main purpose of the proposed soils investigation was to determine the capacity of the firm soils to support a continuous grade beam with, or without, the installation of soil modification or support elements, such as piles. If sufficient support could be obtained in the undisturbed locations, then a continuous concrete grade beam could be designed to span the archeological features. The underpinning approach that we devised was to install the mini piles first so that they could be used for temporary support of the building and act as “hard points” to jack against in lifting the badly cracked masonry walls. In order to be successful, the walls would have to be lifted and pulled together simultaneously. In this way, the maximum amount of existing masonry could be retained by merely closing the cracks.
The Log Church
131
The project documents included structural details and notes that spelled out a suggested sequence of work, a suggested method for execution, and a layout of the mini piles.
SUBSURFACE EXPLORATION Froehling & Robertson, Inc. of Raleigh, North Carolina, was finally authorized to undertake a subsurface exploration in April of 2002 to evaluate subsurface conditions for underpinning of the west wall of the addition. At our request, it had provided a proposal for this work in 1993. F&R drilled two 40-foot-deep borings approximately 5.5 to 6 feet west of the exterior face of the west wall at locations cleared by the project archeologist. Borings were drilled with an allterrain CME-550 drill rig using hollow stem augers to advance the borings.5 The usual approach of including “test” pits, also known as observation pits, in the soils exploration was not necessary because the work of the archeologist exposed the bottom of the walls in the interior of the 1890 addition. The configuration of the base of the wall and the nature of the supporting soils could be observed without the need for observation pits. General engineering characteristics of the subsurface soils were determined from samples obtained at selected intervals in accordance with Standard Penetration Tests (SPT) procedures (ASTM D-1586). Beneath a thin veneer of topsoil and approximately 2 feet of firm, silty clay residual soil, there was 8 to 12 feet of very stiff micaceous, fine sandy silts. Extending for the remaining 40 feet of depth, firm to stiff slightly micaceous to very micaceous, fine sandy silts were encountered. After 24 hours, a piezometer installed in Boring B-1 detected no groundwater. F&R concluded that the conditions encountered at the two borings would be favorable for the installation of friction-type mini piles to a depth approximately 25 to 35 feet below existing grades. F&R anticipated that steel mini piles could develop a design skin friction of 300 to 400 pounds per square foot.5
THE LOG CHURCH The schedule for the reconstruction of the 1823 log church, which included historical research, archeology, design reviews and approvals, and construction, was developed by John Larson of Old Salem, Inc. The log church was scheduled to be opened for visitors as the plans and specifications for the 1861/1890 masonry church were completed. Most of this work occurred in
132
Differential Settlement at St. Philip’s Moravian Church at Old Salem
1996 and 1997. Starting in July 1991, archeologist Dr. Leland Ferguson from the University of South Carolina and his team of students had verified the original location of the 1823 log church and located 120 to 130 graves of people buried in the Stranger’s Graveyard between 1775 and 1890.4 Although Old Salem had photographic and archeological evidence of the log church, the configuration of the structural system to support the roof was based on conjecture and other similar buildings. Structural design issues at the log church included the design of an A-frame roof structure, support of the false chimney clad with brick veneer, bracing of the gable endwalls, design and support of the open belfry, determination of porch and balcony details, tie-down details connecting the log structure to the foundation and the design of the roof structure. The principal element in the roof structure for the log church is partially exposed to view tied A-frame, with the collar tie located approximately midway between the apex of the frame and the level of the supports.
FIGURE 9-10 The A-frames with collar ties were pre-fabricated in a shop.
Three horizontal ties were placed across the building at the top of the log walls to resist the horizontal thrust of the A-frames. A traditional timber joint consisting of a tongue and fork type connection was inadequate for the loads involved in these tie members, and the end connections had to be reinforced with steel.
The Log Church
133
FIGURE 9-11 The connection of the ties to the A-frames had to be reinforced with steel.
Blue Ridge Timberwrights of Christiansburg, Virginia, erected the log walls on a temporary foundation consisting of loose laid concrete masonry units at the direction of Old Salem, Inc. These timbers were allowed to air dry for about a year with double steel channels bolted through the joints between the logs for alignment. Openings for doors and windows were not cut until later. FIGURE 9-12 The log church was erected and allowed to dry for about one year.
134
Differential Settlement at St. Philip’s Moravian Church at Old Salem
At one point, the partially complete (under construction) church structure, with roof structure installed, was moved off its foundation by high winds. The building was lifted and pushed by the wind, causing the bottom log at the rear to fall out and others to be displaced. The roof suffered no damage. The damage was relatively easy to fix, and construction resumed.
UNDERPINNING WITH MINI PILES Foundation Services, Inc., which at the time was a division of Hayward Baker, Inc. located in Greensboro, North Carolina, was contacted regarding possible approaches to underpinning the west end of the church. Scott Harshman of Foundation Services determined that the existing door openings into the church were large enough to permit the passage of the equipment required to install mini piles. A pile is a long, slender, timber, steel, or concrete structural element driven, augered, jetted, or otherwise embedded on end into the ground for the purpose of support, or to modify or stabilize the earth. In this case, Hayward Baker, Inc. recommended the use of relatively small-diameter piles called mini piles, pipe piles, pin piles, pencil piles, or tubular steel piles. The advantages of mini piles are that they can be drilled or driven through virtually any subsurface condition with drill rigs small enough to access difficult areas with low headroom. In some cases, similar pier and pile systems are hydraulically advanced depending on the nature of the soil. FIGURE 9-13 The shoring beams are supported on the mini piles
Construction
135
Once the gaps in the masonry walls were closed, the cracks could be “healed” by a combination of rebuilding and stitching. The stitching process relies on the installation of retrofitted joint reinforcing placed into raked-out horizontal mortar joints straddling the cracks. By necessity, the masonry repairs had to occur after the walls were fully supported by the underpinning system consisting of temporary steel beams and mini piles. A new cast-in-place reinforced concrete footing served as both pile cap and grade beam, spanning between the piles while supporting the wall above. The piles were inserted between the features mapped by the archeologist into stiff soil. The archeologist provided an AutoCAD® layout of the Stranger’s Graveyard, which we incorporated into the structural drawings, enabling us to direct the placement of the piles in undisturbed locations. To avoid conflict, the concrete footing was set as high as possible, but comfortably below grade.
CONSTRUCTION Structural drawings included photographs of existing conditions showing repairs to the masonry and suggested ways to brace the building. These drawings, as well as specifications—including a section describing mini piles—were included in the bid package. The low bidder for the restoration, general contractor H. M. Kern Corporation, selected Foundation Services, Inc. of Greensboro (now Hayward Baker, Inc.) and Blake Moving Company of Greensboro, North Carolina, as the subcontractors. Hayward Baker, Inc. utilized a KB1 Drill Rig with a hydraulic generator and a diesel powered grout mixer. A 2.2-to-1 Portland cement-to-water ratio was used to achieve a grout design mix with a compressive strength of 4,000 psi at three days. The design capacity of the 4-inch outside diameter micropiles was 5 tons, with a factor of safety of 2.2. The 4-inch O.D. piles had a wall thickness of 0.525 inches, with a yield strength of Fy ⫽ 36 ksi. Piles were inserted in accordance with our layout with the exception of three, which had to be offset slightly to avoid obstructions to the drill rig. Charlie Blake of Blake Moving Company used a simple and direct method to pull the walls together. Sets of flat steel bands were placed horizontally around straight sections of wall. Head joints in the masonry were knocked out so that the bands could pass through each section of wall, encompassing the portion to be pulled together. This operation required that the open cracks be cleared of debris so that the cracked sections of wall could be leveled and moved while “floating” on steel.
136
Differential Settlement at St. Philip’s Moravian Church at Old Salem
FIGURE 9-14 The mortar in the cracks had to be removed prior to pulling the wall together.
FIGURE 9-15 Bands of steel were installed through mortar joints. Building corners were protected with wood.
Using the “banding system,” the discontinuous sections of wall were slowly and carefully pulled together so that the mason could heal the cracks using common masonry restoration techniques. The reconstruction of the belfry of the masonry church proved to be interesting. Its configuration was determined by Philips & Oppermann, using the
Construction
137
FIGURE 9-16 The masonry wall was supported by the mini-piles. Steel bands were used to provide under-slung support to the wall. (See color insert.)
early photograph that showed it and the log church. Other evidence included the remnants of the belfry support timbers and framed out openings in the attic. We determined that without supplemental support, the existing structure was inadequate to resist forces derived from wind acting on a new belfry. The solution was to design a wood-framed belfry supported by a pair of steel trusses to span the width of the church. FIGURE 9-17 The steel trusses were designed to be lightweight with bolted connections to ease assembly within the attic space.
138
Differential Settlement at St. Philip’s Moravian Church at Old Salem
These trusses were located in the attic, spaced to avoid the original framing. An added consideration was the erection of this structural system in an tight space. To accommodate the geometry and allow for assembly in place, the steel truss components and lateral bracing consisted of structural angles field-bolted together.
SUMMARY The underpinning fix for St. Philip’s consisting of strategically placed mini piles, concrete grade beams, and the efforts of a general contractor and his subcontractors consisting of a foundation specialty contractor, a structural mover, and a masonry restoration contractor to provide permanent support for the building while avoiding the archeological features beneath the building that were the source of its distress.
REFERENCES 1. C. Daniel Crews, Villages of the Lord, The Moravians Come to Carolina (Winston-Salem: Moravian Archives, 1995). 2. Old Salem, St. Philip’s Church, An Overview, (Winston-Salem: Old Salem, Inc., June 11, 2003). 3. Fischetti, David C. “Preliminary Structural Evaluation” Report, January, 1993. 4. Fischetti, David C., Letter to John Larson, 1995. 5. Charles A. Phillips, St. Philip’s Moravian Church, Report of Findings, (Winston-Salem: Phillips & Oppermann, P.A., 1993).
BIBLIOGRAPHY John Sensbach, Preserving North Carolina’s Old Surviving Black Church, North Carolina Preservation, #86 Summer 1992. Ralph E. Sanders, Report of Subsurface Exploration, Froehling & Robertson, Inc., No. D66–002, April 15, 2002.
CHAPTER
10
James Madison’s Montpelier
ames Madison’s Montpelier is a historic building, with great cultural value, now undergoing a $60 million dollar transformation, restoring it to the size and form it was in the 1820s. This is no small task. The rural Virginia home of James Madison, fourth president of the United States had been altered in the mid- and late nineteenth century and greatly expanded after William DuPont Sr. purchased it in 1901. The ninth owner of Montpelier, the National Trust for Historic Preservation, engaged the architectural department of Colonial Williamsburg in 1997 to undertake a study to determine how the building evolved. This, and other studies, contributed to a body of knowledge that expanded during construction to include information gleaned through the hands-on work of archeologists, architectural historians, architects, engineers, and the various craftsmen engaged to undertake the work. Restoring Montpelier to an earlier time has involved many complex structural issues. These had an array of solutions ranging from traditional repairs, to the application of modern materials, depending on the overall goals of the project. For example, the roof structure consisting of braced principal frames, which had been partially cut out to convert the attic into habitable space. Replacing the missing parts and reinforcing the heel, brace, and post connections of the principal frames to compensate for deterioration and defects involved the application of traditional timber joinery, as well as modern connectors.
J
Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
139
140
James Madison’s Montpelier
FIGURE 10-1 View of the surrounding property from the attic. (See color insert.)
FIGURE 10-2 The up and down braces had been removed to transform the attic into habitable space.
Where reinforcing was accomplished with miscellaneous steel, each connector was designed to resist the forces involved at locations deemed deficient or damaged, with a minimal amount of intervention, while allowing for reversibility where practical. At several locations, a wood mock-up of the connector
James Madison’s Montpelier
141
FIGURE 10-3 The braces were replaced in kind.
assembly was made to ensure an adequate fit. The actual wood mock-ups were provided to the steel fabricator, along with the engineer’s drawings. The small fabrication shop had tool-and-die capabilities, and was not strictly a miscellaneous steel fabrication shop. As a result, reinforcing connections were made with great precision, in stainless steel, to suit each individual situation. FIGURE 10-4 The post-to-beam connection was damaged in several locations.
142
James Madison’s Montpelier
FIGURE 10-5 Each reinforcing connection was custom fabricated by providing a wood mockup to the steel fabricator for each location.
Some rafters, beams, and purlins required reinforcing with steel knife plates where a simple traditional scarf joint would not suffice.
FIGURE 10-6 The proposed knife plate connection was load tested.
James Madison’s Montpelier
143
In these cases, the knife-plate connection actually preserved the maximum amount of historic fabric. FIGURE 10-7 Several rafters were spliced with knife plates to maximize the retention of original fabric.
Deterioration in several beams and timber plates and sills was verified, and in some cases discovered, through the use of resistance drilling. FIGURE 10-8 Wood scientist Ron Anthony used resistance drilling to discover deterioration in timber member.
144
James Madison’s Montpelier
Segmental infill using laminated veneer lumber was used at two locations. The serrated roofs of the wings were reconstructed on the basis of historical writings, prints, architectural evidence, and knowledge of similar construction at other sites contemporary to Montpelier, such as Thomas Jefferson’s Monticello, Poplar Forest, and the University of Virginia. Anchorage of the plates supporting the serrated roof joists to the masonry included tie-down anchors and shear keys to resist lateral loads such as wind and seismic. FIGURE 10-9 The serrated roof followed Thomas Jefferson’s original design, which was verified by “ghost” marks.
The structural interventions typically were exposed to a process that included review by the architects (The architectural firm of Mesick Cohen Wilson Baker Architects of Albany New York), the on-site project superintendent, John Jeanes (Director of Restoration) for Montpelier, Inc., the various craftsmen undertaking the work, and the Restoration Advisory Committee engaged by the owner. Structural concerns at Montpelier included reconstructing the sawtooth roofs, reconstructing the portions of the hipped roof structures modified by DuPont, and reinstalling roof framing, consisting of posts and up and down braces, which were removed to create an apartment from the attic space. In reverting that space back to an attic, floor joists that had been added were removed. Two dormers were removed and the associated framing was replaced by splicing. Timber plates were installed after the two-story wings were lowered to their original one-story condition. Anchors were installed throughout the structure to ensure resistance against wind. Every area of the building required some timber repair or reconstruction and masonry reconstruction, underpinning, or repair. We persuaded John Jeanes to
James Madison’s Montpelier
145
engage Arnold M. Graton of Ashland, New Hampshire, to level the floors. Arnold also underpinned the 1750 chimney to provide a 2-foot-tall vertical clearance at its base to allow mechanical ducts to transition into the vertical space within the chimney. FIGURE 10-10 Arnold Graton (shown here) temporarily braced the chimney prior to removing soil and installing jacks. (See color insert.)
Arnold used 16 jacks to support the chimney mass. FIGURE 10-11 The jacks consisted of 20-ton air jacks with dial gauges.
146
James Madison’s Montpelier
The mason constructed the chimney, filling the gap between the original chimney and a new concrete footing.
FIGURE 10-12 The chimney extension provided duct access into the vertical spaces within the chimney. (See color insert.)
The newer floor openings had to be closed up and the original stair openings reconstituted. In some cases, framing for floor openings became quite complex. Joist hangers, splice plates, and laminated veneer lumber were all utilized in an effort to make more than adequate repairs while removing as little historic fabric as possible. We utilized Dutchman inserts with epoxy to repair some deteriorated timbers. In the lower level, one large deteriorated beam was repaired by removing the deteriorated center of the beam and replacing it with laminated veneer lumber. Many of the original connections required enhancement for the members joined to carry the required load. The connection between the attic posts and the ceiling and dragon beams became a very complicated connection of stainless steel, which was first patterned in wood and then built by a small tool and die shop using the wood pattern as a guide.
James Madison’s Montpelier
147
FIGURE 10-13 The deteriorated interior of the large beam was hollowed out to sound wood.
FIGURE 10-14 Dutchmen consisting of laminated veneer lumber were installed from the top using a gap-filling epoxy.
Through the use of contemporary materials, technology, and analysis, as well as traditional framing techniques, the structural portions of Montpelier, which remain from the time period associated with James and Dolly Madison, were preserved through restoration and reconstruction.
CHAPTER
11
Timber, Glulam, and Conservation
eeting the requirements of the building code is not the same as assuring the public of a safe structure. As structural engineers, it is critical that we make the judgments needed to keep a historic structure in service when parameters appear to fall short of minimum code requirements. In this chapter we will discuss timber structures in general and the structural repair of glued laminated timber structures and the use of laminated timber in the conservation of other timber structures.
M
TIMBER MISUNDERSTOOD Timber is the primary structural component for most historic structures in the United States and Canada. In today’s residential market, timber is primarily of importance as dimension lumber. Most timber production consists of dimension framing. Manufacturers provide the design for prefabricated components such as wood trusses for the complete framing of floors and roofs. Other manufactured products, such as laminated veneer lumber and joist products, are selected on the basis of load tables provided by the manufacturer. As a result, the glued laminated timber industry is one of the few areas where structural engineers are practicing the design of heavy timber structures on a daily basis. Some timber-frame manufacturing firms have in-house engineers, but most use the services of private consulting engineers. Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
149
150
Timber, Glulam, and Conservation
PRESERVATION PHILOSOPHY It is hoped that by learning more about timber design, structural engineers will develop a preservation philosophy that demands rigorous analysis in order to justify “doing nothing” to an historic timber structure that has been performing satisfactorily for many years. Buildings that analysis (and observation) clearly indicates are unsafe should be reinforced in the most sensitive manner in an attempt to retain as much historic fabric as possible. Buildings that require extensive modification or reconstruction should be restored in a way that is in keeping with the original construction if possible, while fulfilling safety requirements. Often, engineers are asked to evaluate framing members to determine the capacity of an existing floor structure in an historic structure. This review process differs considerably from design.
STRUCTURAL REVIEW Members in the horizontal plane, such as floor sheathing, joists, purlins, and beams, are stressed principally in bending. The resisting bending moment is a measure of the strength of such an element. This measure, stiffness and horizontal shear make up the three qualities that are normally checked during the process of selection that we call design. Because timber is available in certain standard lumber sizes, the designer selects from the available sizes, grades, and species those that most economically meet the predetermined standards for bending stress, deflection, and horizontal shear. When the engineer reviews the capacity of an existing member, many parameters complicate the process of selecting appropriate lumber. Size, span and spacing of members are dictated by the structure. It is the engineer’s task to determine the size, orientation, species, grade, and end condition of all of the structural elements in a building that already exists. Between the factors of limited availability of types of lumber, economic considerations, existing standards, and the structure of the building itself, freedom of choice is eliminated.
ENGINEERING JUDGMENT Often, the structural engineer must pass judgment on a structure that has served far beyond what we consider to be a normal period of service. The timbers of such a structure were not selected on the basis of modern engineering analysis. They certainly do not bear inspection marks attesting to their grade and species.
Load Duration and Historic Structures
151
It should be obvious to the engineer that a safe floor structure should not fail in bending due to the actual loads imposed. But it is important to recognize that excessive deflection, excessive vibration, or a lack of stiffness, should not automatically categorize a floor structure as “unsafe.” Strict deflection limitations should be set for floors that support plaster ceilings in lieu of wood or tin ceilings or no ceilings at all. But for comfort, the deflection limitation set in most building codes for floors, no matter what the ceiling, is 1/360th of the span. It must be said that overstressed structural members may also be perfectly safe. It is important for the engineer to evaluate the basis for his or her conclusion regarding the safety of the structure. When making such an evaluation, the loads assumed for design should be reconciled with the actual loads that will occur in service. For example, if we think about the uniform design live load of 40 psf for residential floors used as living areas, packing a group of people weighing 160 pounds each into a room and allocating four square feet of space each would be equal to 40 psf. In reality, it is difficult to imagine such a situation, and when one considers that most furniture weighs less per square foot, it is very difficult to see how residential floor loading could attain 40 psf. The design values that we assume are critical to the computed capacity of some floor systems. For structures such as mill buildings, average design values yield results that fall well above the minimum code requirements for adaptive reuse occupancy, such as Office or Retail.
LOAD DURATION AND HISTORIC STRUCTURES The procedures of load factor design in timber were developed over a period of 10 years based on 20 years of research. In 1996, the American Forest & Paper Association published the first Load and Resistance Factor Design (LRFD) manual. This concept is most appropriate for application to timber design because of the long history of the concept of Live Load Duration. Early timber research found that timber reacts quite well to short applications of load. The duration of load was found to be as critical as the magnitude of the load. Presumably, this sensitivity to the duration of load is a result of the natural composition of timber, which consists of a tightly bound bundle of cells that tend to stretch or elongate with time. The larger and more constant the load, the more stretching of fibers occurs. The effects of this creep can be seen in many timber structures through excessive deflection. For short durations of load, such as impact, allowable design values are substantially increased. Research into this time-versus-stress relationship is of paramount importance. Only through evaluating historic timber structures can we solve this
152
Timber, Glulam, and Conservation
puzzle, which is complicated by cyclic loading, original moisture content, member size, span, species, grade, temperature, humidity and magnitude of stress. Although the concepts of LRFD design are most appropriately applied to timber structures, the vast majority of practicing timber engineers continue to use working stress design (WSD).
CASE HISTORIES The portico of the Miles Brewton House in Charleston, South Carolina (c.1757), required a timber 6 ⫻ 18 in size and 52 feet long. Glued laminated timber was specified because of the need for such a large member. The replacement roof structure for the Thomas Day/Union Tavern (c.1850) in Milton, North Carolina, includes laminated veneer lumber. The tapered rafter, collar tie, and ceiling joist system duplicates the profile of the original structural elements, which were destroyed in a fire three years before we first inspected the building in 1977. Of course “modern” timber products should not automatically replace traditional timber framing and joinery. Replacement-in-kind of members with mortise and tenon, dovetail, tongue and fork, slotted, or oakpinned joint connections is a possibility that must be considered. In recent years, various designs for new post-and-beam frames have been produced containing few or no metal connectors. Traditional technology is available through timber framers located in many areas of the United States and Canada. In a 1988 structural evaluation report, we concluded that the large second floor assembly hall of the Chowan County Courthouse in Edenton, North Carolina (c.1767), could be used for public occupancy if the area was posted to limit the number of people to 200. A deflection limitation of 1/360th of a span governed the design, producing a bending stress as high as 2292 psi in large, dense southern pine timber floor joists and beams. In 1991, we reviewed the floor structure of the 1917 Walker Building at the State Hospital in Concord, New Hampshire. Assuming a reasonable set of design values equivalent to No. 1D SR southern pine, based on examination of wood samples obtained from the building, we concluded that the existing 7 ½ ⫻ 11 timber beams were adequate to support a live load of 86 psf, which is well within the 50 psf required for office occupancy. The live load deflection limitation of 1/360th of the span controlled the design. Of course, we can conclude that this is a safe structure that meets minimum code requirements. The calculations were based on reasonable assumptions of design values. In 1985, half a dozen floor joists from the 1903 Montague Building in Raleigh, North Carolina, were removed from the building and tested to destruction. Of the
Case Histories
153
five joists tested, (of six joists selected, one was found not suitable for testing) the average bending stress at rupture was in excess of 5000 psi. The average modulus of elasticity was 1,295,000 psi. These measures of strength and stiffness were used to evaluate the capacity of the floor structure. To meet tenant requirements for possible retail occupancy in this speculative office building, we recommended that all of the existing floor joists be reinforced. At Moorfields, a 1792 house in Hillsborough, North Carolina, we evaluated the excessive deflection of a summer beam by measuring offsets in the floor surface above the beam. Based on field measurements and computer analysis, we were convinced that the two-span summer beam had failed. Indeed, when exposed to view by removing the ceiling plaster, during construction in 1980, the summer beam contained a severe fracture consistent with a typical bending failure. The only replacement beam available of sufficient stiffness and strength that would fit in the space between the floor sheathing and the plaster ceiling below was a steel tube section of a dimension approximately equal to the original timber beam. St. Michael’s Episcopal Church in Charleston, South Carolina was built between 1752 and 1761. Architect unknown, it resembles English pattern book designs, which were popular in the colonies. St. Michael’s, is similar to James Gibbs’ design for St. Martin-in-the-Fields in London. St. Michael’s survived wars, hurricanes, tornadoes, fires, and the 1886 earthquake. During the Revolutionary War, St. Michael’s was the center of British resistance, and as such, the tower was a target for British naval gunners. The 186 foot tall steeple served as an observation post and navigational landmark in this and subsequent military conflicts. As a result of the 1886 earthquake, the steeple settled 8 inches, while leaning 18 inches towards the west requiring reconstruction of the portico below. Repaired cracks in the brick masonry can be observed today from the inside of the tower. Hurricane Hugo, which struck near Charleston at the Isle of Palms on September, 22, 1989 caused damage to St. Michael’s resulting in an insurance settlement of $6,000,000. An indication of the strength of the winds was the damage to the weather vane at the top of the steeple. Consisting of a tapered 2 ½ inch square wrought iron bar, it was bent by the winds of this category 4 storm. The steeple of St. Michael’s consists of five stages above the roof. Its base, square in plan, forms the center portion of the vestibule. These brick masonry walls vary from 4 feet-9 ½ inches to 5 feet-3 inches in thickness. The masonry box, translating from square to octagon in stages; it extends to the underside of the gallery level. Since the spire consists of four intersecting frames, we applied a 48 to 55 psf wind load to a pie shaped portion of the plan. At the same time, preliminary observation indicated that the eight posts at the open lantern level had various
154
Timber, Glulam, and Conservation
amounts of deterioration in their bases. The analysis indicated that the steeple frame acted much less stiff with one or both these joints disconnected. Subsequent to Hurricane Hugo, I was contacted by Craig Bennett, P.E. of Cummings and McCrady, Inc. architects, in Charleston through a recommendation from materials conservator George T. Fore of Raleigh, North Carolina. George Fore produced a condition analysis and conservation study of the carpentry, masonry, plaster and finishes, and various details. He also provided framing details for the steeple as well as evidence of racking of the upper structure due to Hurricane Hugo. His report located areas of deteriorated wood within the framework. To determine the amount of lean in the steeple a surveying instrument was set in the window of a nearby office building, but measurements were inconclusive. Upon inspection on a day with five to ten mile per hour gusts, Craig Bennett led the author on a tour up into the tower in similar fashion to the tours afforded through the years to dignitaries visiting Charleston such as George Washington and the Marquis de Lafayette. On those occasions apparently it was common practice to afford such dignitaries “a view of the city“. The analysis of a steeple should consider wind pressure in four directions. Overall, stability depends on anchorage to the building’s foundations. Some steeples consist of a spire connected to a bell tower. In these cases, the analysis must include the steeple frame and its connection to the bell tower, whether masonry or stone. Steeples may consist of freestanding timber structures or timber structures where one or two walls are integrated into endwall framing. Many steeples bear on the endwall of the church with two supports and with two supports on the first interior roof truss. In many cases the two interior posts may pass through a balcony structure. Endwalls may be timber frames or masonry walls. No matter what the configuration, wind and seismic forces should be applied in the transverse direction across the ridge and in the longitudinal direction parallel to the ridge. Many steeples lean towards the nave in situations where support is shared between an endwall and a less stiff roof truss. Even with a rigid support of timber posts and balcony or narthex wall framing, a steeple will lean if the endwall support is a non-yielding masonry wall. In these cases, a small amount of shrinkage across the grain in several large timber plates can cause a dramatic lean in a tall steeple towards the nave. For ease of analysis the timber frame of a steeple may be reduced to its primary and secondary framing. Rigidity may depend on x-braces, or up or down braces, or knee braces. A preliminary analysis will reveal whether the braces are resisting tension or compression forces. If the computed tension is high, with the ability of the connection to resist tension insufficient, all such tension members should be deleted and the program run again. The computer model must account for continuity or discontinuity through joints. For steeples
Case Histories
155
with securely fastened sheathing or panels, this additional stiffness afforded to the frame should be accounted for in the computer model. Some steeples, consisting of square, hexagonal, and octagonal sections, which were erected in a telescoping fashion, sometimes with transitional sections between, are difficult to accurately analyze without three dimensional capability. In our report on May 11, 1992 we presented a simple analysis of the steeple which allowed us to consider a replacement-in-kind option which does not rely on supplemental steel reinforcing. We applied a 48 to 54 psf wind load to the vertical projection of one frame. From the 1988 Standard Building Code, we utilized a Use Factor of 1.00 because it is highly unlikely that failure of the steeple would affect 300 or more occupants in the sanctuary. The limited use of a church sanctuary to primarily one day a week is another reason for selecting the lower Use Factor. To the steeple frame, we applied a support condition which consisted of the approximate stiffness of the two portal frames. Each portal frame consisted of two gallery level columns and two 2 ¾ inch ⫻ 8 ¾ inch knee braces. We deleted the contribution of the knee brace which was in tension in determining the stiffness of the portal frame. We applied a horizontal 1000 pound unit load to the portal frame in order to derive the spring constant. To simulate the steeple with the base of the gallery columns not tied down, we placed a roller support with a spring constant in the Y direction at the bottom of the windward column in the portal frame. Using the stiffness of the “deteriorated” portal frame we re-ran the steeple frame with new spring constant and the lantern column on the windward side omitted. We used a Modulus of Elasticity of 1600 ksi and limited Fc (compression parallel to grain) to between 1200 psi and 1700 psi and Ft to 1100 psi. The analysis provided the following computed horizontal deflection of the top of the steeple frame: Horizontal deflection due to a 100 mph wind load As-built
2.13 inches
Deteriorated
5.43 inches
This response seems to be in line with actual conditions. If the steeple was experiencing much larger movements, then sheathing, cladding and architectural feature would be rupturing. Each of the eight faces of the gallery level contains decorative millwork consisting of an arch with keystone, engaged columns and an entablature with exceptional carved ornaments. The molded architrave of the gallery was planed into the horizontal planks forming the arch. George Fore’s investigation did point out that this level of the steeple
156
Timber, Glulam, and Conservation
racked causing the horizontal planks to slip past one another breaking the paint bond which covered the joints. Stresses in the members appeared to be relatively low in the net sections of various members. This seemed consistent with a timber framed structure where the connections at joint locations govern the design. The highest stress appeared to be in the interior vertical post at the top of the lantern level because a large amount of bending was applied to a small net section. This analysis appeared to set the stage for a replacement-in-kind solution where severely deteriorated members are replaced and the deteriorated ends of other members are repaired. About two years before, at the Miles Brewton House in Charleston, I had met Tommy Graham of McClellanville, South Carolina. He had been selected by Hill Construction Corporation of Charleston to provide the restoration of the timber portion of St. Michael’s steeple. My first inclination was to replace in-kind the deteriorated timbers and portions of timbers using mechanical splices. As an alternative, Tommy suggested that we make repairs using Dutchmen and a gap filling epoxy adhesive to maximize the retention of historic fabric. Besides, he said that the acquisition of large dense cypress timbers dried to the moisture content compatible with the timber inside the tower was problematic. To test the epoxy, I directed Tommy to have his crew prepare six 1 inch by 3 inch long half lapped joints, under field conditions, which could be transported to a testing laboratory. With the assistance of Froehling & Robertson, Inc. we tested the specimens at North Carolina State University’s Forestry Department utilizing a Tinius-Olsen testing machine. The results tabulated in F&R’s October 8, 1992 report of tensile tests were fairly uniform. Specimen No.
Breaking Load (lbs.)
Stress p.s.i Moisture %
1
2,510
846
10.4
2
2,500
842
10.3
3
2,855
973
10.2
4
3,040
1,035
10.6
5
2,390
812
10.4
6
1,845
634
10.5 (Avg. 857)
The results of the tensile tests indicated that wood failure occurred along the plane with sidegrain contact and total glue failure occurred at endgrain to endgrain surfaces. This indicated to us that our Dutchmen and built-up repairs should include only scarf joints. In one case, we discovered a horizontal strut which was totally deteriorated. To replace it we vertically laminated five cypress boards together.
Case Histories
157
New tenons and boat shaped Dutchmen were fabricated from dense cypress with a moisture content of 14 percent to 16 percent which was close to the moisture content of the original frame of 11 percent to 14 percent. FIGURE 11-1 Deteriorated wood has been cut away from a beam in St. Michael’s Episcopal Church in Charleston, South Carolina.
FIGURE 11-2 The repair was completed using cypress infill pieces similar to the original in density and moisture content.
Where radiating 8 ⫻ 10 timber beams below the floor of the gallery were severely deteriorated we replaced them with pressure treated Southern Pine having a 2.5 pcf retention of Copper Chromated Arsenate (CCA) water borne preservative. These members, cantileved towards the center across brick corbels
158
Timber, Glulam, and Conservation
provided vertical support to the central spine of the tower. The ends of these members were embedded in the masonry wall approximately 3 feet. Wrought iron straps throughout the steeple which had disintegrated and could not be reworked were replaced with stainless steel.
LEED AND TIMBER In the Leadership in Energy and Environmental Design (LEED), Green Building Rating System ™ developed by the U.S. Green Building Council, glued laminated timber should be rated far above other materials. To assemble smaller pieces of our only truly renewable construction material into massive and efficient structural units, saving large solid timbers for other uses is a powerful green advantage. The LEED system should immediately propel the abundant array of forest products of all types to the pinnacle of “greenness.” First, how does one put a value on the renewable aspects of wood? Of what value is the production of oxygen from carbon dioxide through photosynthesis, a process that we do not understand? Other construction products consume millions of BTUs during production, while trees simply produce oxygen—and moderate the climate, provide habitat for birds and animals, and enrich and secure the soil. So what we have in trees, at the least, are massive and numerous carbon reservoirs, which can easily be harvested and utilized as a construction material. In fact, timber components are easily connected using simple means. The ability of wood to hold a nail or spike in the tight grip of its fibers is basic and not easily duplicated with other materials. The act of inserting a screw into a massive timber (although we have almost perfected powder actuated fasteners and self drilling and self tapping screws) is basic to life as we know it, when one considers that the screw is simply an inclined plane wrapped around a shaft. Forget the old-growth forest where the elderly simply die and return their carbon to the forest floor. If we want to remove carbon from the atmosphere and store it where it will do the most good, we need to manage our forest resources so that we maximize utilization while conserving the timber structures that exist. Many conservationists agree that the greenest building is the one that already exists. Actually, the “greenest” building is the one that exists which contains timber components.
LAMINATED TIMBER At initial glance, it would seem incongruous for glued laminated timber to be mentioned in a discussion of preservation and conservation. In fact, glued laminated timber may be the “greenest“ construction product available, used in a
Laminated Timber
159
multitude of structures that have now attained the age of 50. Introduced into the United States in the 1930s, from Germany, by Max C. Hanisch, Sr. (1882– 1950), glued laminated timber is present in thousands of buildings.
FIGURE 11-3 Glued laminated timber was introduced into the United States by Max Hanisch.
If one considers the stock beam program of many companies, producing glued laminated timber for lintels, headers, and general-purpose use, the number of existing structures that contain glued laminated timber in North America is certainly in the hundreds of thousands. The first glued laminated timber building built in the United States; the Peshtigo Wisconsin High School Gymnasium (1934) certainly deserves to be listed in the National Register of Historic Places. There are many monumental structures constructed of glued laminated timber, which would seem to qualify as historic properties eligible for preservation tax credits. Who is surveying our glued laminated timber buildings to determine which are our first and most significant buildings containing glulam Tudor arches (Peshtigo High School Gymnasium), curved tapered beams, radial arches, open knee Tudor arches, bowstring trusses, long span trusses on many varieties, cross vaults, radial rib or geodesic domes? Which buildings contain the longest span of these components? With the use of glued laminated timber as a substitute material in World War II, there remain many monumental buildings such as drill halls, hangers, gymnasiums, armories, and warehouses certainly eligible for inclusion in the National Register of Historic Places. In the 1950s glulam technology was applied to long span structures such as bowling alleys, supermarkets, automobile showrooms, gymnasiums, and religious structures.
160
Timber, Glulam, and Conservation
FIGURE 11-4 The Peshtigo High School Gymnasium was built in 1934.
Pertinent to this, were the recent remarks of a very influential structural engineer during a keynote address at a symposium on the treatment of modern historic structures. He stated that modern structures were defined by the modern materials from which they are constructed. These, according to him, are steel, glass, and concrete.
CONSERVATION OF GLUED LAMINATED TIMBER STRUCTURES It is important for conservationists to consider the particular aspects inherent to the design and construction of glued laminated timber structures when, in the coming years, so many of these buildings will be certified as historic. Glued laminated timber is an important 20th century building material. It can be produced in longer lengths and larger sizes than solid timber and has higher allowable design values and stiffness. Laminated timber can also be curved. The deterioration of glulam is somewhat different from that of ordinary wood, because of the glue joint. However, repair of glulam is similar to that of
Diagnostics and Condition Assessment
161
solid timber, except for that one must take into account different allowable design values, fabrication and connection techniques, and the larger sizes and special shapes common in glued laminated timber construction.
DETERIORATION The repair or rehabilitation of glued laminated timber structures requires the expertise of a structural engineer familiar with glulam design. In order to design an appropriate repair which meets the requirements of the Secretary of the Interior’s Guidelines, the engineer of record must determine as much as possible about the building under investigation. This information is best found in the shop drawings. Observation and measurement is required to determine how the building has performed during its service life. Rigorous analysis is required to determine the capacity of glued laminated timber structures and how to best reinforce, repair or rehabilitate them if necessary. Laminated timber deteriorates in the same manner as solid timber except for a few unique characteristics. Termites and fungi will destroy wood that has moisture content greater than 20 percent. In glulam, deterioration may follow certain laminations because of moisture variations. The glue line, although thin, will act as a boundary with termites found in one or two laminations for a certain distance while adjacent laminations may be free of infestation. Because laminated timber members are large, deterioration can be very serious, requiring intervention on a major scale. As in other structural materials, glued laminated timber can fail due to deficiencies in design or fabrication or changes in service conditions. Failures in glued laminated timber members can be in horizontal shear, radial tension, bending or deflection. Horizontal shear usually occurs at connections, notched ends or highly loaded beam ends. The failure mode includes horizontal splits in the end of a member where wood fibers slide past one another. An inadequate glue bond can cause horizontal shear failure to occur at a glue joint.
DIAGNOSTICS AND CONDITION ASSESSMENT The first step in assessing a glued laminated timber structure is to determine species of wood, design criteria, type of adhesive, and treatments if any. If the shop drawings survive, many of these questions can easily be answered. Shop drawings provide information such as design loads, design values, and lumber combinations, the amount of camber, building geometry, member sizes and lengths, and connection details. Concealed or hidden connections are
162
Timber, Glulam, and Conservation
most easily determined by reviewing the shop drawings. Shop drawings are very important to the evaluation, because they reflect what was actually built. Certain dimensions such as the tangent depths of two-hinged Tudor arches are very difficult to measure in the field. The date of construction will establish the full range of design values associated with a particular lumber combination. Many changes in design with respect to adjustments to design values or stresses have occurred since the 1930s. It is important to determine which set of design standards were used. Waterproof adhesives usually are dark, while water-resistant adhesives are white or gray in color. Treatments, type and the amount of retention, may require that samples be laboratory tested. By tapping with a carpenter’s hammer, a deteriorated glulam can be “sounded out.“ The extent of deterioration on the surface of a member can be easily recognized because of discoloration. Often, termite tubes or small pinholes caused by borer insects may be visible on the surface. Ultrasonic devices may also be of value. A moisture meter can be used to determine areas likely to contain deterioration. By measuring deflection, members that have lost stiffness due to deterioration or failure can be identified. Possible causes of damage from excessive moisture include termites and fungi. Deficiencies in design or fabrication or changes in service conditions can cause glued laminated timber structures to fail. Horizontal shear, radial tension, bending, and deflection are areas of investigation for the structural engineer.
CONSERVATION METHODS Methods of conservation include reinforcement or repair with steel and epoxy systems, segmental infill, field lamination, and steel or wood cover plates nailed, screwed, lag screwed, or bolted into place. Damaged timber members can also be replaced. Of course, the cause of the original deterioration must be eliminated. In North America, glued laminated timber usually consists of 1- or 2-inchthick (nominal thickness) Douglas fir or southern pine boards with a waterproof adhesive applied to the face of each board. After drying, natural growth characteristics are removed and individual boards are end joined, with finger joints, to form long laminations. Individual laminations are then laid up according to a pattern and clamped under pressure until cured, forming structural members that are then dressed in a double-faced planner. In the fabrication of glued laminated timber, the moisture content can be controlled while many strength reducing characteristics found in solid timber
Conservation Techniques
163
members are eliminated. In the cross-section of a glulam timber, higher-grade laminations are placed in areas of high stress. For example, the bottom of a simple beam in bending will receive higher grade boards to resist tension at the extreme fiber. So will the top of the beam cross-section more dense, straightgrained boards where higher stresses in compression are found. Glued laminated timber allows increased freedom of design and is commonly associated with the fabrication of large engineered wood components, which can be curved or shaped in unique ways. By gluing, timber can be fabricated into sophisticated structural shapes or into systems such as lamella structures or geodesic domes. Tudor arches and curved tapered beams are structural components unique to glulam technology. Glued laminated timber has been used in conjunction with wire cables and fabric to form tensile structures. Until the late 1960s, waterproof and water-resistant adhesives were both available. Various preservative pressure treatments have been used, either treating individual laminations prior to gluing or the finished member after fabrication. The most popular pressure treatment for glulam has been pentachlorophenol (in a liquid petroleum) or methylene chloride. These treatments avoid the problems of warping or checking associated with the wetting and drying process used in waterborne treatments such as Chromated Copper Arsenate (CCA). Since its introduction into the United States in the 1930s, laminated timber has most often been a custom prefabricated construction material completely engineered by the seller. The shop drawings, submitted for the contractor’s approval by the laminator and reviewed by the original design team, often survive. It is very important for the architect/engineer team evaluating such structures to obtain a copy of the shop drawings. Designers often place the responsibility for the design on the laminator. Although contract documents may indicate one set of sizes and connections, the shop drawings may reflect a “minimum design” with different member sizes, and a framing system optimized by the laminator. Although laminators often destroy project files after a few years, depending on the legal statute of limitations, shop-drawing tracings may survive. Sometimes the owner or contractor will have a copy of the shop drawing prints. Often the original structural engineer or architect of record will have old shop drawings on file.
CONSERVATION TECHNIQUES Repair and conservation techniques range from replacement in kind to reinforcement with steel and/or epoxy systems. Many structural repairs require the replacement of the decayed ends of arches or A-frames with moment resisting steel legs connected with field-applied shear plates.
164
Timber, Glulam, and Conservation
The usual repair for a horizontal shear problem is to replace the member if it is badly split. Shear reinforcing of other overstressed members that have not failed may include lag screws used to “stitch” the beam together. These are normally inserted through the roof or floor deck, perpendicular to the axis of the beam. Stitch lags are inserted into pre-bored lag lead holes, which may extend almost the full depth of the beam. Three-quarter-inch diameter lag screws are available up to 30 inches in length. Other shear reinforcing may include an exposed joist hanger to support the bottom of a notched beam, steel side plates, or steel or fiber reinforced plastic dowels inserted in vertical holes and epoxied in place with a gap filling epoxy formulated for wood repairs. The zone around the bored hole may be strengthened with an epoxy consolidant prior to inserting a dowel and a split member may be clamped under pressure prior to adding epoxy. Radial tension is a failure similar to horizontal shear that occurs in the curved portion of curved tapered beams and Tudor arches. Again, the typical repair requires insertion of lag screws or reinforcing rods inserted perpendicular to the failure lines. In a curved member, insertion would be on a radial pattern. Bending failures may require the full replacement of a member. If the failure is confined to a few tension laminations, the glulam member can be relieved of its load by jacking. The damaged wood can then be carefully cut away. New high-quality boards obtained from a laminator, planed to the actual thickness of the exiting laminations, can be glued in place using a field-applied, gap-filling epoxy. This work requires the skill of a craftsman and the cooperation of a glulam manufacturer who can furnish long, finger-joined replacement stock. Of course, the cause the failure must be removed. The repair, to be successful, may require the addition of one or more laminations to increase the depth of the member. A bending failure may require that the member be reinforced with steel side plates, bottom plates, or flitch plates. Any repair with steel requires that the engineer balance the load carried by steel with that carried by the glulam timber. The engineer must design the shear transfer between the two materials. Most engineers will ignore the contribution of the glulam and design the steel to carry the full load. In many glued laminated timber buildings, steel side plates have been painted to match the wood finish. If appearance is a major problem, a steel flitch plate can be inserted into a kerf or rout cut into the center of the beam. Often, these cuts are made with a chain saw attached to a guide. The flitch plate must then be securely attached to the wood with a suitable epoxy-bonding agent. Determining plate thickness, height, length and connection method requires a thorough structural analysis. Glued laminated timber beams with inadequate bending capacity can also be reinforced by adding tie rods or bottom plates of steel.
Conservation Techniques
165
Deflection failures, cause by inadequate stiffness, usually lead to bending failures. For example, inadequate stiffness can cause excessive ponding of water on a flat roof leading to failure bending. Of course, the most straightforward repair would be to put a lightweight tapered insulation on the roof and offset the deflection. Most laminated timber beams are cambered to offset dead load deflection. Excessive deflection may indicate that a large overstress is present in existing beams due to dead load only. Certainly, on more than one occasion, cambered glued laminated timber beams have been installed up-side down. Since glued laminated timber is a material that depends upon adhesives, epoxy repairs would be compatible with requirements of the Secretary of the Interior’s Guidelines. Replacement-in-kind of deteriorated laminations is relatively easily accomplished in the field if the moisture content can be controlled and if glulam stock is available. Boards can be planed to width of the member in the field after attachment. In many glued laminated timber structures, the bases of Tudor or radial arches become deteriorated if exposed to moisture.
FIGURE 11-5 Severe deterioration is evident in the leg of a Tudor arch, which was not protected.
166
Timber, Glulam, and Conservation
The connection of the laminated timber arch to its supporting steel shoe is critical because the shoe transfers vertical forces and horizontal thrust through anchor bolts to the foundation. FIGURE 11-6 In this case, axial and bending forces are transferred to a steel leg.
Repairing this type of connection often requires that steel plates be welded to the existing shoe and connected to the glued laminated timber member to resist all forces. FIGURE 11-7 The steel side plates transfer axial loads and bending moment to the support.
The connection of steel side plates to glued laminated timber may require the field installations of 2 5⁄8- or 4-inch-diameter shear plates.
Conservation Techniques
167
FIGURE 11-8 Nine sets of holes and grooves have been installed to accept 4-inch-diameter shear plates.
Shear plates are inserted flush to the face to the member in a dapcut by a special cutter. FIGURE 11-9 Providing a metal covering and blocking to allow moisture to escape will ensure the serviceability of the repair.
168
Timber, Glulam, and Conservation
REPLACEMENT-IN-KIND Because laminated timber structures are composed of many components, sometimes the replacement in kind of a damaged or deteriorated beam, purlin, column or arch half span may be a more cost-efficient solution that an in-place structural repair or reinforcing. Often, replacement-in-kind is not economically feasible. More advances are being made in the field of timber design than in any other area of structural engineering. Recent products include laminated veneer lumber and numerous other beam and joist substitutes. The most important benefits of these reconstituted wood products is the availability of long lengths, higher design values, and greater stiffness. Preservationists and preservation engineers must determine the appropriateness of these materials to each case.
CONCLUSION Only through specialized knowledge and experience can structural engineers make the judgments needed to properly evaluate historic timber structures. The engineer must be convinced that the structural model in the computer is an accurate representation of actual conditions. Once that is clear, the application of rigorous analysis, testing, and engineering judgment may be necessary to explain why the historic timber structure in question has performed adequately for many years.
CHAPTER
12
Tabby: Engineering Characteristics of a Vernacular Construction Material*
INTRODUCTION abby, like historic brick masonry, receives little attention among the general public, as well as within the construction industry. At the present time, research funds for construction-related topics involving coastal issues flow toward wind design, exterior insulation systems, and the geophysical interaction of wind and ocean on shoreline development. In general, historic materials research takes a back seat to other structural engineering endeavors. A discussion of tabby as a construction material must always begin with a definition or a description, because it is unknown to most people in the construction industry. Tabby is an early cast-in-place construction material consisting of sand, lime (from shells and wood ash), and water. Tabby can be considered a lime-based concrete, unreinforced, with shell and shell fragments serving as the coarse aggregate.
T
*This chapter was originally written for The Conservation and Preservation of Tabby: A Symposium on Historic Building Material in the Coastal Southeast, Jekyll Island, GA (February 1998). Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
169
170
Tabby: Engineering Characteristics of a Vernacular Construction Material
FIGURE 12-1 Church wall at St. Helena’s Episcopal Church in Beaufort, SC is a tabby wall with a brick cap.
As an unreinforced concrete product, methods used for the analysis of unreinforced concrete can be applied. As in the evaluation of any historic structure, the evaluation of tabby depends on field observation and measurement, testing, analysis, and engineering judgment. Historically, the quality of tabby construction was dependent on word-ofmouth tradition, as well as the quality of local materials available and the skill and knowledge of the workmen and their supervisor. The recipe, based on oral tradition, usually varied from the Spanish, Portuguese, or Dutch-speaking Caribbean region to the English colonies and was influenced by African traditions.
TABBY MATERIALS AND PROPORTIONS The reprint of the 1867 edition of The Encyclopedia of Architecture gives the following definition for concrete: Concrete is a compound of ballast, or stone chippings, and lime mixed together. It is so called from the speedy concretion that takes place between these particles.1 Since ancient times, chemists and others have formed various opinions about the effects of sand and lime in the formation of mortar. Nineteenth-century publications detail various methods of making mortars and cements of lime. Coal cinders, furnace slag, brick dust, wood ashes, and other ingredients find their way into various recipes for lime mortar.
Compressive Strength
171
In about 1843, Portland cement was developed. Lime and clay are combined by burning. The resulting clinker, ground into a fine powder, made cement much superior in durability to natural cements. When employed in a mortar or a concrete, it was far superior in strength and hardness. Within 50 years, most concrete employed Portland cement in lieu of lime cement. Tabby consists of oyster shell and pit sand aggregate, bonded together with homemade lime and water. The mixture is placed between form boards, which are held together with wood ties and wedges. The tabby mixture was rammed or tamped into place to properly fill the form without voids.
FIGURE 12-2 Tabby is surprisingly durable.
The construction of a wall proceeded upward in 12-inch lifts in a similar fashion to a slip-formed cast-in-place concrete wall.
COMPRESSIVE STRENGTH Depending on the mix and the time and quality of curing, the compressive strengths of new tabby probably ranged between 250 psi and 1,000 psi. Additional sampling and testing should be encouraged in order to increase the body of knowledge regarding tabby strength. Compressive strength is also an indication of hardness, durability, and impermeability.
172
Tabby: Engineering Characteristics of a Vernacular Construction Material
Samples of historic tabby, when tested, have yielded fairly good compressive strengths. Dr. Lauren B. Sickels-Taves tested tabby samples from the Cumberland Island National Seashore for the National Park Service. The results of the tests were as follows: Analysis of Original Tabby: Compressive Strength—350 psi Absorption—84.58 Specific gravity—2.013 Formula—1:3:1 lime:sand:shell with wood ash Stereology—inland beach sand The analysis of tabby ruins or tabby buildings begins with the determination of compressive strength. A preliminary evaluation might depend on nothing more than an assumption, based on engineering judgment, for compressive strength.
TENSILE STRENGTH Tensile strength of tabby is probably 10 to 15 percent of the compression strength. In an unreinforced tabby structure, low tensile strength would significantly affect serviceability. Considerable cracking would occur during both initial shrinkage and subsequent seasonal cycles in temperature. All walls supporting lightly loaded roofs are subjected to tensile forces due to lateral loads or uplift due to wind. For this reason, the tensile strength of tabby must be determined. Most tabby ruins are the remains of buildings that were destroyed by high winds. Presumably, the roofs of these structures were pulled off by high winds causing the collapse of some walls. The low tensile strength of tabby and the lack of anchorage of the roof structure to resist uplift and the absence of continuous vertical ties contributed to these failures.
SHEAR STRENGTH The shear strength of tabby is probably about 50 percent of the compressive strength, ranging from 35 to 80 percent. Shear strength must be determined when evaluating a tabby structure for lateral loads such as wind and earthquake. The model codes are beginning to mandate that sufficient testing be undertaken
Stress–Strain Curve
173
FIGURE 12-3 Typical tabby ruins, Coastal Georgia.
in historic buildings to determine the shear strength of unreinforced masonry buildings for seismic evaluation. Although tabby is not a ductile material, seismic enhancement of tabby structures can be accomplished by increasing the ductility of the total system of walls, floors, and roofs acting together. By tying floor and roof framing to tabby walls while allowing subtle yielding of the joints between the components, the ductility of the total system can be enhanced.
STRESS–STRAIN CURVE Concrete is usually tested by filling 6-inch-diameter by 12-inch-high cylindrical molds with concrete during job placement. These cylinders are allowed to set at the jobsite and are then transported to a testing laboratory to cure for 7 or 28 days. Out of a quantity of five cylinders, two usually are tested at 7 days, two tested at 28 days, and one held in reserve. The samples are molded in accordance with ASTM C-31 and tested in accordance with ASTM C-39 by breaking them in a hydraulically powered compression machine that records load applied versus deformation. The strength at 28 days is the compressive strength, which is specified for concrete. For example: “3000 psi” concrete is actually “3000 psi @ 28 days” concrete. Obviously, historic tabby cannot be sampled fresh and must be removed by being cut or cored from the structure.
174
Tabby: Engineering Characteristics of a Vernacular Construction Material
The testing of a cylinder of tabby or a test prism cut from a tabby wall should yield a stress–strain curve when stress is plotted against strain. The modulus of elasticity of a tabby sample can then be obtained. The results of this test are a measure of the stiffness of the material, and are useful in determining the stability of unbraced walls.
TESTING TABBY Many of the methods of testing concrete and masonry can be applied to tabby. Because of its continuity, which is superior to unit masonry, testing can be applied easily to samples, assuming that the samples can be removed, transported, trimmed, and capped without crumbling. Olivia Alison, curator of the Telfair Museum of Art, saved several cores obtained from HVAC work completed at the Owens-Thomas House at the Telfair Museum of Art in Savannah. These cores, 45/8 inches in diameter, were taken from the thick interior walls of the mansion.
FIGURE 12-4 The cores were obtained from holes made through the walls for piping.
Two cores were transported to the Froehling & Robertson, Inc., office in Raleigh, trimmed, capped, and tested in a Forney 500,000-pound-capacity testing machine.
Testing Tabby
175
FIGURE 12-5 The two samples were capped in similar fashion to concrete cylinders.
The core samples A and B failed at an ultimate load of 14,945 pounds, or 890 psi, and 15,499 or 923 psi, respectively. FIGURE 12-6 The tabby cores were tested in a 500,000pound-capacity machine.
In situ tests that have been developed for masonry can be applied to tabby. As with masonry and concrete, obtaining accurate values for compression and shear is important. Unit weight is a physical property often overlooked, but important for analysis.
176
Tabby: Engineering Characteristics of a Vernacular Construction Material
WALL CONSTRUCTION Tabby walls are proportioned so that buckling due to slenderness is not a problem. Use of the basic equation for unreinforced masonry or concrete walls shows that a height to thickness ratio of 10 to 1 does not cause a reduction in strength due to slenderness. The eccentric loading due to timber trusses or large floor beams probably can be ignored if distributed on a thick wood plate. Because of its relatively low strengths, tabby performs well when uniformly loaded. The support of a post or beam on a tabby wall is problematic when concentrated loads are not distributed, such as on a wood plate or brick masonry block. At St. Helena’s Episcopal Church in Beaufort, South Carolina, the brick masonry sidewalls are supported on a tabby foundation wall that is 26 inches thick. The computed design pressure for the combined dead load and live load of 6.8 psi is low when compared to the 350 psi compressive strength obtained by Sickels-Taves. In St. Helena’s we have a fairly uniform load. There are no cracks in the sidewalls related to settlement caused by failure in the tabby. Stucco and plaster applied to tabby walls not only protect them but give them greater strength. A thorough analysis would include these materials in a composite section. The reapplication of these surface treatments provides an opportunity for reinforcing a tabby wall with metal lath, although corrosive environments may dictate that a stainless steel lath be used. The stucco layer can conceal earthquake or wind anchors, which may be required to tie floor and roof structures to tabby walls.
TABBY REINFORCING Inset wood grounds, nailers, or plates can provide the horizontal continuity in a tabby wall capable of resisting tensile forces due to lateral loads. Often, these elements in historic structures are badly deteriorated and are in need of replacement. The tensile capacity of such elements is dependent on the net cross-sectional area of sound material, bond capacity, and continuity through joints.
SERVICEABILITY Tabby is a surprisingly durable construction material when kept dry and free from freeze–thaw degradation. During construction, the formula of lime, sand, shell, and wood ash mixed and placed under field conditions was subject to variation. In tabby, because it is
Serviceability
177
FIGURE 12-7 The Horton-DuBignon House on Jekyll Island (ca. 1738) is one of the oldest tabby structures in Georgia. (See color insert.)
an unreinforced lime-based cementacious product, only low strengths can be achieved compared to modern-day Portland cement concrete. It is a durable material when protected by stucco, actually hardening with time due to carbonation.
FIGURE 12-8 The intersecting interior wall provides stability to the two-story Horton House ruins.
178
Tabby: Engineering Characteristics of a Vernacular Construction Material
STABILIZATION The most appropriate stabilization for a tabby wall should be the same as that employed for any historic brick masonry wall suffering damage. Traditional repairs are the most direct, using similar technology to that available to the original builder. Walls function best when they are braced by floors and roofs. All masonry walls provide better service when they are part of an occupied building with an intact roof system. Methods for preserving tabby should be similar to those of any other masonry system, with repairs determined on a case-by-case basis. Protecting a tabby structure from moisture should be the primary goal.
FIGURE 12-9 In 1899, steel rods were added and the tops of Horton House walls were capped.
RUINS CONSERVATION Structural stabilization of tabby ruins is required if close inspection by the public is to be allowed. Over a long period of time, tall, unbraced walls and chimney structures tend to collapse due to high wind events. If subjected to a sufficient number of storms of sufficient magnitude, what remains are walls that are stable until deterioration reduces their capacity further. Bracing may be required if analysis indicates that a wall exceeds a certain maximum unbraced
Reference
179
length, which has been calculated, or if calculations indicate that sufficient wind can be applied to overstress the free-standing wall. Because of the open nature of ruins, a free-standing wall is subject to wind forces from two directions normal to its face. Analysis is similar to a sign or solid fence, using building-code wind-load factors for such structures.
DESIGN AND ANALYSIS Soil cement or terracrete requires pressure to help bind the ingredients because moisture and cement are both limited. Soil cement has been used in the manufacture of unit masonry by ramming the mixed ingredients by hand into a mold. The design and analysis of tabby, soil cement, and adobe are similar.
CONCLUSION Tabby is a traditional construction material important to the coastal areas of the southeastern United States and the Caribbean. Conserving historic tabby buildings and ruins that remain will require that we undertake sufficient research to better understand this construction material. Tabby can be analyzed in much the same way as unreinforced Portland cement concrete is analyzed. Through observation, measurement, testing, and analysis, tabby structures can be evaluated to determine their structural serviceability.
REFERENCE 1. Gwilt, Joseph. The Encyclopedia of Architecture, the Classic 1867 Edition, The Complete Guide to Architecture from Antiquity to Nineteenth Century. New York: Crown Publishers, 1982.
CHAPTER
13
Relocating the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse
INTRODUCTION he relocation of the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse and dependencies involved structural issues related to lifting, transporting, and supporting the various buildings at the new location. The International Chimney Corporation (ICC) of Buffalo, New York, won the design-build contract from the National Park Service. The relocation team included five subcontracting consulting firms, a structural mover, and a unified hydraulics system expert. Any relocation transportation system must deal with the act of lifting the structure off the ground, transferring the load to a transport system, moving the structure along the move route, and transferring the load of the structure from the transport/support system to the new foundation. The 208-foot-tall brick and granite masonry tower completed in 1872 was originally constructed 1,600 feet from the shoreline. It rested on a double layer mat of 6 ⫻ 12 southern pine timbers, laying flat. The timber mat was located approximately 4 feet below the water table, keeping it safe from deterioration. On the timber mat rested the base of the lighthouse consisting of hard, dressed stones of pink Vermont granite grouted into place.
T
Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
181
182
Relocating the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse
FIGURE 13-1 The Cape Hatteras Lighthouse is 208 feet tall. It weights 4,800 tons.
BACKGROUND The case for moving the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse was made in a paper, by this author, titled “Straight Line Move Necessitated by the Migration of the Barrier Islands,” presented at the Annual APT Conference, October 1986, in Austin, Texas. That paper discussed the inevitable migration of the barrier islands, the original construction of the lighthouse, examples of other similar large buildings moved successfully in the United States and elsewhere, and the technology available to accomplish the task. A lighthouse is by nature obstinate and stubborn, standing as it does on the edge of the earth, subject to the ravages of the sea. When a lighthouse is threatened by time and the environment, it is popular to rally to its defense, often with the same obstinacy that the lighthouse exhibits daily. So it is with the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse in North Carolina. This wonderful structure was designed in the 1860s painstakingly by hand, without benefit of computers. The bricks were made and laid by hand. Beautifully
Background
183
proportioned and crafted, this lighthouse has symbolized North Carolina’s Outer Banks for years. Now it was threatened by the relentless surf and the westward migration of the barrier island on which it stood. By 1988, the black and white diagonally striped Cape Hatteras Lighthouse had warned mariners for 116 years of the treacherous waters that have given North Carolina’s Outer Banks the nickname “Graveyard of the Atlantic.” The Light Station at Buxton is a symbol of the Outer Banks and of maritime culture and may be the best known of American lighthouses. Because of its historical importance in the region and, indeed, the nation, the distinctive tower is included on the National Register of Historic Places. In much the same way that the structure dominates the landscape, so too is the lighthouse prominent in the local culture. It was obvious that migration of the North Carolina barrier islands would, in time, undermine this historic structure. Dr. Orrin H. Pilkey, a Duke University geologist and noted authority on the Outer Banks, stated many times that “the attempts to save the lighthouse in place are doomed.” On May 19, 1985, a Cape Hatteras Shoreline Erosion Workshop was held at Buxton, North Carolina. Participants included representatives from the National Park Service, North Carolina State University, the University of Virginia, the Army Corps of Engineers, and the North Carolina Department of Natural Resources and Community Development. The purpose of the workshop was to review the patterns and frequency of ocean shoreline changes in the vicinity of the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse. Regardless of the database or study used, it was clear to the participants that the long-term change in this shoreline is characterized by erosion. This erosion trend appears to be consistent with changes reported for most of the mid-Atlantic coast. They concluded that causes were a combination of longterm sea level rise, storms, and both manmade and natural reduction in sediment supply. The erosion of the beach was documented by reviewing 18 publications dealing with the quantification of erosion and accretion. The information reviewed was based on aerial photographs and bathymetric charts for a period of 100 years. Shoreline erosion is a manifestation of the whole island changing shape and position. Migration of the Barrier Islands is a well-documented natural condition caused by the forces of waves, tides, and wind. As the Barrier Islands roll over themselves in tank-tread fashion, nature maintains the dynamic equilibrium of the beaches through unceasing trade-offs of material, energy, topology, and the rising sea level. For thousands of years, the traditional methods of protecting shorelines have centered around stabilizing the natural system. The construction of marine
184
Relocating the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse
structures such as groins and jetties perpendicular to the shoreline attempt to stabilize shorelines by trapping sand carried by littoral currents running parallel to the shoreline. Structures constructed parallel to the shoreline, such as seawalls, bulkheads, and revetments, are built to protect a shoreline by absorbing the impact of the breaking waves, while breakwaters are designed to dampen wave energy before it reaches shore. Many millions of dollars have been spent replenishing or “nourishing” beaches by pumping new sand onto the beach or into longshore currents. Since anything built on the beach usually increases the rate of erosion, relocation of the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse would be the preferred alternative to construction of an encircling revetment wall. Relocation of such a structure would demonstrate the feasibility of a coastal management policy that would respect the natural migration of the Barrier Islands in an area where the rapid development of permanent structures is sure to lead to disaster. The long-term history at Cape Hatteras has been shoreline erosion at an average of approximately 11 feet per year. More than 1,200 shipwrecks have occurred in the waters off Cape Hatteras since the first recorded wreck in 1526. Hatteras is the point where two major ocean currents off the east coast, the northbound Gulf Stream and the southbound remnant of the Labrador Current, collide head on. This collision causes constant turbulence of Cape Hatteras, which has resulted in the formation of a shifting mass of underwater sand bars that stretch eastward into the Atlantic from the cape for some 14 miles, creating Diamond Shoals, dreaded by mariners the world over. Congress heeded the call of coastal captains for navigational aids specifically designed to assist offshore vessels by passing an act in 1794 that provided for the drafting of construction plans for a first-rate lighthouse to be built at Cape Hatteras. The first Cape Hatteras Lighthouse was a 90-foot high, octagonal shaped, sandstone structure completed in 1802. In 1850, complaints to a newly formed Light House Board regarding the inadequacy of the Cape Hatteras light were heard. The light was inadequate to be seen a great distances, and the tower was not tall enough to penetrate a blanket of haze that formed over nearby Diamond Shoals and the cape itself. In March 1867, Congress appropriated $75,000 for the construction of a new lighthouse at Hatteras. The Light House Board insisted that” (in) a tower so exposed as the new one proposed for Cape Hatteras, it is desirable to take every measure to secure the very best materials.”1 The materials included one million “prime dark red brick” at a cost of $12.35 per thousand supplied by Nicholas M. Smith of Baltimore. The brick and stone for the foundation were transported by schooners or shallow-draft steamers to a point in the open
Background
185
sound where materials were transferred to lighters. These scows could not get all the way to shore, so a long wharf had to be built into the sound. A tram railway was constructed from the wharf to the construction site to transport building materials over mucky marsh and soft sand. David Stick, in his book North Carolina Lighthouses, describes the laying of the foundation of the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse.1 Instead of contracting with a private firm for the project, the Light House Board took on the job with its own crew, hired a foreman, and employed day labor, all under the general direction of a district engineer. The foreman selected for the Cape Hatteras project was Dexter Stetson, a man ingenious enough to figure out new ways of getting things done and capable of doing them. Dexter Stetson’s working party was on the job in early November 1868. Construction began on quarters and a messroom for the crew, a blacksmith shop, two derricks, and storage buildings for cement and other perishable materials, as well as the wharf, tram railway, and scows. Because the lighthouse was to be constructed on a relatively low beach covered with soft sand, there was special concern about the foundation. Original plans had called for driving heavy pilings into the sand as support for the huge blocks of granite that were to serve as a base for the tower, but Stetson found that he could a drive a sounding rod only 9 feet into the sand. He then discovered one of those contradictions of nature that coastal residents tend to take for granted. The very same sand that is so dry and soft near the surface that a man’s foot will sink to a depth of an inch or two with every step is almost invariably damp and compact only a couple of feet down. It thus forms an exceptionally sturdy foundation capable of supporting tremendous weight.1 Accordingly, Stetson proceeded to excavate a wide hole 6 feet deep. Finding that he could drive the pilings only 6 more feet below that level as a result of “the sand being very hard and compact,” he devised an entirely different method of supporting the structure. Because his 6-foot hole had rapidly filled with water, he took advantage of another phenomenon of nature: the resistance of certain types of wood to decay so long as they are totally submerged in water and thus not exposed to the air. By building a cofferdam around his huge hole in the sand, he was able to keep the hole free of water with the use of “powerful steam engines.” He then laid a course of 6-by-12-inch southern pine timbers in the bottom of the hole and placed a second course of 6 ⫻ 12s crossway on top of the first layer. Using the timbers as a base, he then “laid a massive octagonal foundation, composed of large blocks of granite laid in cement mortar, a rubble masonry, the interstices being filled with smaller stone of the same kind.”1 When this was done, he turned off the steam engines and let the water seep back into the hole, covering the pine timbers.1
186
Relocating the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse
From the ground level, four more octagonal courses of cut granite were added, each narrower than the preceding one, thus giving the outward appearance of huge stone steps surrounding the exposed foundation. Above this foundation for a height of approximately 10 feet cut granite was laid at each corner with solid brick between, thus providing a base sufficient to support the weight of the massive circular brick tower that was to rise above it. As the crew of masons continued to lay course after course of brick, gradually reducing the diameter of the tower as they worked skyward, metal stairways were installed. When at last the structure was completed, the Light House Board shipped down a first-order flashing lens of the most modern design with a lampist named George J. Crossman to install it properly. The current tower, round and 208 feet tall, was completed 600 feet north of the original 1802 sandstone structure and 1,600 feet from the shoreline; the older light was demolished. Yet by 1919, the shoreline had eroded to within 300 feet of the second tower. In an effort to arrest the trend, the Lighthouse Service installed 900 linear feet of interlocking groins in 1930. Within two years, though, the shoreline was 100 feet from the light station, prompting the construction of more groins, which also proved ineffective. In 1935, land was acquired for a new light station, and a metal frame tower 150 feet in height was completed the following years. Upon exhibiting the new light, the 44 acres comprising the old site were turned over to the Department of the Interior for use by the National Park Service. In the following decade, the erosion was reversed by accretion along the shoreline. As a result, in 1950 the National Park Service and the Coast Guard entered into an agreement that allowed the light to be moved back to the striped tower. Basically, the agreement specified that the National Park service controls the light station, while the Coast Guard was obligated to take appropriate action to maintain a light, whether in the tower or elsewhere. Since 1950, though, erosion rather than accretion had affected the coast in the vicinity of the station, and again the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse was threatened with destruction by the sea. In 1979, the National Park Service commissioned a study for the feasibility and cost estimate for relocating the lighthouse.2 The proposed method called for the relocation of the complete light station to an area 2,800 feet southwest from its present site. Two keeper’s quarters and an oilhouse would be relocated along with the 2,600-ton lighthouse. For that study, MTMA Design Group of Raleigh, an architectural firm, hired the author to provide consulting structural engineering services to assist in determining the means and methods of such a relocation and assist in the cost estimating. Previously in 1978 we had provided consultation to MTMA Design Group for a similar study for the Cape Lookout
Background
187
Lighthouse which was also threatened by erosion.3 For the Cape Lookout study we naively concluded that the lighthouse could be cut into four to five pieces to be moved separately. It was obvious that for the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse there would have to be another approach because the base alone weighed more than 700 tons. The 208-foot-tall lighthouse is a brick masonry cylinder enclosed by a truncated cone. The inner and outer walls are connected by numerous shear walls. The center of gravity of the lighthouse is only 56 feet above the base. Proportioning the lighthouse with a low center of gravity enables it to withstand high wind forces tending to overturn such a tall structure. Its inherent stability against overturning is critical to the feasibility of relocating this massive structure in one piece. Because of economics, the relocation of very large masonry structures is usually made in a straight line or along a smooth horizontal curve on fixed rails. Even though the lighthouse was at that time estimated to weigh 2,600 tons above grade, it was more feasible to move the structure in one piece rather than several. The cylindrical tower could have been cut into manageable sections, but the octagonal base, weighing 768 tons, would remain a very heavy piece to relocate intact. Thus, the proposed method to move the lighthouse in its entirety, in a straight line, along steel and concrete rails to a new foundation was judged to be a more simple and practical solution once the structure is lifted from its foundation. The new site, as selected by the National Park Service for the relocation study, would be 2,800 feet southwest of the current site and 2,400 feet from the shoreline. Factors influencing site selection include soil-bearing capacity and water table depth, elevation and stability of the landscape, number of years before coastal erosion again would affect the structure, and ease of moving across the intervening landscape. To lift the lighthouse from its foundation, we proposed that heavy-steel needle beams would be horizontally inserted in two directions through the octagonal base. The beams would be connected to steel girders, forming a square in plan; numerous struts would brace the girders to each other. The structural steel would weigh an estimated 150 tons, with the largest piece weighing 33 tons.2 The lighthouse, along with the steel framework, would then be raised by twenty-two 150-ton hydraulic jacks. Sufficient cutting of brick and stone would be required to ensure a relatively clean separation from the foundation, which would then be relocated to the new site. The proposed procedure would require that two parallel rails be constructed to the new site. The rails would consist of 1 ¼-inch continuous steel
188
Relocating the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse
plates bearing, on concrete grade beams, on a wide band of sand stabilized with Portland cement. Upon visiting the structure on September 13, 1986, Mr. Kenneth Adair, a building mover contractor from Boynton Beach, Florida, stated to this author that there is “no question” that the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse can safely be moved.
FIGURE 13-2 Kenneth Adair (right) consulted with the author in September 1986.
The solution proposed by Mr. Adair would require that five to six parallel rails be construction to spread the weight of the moving load more evenly on the supporting sand layers below. This discussion validated the assumptions we made regarding the feasibility of location made seven years before. Machinery available to move a large masonry structures include hydraulic cylinder jacks, industrial rollers, and cable pulling machines to provide the force needed to overcome static friction at the initiation of movement and to sustain a constant rate of movement. The Simplex Division of Templeton, Kenly & Company of Broadview, Illinois, had been manufacturing high tonnage hydraulic cylinders for 40 years.
Background
189
Simplex/Pine hydraulic cylinders are available from stock in capacities, ranging from 150 to 500 tons with piston travels from 3 to 12 inches. Higher capacities and longer travels can be engineered into the hydraulic cylinder jacks. Hightonnage hydraulic cylinder jacks, manufactured by many companies, have been used in countless applications throughout the world for many years.4 Hillman Incorporated, of Wall, New Jersey, manufactures large industrial rollers with load capacities of 300 to 500 tons per unit. Constructed of hardened steel, these rollers can move very heavy loads with a 5 percent coefficient of friction between bearing surfaces.5 The Lucker Manufacturing Company is a division of the American Hoist and & Derrick Company Manufactures Pulling Machines, which pull wire rope with a continuous, steady, smooth motion. The hydraulic power unit, powered by electric motor, gasoline, or diesel engine, can exert pulling up to one million pounds at a normal speed of 3 feet per minute. Pull machine controls provide for precise and full control of the pulling operation. A direct reading calibrated gauge tells the operator the actual pounds or kilograms pulling on the wire rope at all times. Force of pull and speed are fully adjustable from zero to maximum. It was obvious that the equipment required to accomplish the task was available in several forms by many vendors. The physics involved in the horizontal moving of any object is rather simple. In the horizontal direction, the force required to produce movement is a function of the mass of the structure and the acceleration required to overcome the friction forces between the surface of the rollers and the rails. In other words, in the case of the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse, a 130-ton force would be required to move the 2,600-ton structure from a stationary position to a very slow velocity in the horizontal direction. The stability of the lighthouse is a question of simple statics. In the vertical direction, the underlying sands will “push up” with an opposite force equivalent to the weight of the lighthouse, thus providing stability in the vertical direction. This is no problem as the underlying geology is composed of very dense sands. The overturning forces imposed on the lighthouse due to small horizontal accelerations during the moving operation would be insignificant compared to the overturning forces produced by a 120 mph wind. The overturning stability of the lighthouse is excellent because its proportions were determined to specifically resist horizontal wind load forces. The successes, for many years, of building movers in the United States is well documented in such periodicals as Scientific American, Engineering News Record, and House and Building Mover magazine. In 1923 the firm of John Eichleay, Jr., Company, of Pittsburgh, Pennsylvania, moved the 3,200-ton St. Nicholas Roman Catholic Church on East Ohio Street in
190
Relocating the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse
Pittsburgh, a distance of 20 feet. The church consisted of heavy brick walls with timber-framed floors and roof structure. The building measured 110 feet by 65 feet with two towers flanking the narthex. The contractor utilized 85-pound steel rails, 3-inch rollers, and numerous screw jacks, as well as a considerable amount of timber cribbing and “running timbers.” There was no interruption in the use of the building and no damage to the delicate plaster or stained glass windows.6 This same contractor, in 1903, moved the 600-ton Col. Brown mansion 160 feet vertically from the banks of the Monongahela River in Pittsburgh to the top of the bluff overlooking the river. FIGURE 13-3 The Col. Brown Mansion was moved in Pittsburgh, Pennsylvania, in 1903.
The brick house measuring 85 feet by 40 feet was lifted in stages to four benches cut into the face of the cliff. Again, the technology was similar, utilizing steel needle beams, screw jacks, and timber cribbing.7 More recently, in 1975, the sixteenth-century Church of the Virgin Mary at Most, Czechoslovakia, weighing 12,000 tons, was moved because it prevented access to large underground coal deposits. It was moved 800 yards on rails at 0.0013 mph over a period of 4 weeks at a cost of $15,300,000.
Background
191
FIGURE 13-4 The Church of the Annunciation of the Virgin Mary, Most, Czech Republic. Source: Courtesy of the City of Most, Michal Hornof.
FIGURE 13-5 The Church of the Virgin Mary moved along a curved route. Source: Courtesy of the City of Most, Michal Hornof.
In 1966, the 3,200-year old Temples of Ramesses II, at Abu Simbel in Egypt, were moved to site 212 feet above and 690 feet back from the approaching shoreline of Lake Nasser. Italian engineers, in 1965, proposed to move each of the temples in a single piece. One weighing 291,500 tons and the other 60,500 tons.
192
Relocating the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse
The estimated cost for this proposal was $90 million. Alternatively, the temples were cut into 950 pieces weighing 30 tons or less. The relocation effort that rescued these ancient structures was chronicled in the May 1966 issue of National Geographic in an article titled “Saving the Ancient Temples at Abu Simbel.”8 FIGURE 13-6 The Temples of Ramses were moved in 1966. Source: Courtesy of Denise Chan’s Flickr stream, Creative Commons License AttributionShare Alike 2.0 Generic.
The relatively simple structure of the lighthouse and its location are two aspects that contribute to the technical feasibility of relocation. It is not an ancient structure. Detailed plans showing the construction of the lighthouse are filed with the Coast Guard in New London, Connecticut.9 We argued that the relocation of the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse would be beneficial to the State of North Carolina in terms of tourism not only during the moving operation, but also thereafter; the value of the lighthouse as a historic site would be enhanced because this would be the lighthouse that was “moved.” It would have an impact on our policy regarding coastal management and zoning that would recognize the migrating nature of the barrier islands and the feasibility of relocating large structures. The philosophy/argument that if a structure is moved its historic significance is compromised was invalid here. To the contrary, the revetment is a traditional “hold back the sea” approach, which denies the migrating nature of the barrier islands. It would have permanently changed the site, creating within 50 to 70 years a new island, restricting access, and obscuring the view of the
Design Issues
193
lighthouse. Building a wall is a primitive, expensive, and ultimately futile attempt to save the lighthouse because when the island itself is undercut by the sea, there will be no more alternatives. In this case, moving the lighthouse 1,000 yards preserved its historic setting among the dunes, with its outbuildings surrounding it, for at least 200 years. It was a valid approach, since the technology to move it was readily available. This was a project worthy of national attention and of size sufficient to demonstrate new approaches to preservation. We were concerned about having our preservationist ideals entrenched within the bureaucracy to such an extent that valid, economical solutions are ignored to the detriment of the structure. In an amazing reversal, the National Park Service embraced the idea of relocation as the best solution for saving the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse. It was important that the citizens of the United States to have an opportunity to save the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse in a manner that would result in the least amount of disruption, the most permanent solution, and the lowest possible cost. The Move the Lighthouse Committee, a small, nonprofit, group dedicated to the relocation of the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse, was created shortly after the National Park Service announced that it intended, with the U.S. Army Corps of Engineers as consultant, to build a seawall revetment to protect the lighthouse in place. During a jobsite visit in Raleigh I mentioned to Barrett Wilson that the proposed revetment wall would not work, and that furthermore, I knew that relocation was feasible because, as consultant to MTMA, we had determined that the cost for relocation was estimated to be 2.74 million dollars. Barrett thought that we should organize an effort to pressure the National Park Service to reverse their decision. We wrote many letters to the National Park Service, the US Army Corps of Engineers, and our elected officials and informally published the document “Move It or Lose It!” This organization, consisting of Barrett Wilson of Raleigh, North Carolina, David M. Bush, formerly of Duke University, Dr. Orrin Pilkey of Duke University, and this author began to lobby against the seawall revetment, and for relocation. In 1988, the Park Service revisited its decision with the assistance of the National Research Council’s Committee on Options for Preserving Cape Hatteras Lighthouse. The National Research Council’s agreed with the Move the Lighthouse Committee and selected relocation as the preferred option.
DESIGN ISSUES The Park Service first solicitated design proposals for the relocation of the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse. We participated in the brainstorming part of that effort and our team was selected for the project. During the design proposal
194
Relocating the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse
our team considered, and then quickly rejected, two possible alternatives for primary elements of the project. First, we considered the idea that the lighthouse required a gantry or bracing structure to provide stability during transport. We reasoned that by its inherent service as a navigational aide, subjected to high wind forces, the lighthouse is proportioned to be highly stable and thus did not require a supplemental bracing structure. Our analysis showed that the factor of safety against overturning, in a 120 mph wind, was at least 17 to 1. At no point in a 120 mph wind does the lower portion of the windward side of the masonry structure develop tensile forces due to overturning. We estimated that a stiff gantry structure of steel would weigh at least 200 tons. Construction of such a tower would negatively affect the schedule and the budget with little or no benefit in return. Unfortunately this project did not move forward because the funding was not in place. The selected alternative in the International Chimney Corporation designbuild proposal consisted of steel cross beams, main carrying beams, and a steel cradle at the base of the lighthouse. This is the critical area that must be contained while a controlled application of force is applied to the bearing surfaces at the lift points. Our team considered and rejected the idea that a continuous hard rail system had to be built along the total length of travel. We instead agreed that a set of steel rails and a steel mat which would be advanced in leapfrog fashion along the route would have many advantages. For strength, ease of handling, availability, and salvage value, a mat consisting of W10 ⫻ 54 steel beams was selected.
LIFTING THE LIGHTHOUSE The ICC team considered separating the lighthouse at the floor level, at midheight of the base above grade, and below the base of the lighthouse. International Chimney Corporation rejected all alternatives in favor of lifting the lighthouse from several feet below grade. Separating the lighthouse at floor level was rejected because it would require considerable rehabilitation of brick and stone and separate the work into essentially two large moves. The second alternate was rejected for the same reason. Although work would be more efficient above grade, the cost for rehabilitation of the stonework and brick masonry above grade would negatively impact the project. A lift of the total structure from below the base was also rejected because of the much greater weight involved, the large vertical distance for the lift, and the expense of working below the water table. Although the total lift alternative is an attractive possibility because of the retention of historic fabric, the overall cost
Lifting the Lighthouse
195
would be 30 to 50 percent greater than the selected scheme. The selected alternative allowed us to perform the majority of work between grade and the water table. Cutting through the base with a cable saw provided an opportunity to observe conditions within the stone base and mitigate adverse conditions prior to the lift. The builder, Dexter Stetson, did an exceptional job of placing and grouting the Vermont granite stones. Cable saw cuts by International Chimney revealed a solid, well-grouted base consisting of large semidressed granite blocks. Compressive strength tests made of cores obtained from the granite were in the 16,000 psi range. So hard was the granite that cutting through the base required much more time than originally scheduled. The ICC team considered and rejected a deep foundation for the rail system as unnecessary. Preliminary soil borings indicated that hard stiff sands are fairly close to the ground surface. We agreed that the most cost-effective approach was to mitigate the loose soils utilizing vibratory compaction methods. This technique provides a wide path of uniformly dense sands. We rejected the deep pile solution because of the variable support provided in the system. Hard supports at pile locations would have contrasted with intermediate support points, depending on the stiffness of the grade beams that would have to span between. The cost of grade beams to span even short distances would be prohibitively high. The cost for the removal of piles after construction would also negatively affect the schedule and budget. We also considered, and then rejected, a new foundation supported by piles. Again, the presence of near surface dense sands made a deep foundation unnecessary. Our team agreed that the original builder Dexter Stetson’s method of building a raft or mat as support for the lighthouse was the most cost-effective alternative. He utilized a double mat of 6 ⫻ 12 southern pine timbers as support for a granite base of large, semi-dressed stones grouted in place. Jobsite inspection, monitoring, and testing services for the lighthouse relocation included geotechnical engineering associated with the rail support system along the relocation alignment and at the new relocated lighthouse site, as well as testing and inspection services during the preparation and construction of the rail system and the new lighthouse foundation site, and also continuous monitoring of the stress and strain within the structure during the actual move. Field and laboratory testing by Law Engineering and Environmental Services Inc. (MACTEC) was presented in a geotechnical report describing the findings of the investigation. Included were recommendations for subgrade preparation and foundation support along the route and at the new lighthouse location. The procedures for subgrade preparation, along with subgrade performance during the
196
Relocating the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse
relocation, were addressed. The geotechnical investigation for the new lighthouse location included recommendations for site preparation and requirements for foundation support. Full-time testing and inspection was required in order to verify the continuity of subsurface conditions indicated in the geotechnical report and to monitor construction activities to verify that adequate foundation subgrade conditions were achieved. In addition to monitoring of the subsurface conditions, on-site geotechnical personnel provided in-place density tests of subgrade soils. The on-site monitoring provided information, on a continuous basis, to on-site personnel as to the motion and strains to which the lighthouse was being subjected and issue warnings if the established parameters had been approached or exceeded. Data was also compiled at three locations for various team members in Buffalo, Chicago, and Atlanta.
ROUTE PREPARATION After excavation and dewatering, the base of the lighthouse was “mined” by cutting through with a stone cutting cable saw.
FIGURE 13-7 After the excavation, of the original foundation had to be dewatered.
Route Preparation
197
FIGURE 13-8 The original granite foundation was cut away using cable saws.
This horizontal cut proceeded in 4- to 5-foot stages as stone was removed. FIGURE 13-9 Stone was mined from the base of the lighthouse as shoring posts were installed.
This provided a 6-foot tall space under the lighthouse, where steel shoring beams and posts could be placed. As the mining operation proceeded, stone was replaced by the shoring system consisting of transverse W8 ⫻ 35 shoring
198
Relocating the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse
beams and 5-inch-diameter, double extra strong, shoring posts on heavy bearing plates supported by one layer of 6 ⫻ 8 oak cribbing. FIGURE 13-10 A steel mat was installed to support the pipe column shoring posts.
Supporting the oak cribbing was a continuous steel mat of W10 ⫻ 54s that rested on the original timber mat. The 70-foot-long steel mats were inserted first. After the cribbing and plates were placed, the shoring posts were installed, spaced 4 foot on center in one direction and 4 foot, 6 inches on center in the other direction. After installing cross-bracing angles, the W8 ⫻ 35 shoring beams were installed on top of the posts. Built into each post was a Simplex™ 50-ton hydraulic jack with a 10-inch stroke. As each section was completed, the hydraulic jacks were pressurized to support their share of the total weight transferred to the shoring steel, the next section was sawed through, and the stone removed. Steel mats, cribbing, bearing plates, posts, and shoring beams followed the mining of each section until the lighthouse was supported on steel in its entirety. Heavy cross steel consisting of 60-foot-long W14 ⫻ 145 beams were inserted parallel to and between the shoring beams. Gaps above the shoring beams were grouted and shimmed. Below the 13 cross beams, seven main beams consisting of seventy, 72-foot-long double W24 ⫻ 162 beams were inserted transverse to the shoring steel and parallel to the move direction. The main beams contained inverted hydraulic cylinders that rested on Hillman™ industrial rollers. This assembly was the heart of the system. Repeated 100 times,
Route Preparation
199
the 100-ton hydraulic jacks had more than sufficient capacity to support the lighthouse during the move. The lighthouse was lifted in stages using the synchronized hydraulic system. After the cylinders were sufficiently extended, 6 ⫻ 8 oak cribbing was installed as a temporary support. The load was transferred from the jacks to the cribbing, and then the posts, jacks, and plates were reset at higher elevation on additional cribbing. In this manner the lighthouse was lifted out of its original excavation to a height that would allow it to move horizontally on the track of densified soils, stone subbase, steel mats, and track beams. Five hydraulic push jacks connected to the track beams and the double main beams were used to propel the lighthouse and its supporting steel. Each push jack was connected to a track beam with a hydraulic clamp. The 4,800 tons quietly moved along the tracks, pushed in 4- to 5-foot increments. After the push jacks were extended, the hydraulic clamps would release to allow the push jacks to retract for the next push. As the mat and track steel were passed over and cleared, these items were picked up and relocated in front of the lighthouse. This “leapfrogging” of stone and steel was the limiting factor to the rate of travel for the lighthouse. FIGURE 13-11 The main steel “leapfrogged” along the route to the new site.
Moving the lighthouse from the prepared travel route onto the new foundation essentially reversed of the process used to move it off the old foundation. A transition zone of stepped cribbing was used to carry the track steel across the new foundation.
200
Relocating the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse
FIGURE 13-12 The Lighthouse was lifted out of its original position to the proper grade.
Once the correct position was reached, a sequential operation of placing steel support columns between the cross steel to the foundation allowed for the removal of the track beams and main beams. Support columns were installed while the lighthouse was still elevated; setting the lighthouse to its proper elevation, and allowing the columns to support the load of the lighthouse, while the support frame was sequentially dismantled from the mains down.
FOUNDATION DESIGN Eighty percent of the weight of the lighthouse was estimated to lie within a donut-shaped footprint. This load pattern was used to distribute the weight to the shoring beams and towers, cross beams and main steel, and the new foundation. The new foundation was proportioned by applying the load from the lighthouse in three stages across the footing. The Portland Cement Association concrete design software PCA-Mats™ was used to check footing thickness and reinforcing quantities. Although the original footing mat had been a double criss-cross layer of 6 ⫻ 12 dense southern pine timbers, laying flat, the new foundation was 60 feet wide to accommodate the moving system. It was designed to subgrade parameters provided by the geotechnical consultant. Footing thicknesses reviewed included 36, 48, and 60 inches. Final parameters used for design consisted of a subgrade modulus (Ks) of 50 kcf and an allowable
New Foundation
201
soil bearing pressure (Qa) of 6,000 psf. Analysis indicated that a 48-inch thickness provided a balanced design between concrete and reinforcing steel with a comfortable factor of safety in bending and shear for the various loading conditions during and after the move.
FIGURE 13-13 The new foundation consisted of a 4-foot-thick reinforced concrete mat 60 feet square in plan.
NEW FOUNDATION The original timber mat provided satisfactory support for over 125 years. Available soils data, experience, and testing in the Buxton area indicated that soil conditions at the new location were very similar to those at the original location. A concrete mat foundation 4'-0" thick by 60'-0" square was designed to distribute the weight of the lighthouse uniformly across a wide area with the least amount of internal stress in the foundation structure. The foundation mat was proportioned to impart relatively low stresses to the underlying soils. Because the load of the lighthouse was applied nonuniformly to the new concrete mat as the lighthouse was moved onto it, the new mat contained additional reinforcing to accommodate the changing stress pattern. Reinforcing consisted of epoxy coated #10 (1¼-inch diameter) bottom bars spaced at 8 inches on center each way and #10 reinforcing bars spaced at 14 inches on center each way in the top of the mat. Strips through the middle of the footing had additional reinforcing to accommodate bending stresses imparted
202
Relocating the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse
by the moving load. The reinforcing was placed in a layout that recognized the directional manner of the movement and accommodated stresses resulting from the moving load. Concrete for the mat, consisting of 522 cubic yards, was placed during an 8-hour period with two concrete pumps. In order to accomplish the transfer of the support frame onto a new foundation, a space of at least 8 feet was needed. The base of the concrete mat foundation bears at about 12 feet below grade. At this depth, medium dense to dense sands are present that will easily support the estimated pressure of 5,000 pounds per square foot that will be imposed by the lighthouse. Dewatering was accomplished by installing a system of single-stage multiple wellpoints. These wellpoints drew down the groundwater to allow construction of a crushed stone base layer and the 4-foot-thick reinforced concrete mat foundation. When the mat was completed, the wellpoints were removed to allow the groundwater to return to its former level. When the lighthouse reached the new foundation, the groundwater was again lowered, but only partially, to expose the top of the mat. The concrete mat was placed sufficiently in advance of the arrival of the lighthouse to allow time to achieve full concrete design strength. After the concrete had cured for more than 28 days, the lighthouse was moved across the new foundation and into place on July 9, 1999. Based on the geotechnical analyses, the new foundation was expected to have an immediate settlement on the order of 1 to 2 inches. Because the transfer of load to the new foundation occurred while the three-zone unified hydraulic support system was active, it was determined that settlement of this magnitude would not affect the lighthouse. The actual amount of settlement was much less than anticipated, on the order of 3/8 inch.
OTHER ADVANTAGES The ICC relocation equipment was totally reusable and recyclable. The steel included recycled beams used by Expert House Movers of Maryland on previous projects. The majority of concrete placed on-site was for the foundation of the relocated lighthouse structure. Solutions utilizing piles, piers, or a deep foundation for a rail system requiring abandonment, reclamation, retrieval or disposal were rejected. The mats, cribbing, rails, beams, and hydraulic jacks all can be used on future projects. The aggregate base course of crushed stone was leap-frogged ahead of travel, and at the end of the move, stockpiled for the National Park Service to use in later phases of construction.
Summary
203
The transportation scheme designed by the ICC team provided system redundancy. No other system offers a comparable safety margin and system redundancy as the selected design. With regard to weight variables, inconsistencies in the move route, protection against storms, and variations in subgrade support, a hydraulic system on steel rails was judged the best solution for moving the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse.
FIGURE 13-14 The Lighthouse was moved on steel rails.
SUMMARY The relocation of the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse utilized technology known to few people, mostly in the structural moving industry, to lift, transport, and set the 4,800-ton lighthouse. The unified hydraulic system allowed the structure to be uniformly supported while traversing a support system consisting of beams, mats, and compacted soils. Structural issues involved vertical support of the lighthouse as its base was incrementally removed by mining, support during transport by a system of cross beams and main beams, and temporary and permanent support at the new location. The inherent stability of the lighthouse dictated that once supported on steel the lighthouse would remain stable. The 5-inch double extra strong steel pipe shoring towers had to be laterally braced to resist wind and seismic forces.
204
Relocating the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse
FIGURE 13-15 Temporary support shoring posts consisting of 5 x-strong pipes had to be laterally braced.
This, we determined, was the most critical condition of the move. Mindful of liability and budget constraints while working within a designbuild framework, the National Park Service was most cooperative in its administration of the project. Overall, the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse Relocation was a well-considered and executed project. It is a direct reflection of the International Chimney Corporation’s overall team expertise in the relocation of historic structures.
CONCLUSION The successful relocation of the Cape Hatteras Lighthouse should resolve once and for all the technical feasibility of moving large structures. In this case, engineering and construction expertise combined to solve the National Park Service’s dilemma regarding the management of an important cultural icon.
CREDITS DCF Engineering, Inc. of Cary, North Carolina, produced the structural drawings for the lifting and transporting of the lighthouse, and the new foundation. Law Engineering (now MACTEC) of Raleigh, North Carolina, and Atlanta, Georgia, provided geotechnical services and material testing. Randy Knott, P.E., and Al Tice, P.E., were the primary managers for Law Engineering and
Bibliography
205
Environmental Services, Inc. (now MACTEC). Wiss, Janney, Elstner Associates (WJE) of Northbrook, Illinois, provided the monitoring system and the historical architect. Harry Hunderman, FAIA, and Jerry Stockbridge, P.E., oversaw the architectural and materials testing effort for WJE. Joseph Jakubik, project manager, and George Gardner, P.E., of International Chimney Corporation (ICC), and Peter Friesen (hydraulics expert) of Washington state worked out the logistics for the move and devised details for temporary shoring and jacking with Jerry and Jim Matyiko of Expert House Movers. Rick Lohr, led the ICC team, and Skellie Hunt was the ICC jobsite superintendent.
REFERENCES 1. Stick, David. North Carolina Lighthouses, North Carolina Department of Cultural Resources, Division of Archives and History, Raleigh, North Carolina, 1983, 3rd printing. 2. “Study and Report, Cape Hatteras Lighthouse,” for National Park Service, MTMA Design Group, P.A. Raleigh, NC, December 1980. 3. “Cost Estimate: Relocate the Cape Lookout Lighthouse, Cape Lookout National Seashore, North Carolina,” MTMA Design Group, P.A., Raleigh, NC, November 15, 1978. 4. “Simplex/Pine Design Features and Applications, “Kenly, Templeton & Company, Broadview, Illinois 60143. 5. “Wire Rope and Jack Pulling Systems,” Lucker Manufacturing, An Amhoist Company, King of Prussia, PA 19406. 6. “Moving a Church of 3200 Tons,” Scientific American, March 1923, p. 186. 7. “A Great Engineering Feat,” Scientific American, July 1, 1916. p. 17. 8. Gerster, Georg, Robert W. Nicholson. “Saving the Ancient Temples at Abu Simbel, “National Geographic, Vol. 129, No. 5, May 1966. 9. Office of the Lighthouse Superintendent Fifth District – Baltimore, MD, Cape Henry Lighthouse Station. “Architectural and Engineering Drawings for First Order Lighthouse for Cape Hatteras, North Carolina,” United States Coast Guard Academy Library, New London, CT 06320.
BIBLIOGRAPHY Pilkey, Orrin H. Jr., William J. Neal, Orrin H. Pilkey, Sr., Stanley R. Riggs. From Currituck to Calabash, Living with North Carolina’s Barrier Islands, North Carolina Science and Technology Research Center, Research Triangle Park, North Carolina 27701, 1978.
CHAPTER
14
Crisis in American Covered Bridges
uring the past few years, historic preservationists have been successful in convincing highway department administrators and other state officials of the importance of saving historic bridge structures. State bridge engineers have been given the task of rehabilitating and upgrading bridge structures that, several years ago, would have been replaced without question. State highway departments now have in-house preservation planners who work closely with the State Preservation Department and local preservation groups. With this emphasis on historic preservation, the rehabilitation of our timber-covered bridges should be much easier. Unfortunately, this does not appear to be the case. Between 1805 and 1885, an estimated 10,000 covered bridges were built in the United States. Today, approximately 800 remain. In order to save our remaining historic timber-covered bridges, we must embark on a program that involves evaluation, rehabilitation, upgrading, and maintenance. Too often, covered bridges are taken out of service without the benefit of a complete structural analysis and testing program. Too many bridges have been victims of well-intentioned repairs, designed to upgrade the bridge’s structural capacity, but have instead, actually destroyed the “essence” of the bridge. The use of precast concrete, steel, or glued laminated timber girders to supplement the existing trusses, or schemes that remove the bridge trusses from service altogether, are a poor reflection on a structural engineering profession capable of solving many difficult problems.
D
Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
207
208
Crisis in American Covered Bridges
There are many structural engineers in the United States with extensive timber design experience. Unfortunately, many of these engineers do not have experience designing or analyzing highway structures. Fewer still are proficient in the area of historic preservation. Timber is an excellent material for highway bridge construction. If maintained, a timber bridge structure can give good service for many years. In Pennsylvania, Vermont, New Hampshire, Ohio, and Indiana, there are many examples of covered bridges that have provided good service for 100 years or more. These bridges are often neglected or inadvertently abused by well-intentioned highway maintenance personnel, and yet they continue to serve an ever-increasing traffic demand until they are ultimately removed from service. The structural engineer engaged in the evaluation of historic timber covered bridges should focus on the evaluation of the primary structural elements. A complete and thorough analysis of the bridge truss must be performed. Included should be a realistic computer analysis that accurately models, as best as possible, continuous and discontinuous joints, as well as the various components members. First, the structural materials should be identified. It may require that small samples of the wood be provided to the forestry department of a local university or to a full service-testing laboratory. Some species of wood cannot be identified without a “thin section” being examined under a microscope. The density and grade of the component materials must be determined by observation and testing. Laboratory testing of components of the bridge may indicated that allowable design values vary from those currently published in the National Design Specification for Wood Construction of the National Forest Products Association.1 Some components of the original truss may have to be sacrificed to a destructive testing program to obtain information used to justify realistic design values. Nondestructive bending tests of components can be utilized to establish an accurate modulus of elasticity, or stiffness, of component materials. Load testing the bridge can easily be accomplished by driving a vehicle of known weight onto the bridge. Accurate deflection measurements must be obtained directly off the truss with a surveyor’s instrument or deflection gauge. A reasonable and fair design philosophy must be established that provides for bridge safety, while justifying the continued service of historic bridge structures. A timber design philosophy that recognizes, for example, the critical nature of buckling and tension failures versus less critical conditions, associated with a perpendicular-to-grain overstress at a bearing connection, must be developed by the engineer.
Crisis in American Covered Bridges
209
FIGURE 14-1 A Delaware County (New York) truck of known weight was used to test the Downsville Covered Bridge.
FIGURE 14-2 Readings were obtained before, during, and after the loading of the bridge.
Structural upgrading of a bridge, if needed may involve the substitution of larger pieces in certain areas of a truss or floor structure. The lateral bracing of the bridge truss or a radial stiffening arch may have to be increased or modified. Wherever possible, the upgrading of an historic timber bridge should
210
Crisis in American Covered Bridges
utilize members and connections similar to the original bridge fabric. Steel cover plates, stiffeners, ties and modern connectors should be avoided wherever possible. The timber bridge trusses of Reuban L. Partridge (c.1823–1900) in Ohio appear to be designed to allow for the easy replacement of web compression members and the outboard chord material. Only the tension diagonals that are notched through the multiple chord members are impossible to replace without extensive shoring or the bridge. Mr. Partridge’s bridges, less than 100 feet in span, can be structurally upgraded by substituting full-length glued laminated timber members for existing bottom-chord material. This substitution will increase the tensile capacity of the bottom chord in three ways. The use of full-length glued laminated timber removes the reduction to the multichord net section due to shear block notches and butt splices. Also, higher allowable design values in tension are available with glued laminated timber materials. These kinds of solutions would bring to these projects timber design expertise capable of evaluating and analyzing historic bridges as timber structures. Historic timber structures provide an excellent laboratory for the timber industry. Information regarding the long-term performance of wood would be of great assistance to structural engineers faced with the problem of evaluating historic structures. Research opportunities such as these would add to our knowledge of modern timber engineering, as we utilize this renewable construction material, so important to our forest products and construction industries. Structural engineers with timber design experience must become actively involved in historic preservation in order to save our remaining historic covered bridges. Highway department bridge engineers must seek out consultants with timber design expertise. By working together, we can save an important part of our civil engineering heritage.
REFERENCE National Forest Products Association, National Design Specifications for Wood Construction, Washington, D.C.: National Forest Products Association, 1977.
CHAPTER
15
The Timber Trusses of Burr, Town, and Haupt
ne cannot offer a good summary of the engineering aspects of covered bridge design without discussing the work of Theodore Burr (1771– 1822), Ithiel Town (1784–1844), and Herman Haupt (1817–1905). This discussion is illustrated by several case histories in this chapter and in other places in this book. In recent years, the attention of state DOT bridge-engineering departments has been focused on historic timber-framed covered bridges. Transportation enhancement funds made available in the past 10 years, and the Historic Covered Bridge Preservation Program, have suddenly provided opportunities to rehabilitate these historic timber structures. Many people during most of the twentieth century considered covered bridges to be primitive, unengineered systems. After all, the designer/builders did not have access to sophisticated methods of structural analysis. These were mere timber structures, often built in remote areas of the country, far from industrialized cities, usually constructed with locally grown timber. They were built in an era when wrought and cast iron, and steel and concrete, eclipsed timber as the construction materials of choice. Even today, few recognize the environmental advantages of constructing such monumental structures from our most important renewable resource. Indeed, many sustainable construction advocates and some members of the forest products industry do not fully realize the benefits of heavy timber construction.
O
Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
211
212
The Timber Trusses of Burr, Town, and Haupt
FIGURE 15-1 General Herman Haupt.
The timber trusses that form the primary structural systems of covered bridges take many forms. Some of the most common, such as the Burr archtruss and the Town lattice, are based on patents that can be attributed to particular inventor/builders of the first half of the nineteenth century. Long service history has shown that these two, the most popular covered bridge truss configurations of the nineteenth century, were the best structural solutions for building these monumental timber structures. In this chapter we will discuss the bridge designs of Burr, Town, and Haupt.
THEODORE BURR Theodore Burr’s addition of the two-hinged arch to the multiple kingpost truss was a technical breakthrough in bridge construction. His 1817 patent prompted much discussion in engineering circles about the interaction of the arch with the truss. His patent, which was simply a combination of a two-hinged arch with a multiple king post truss, demonstrated
Theodore Burr
213
FIGURE 15-2 The Utica Road Covered Bridge contains modified Burr trusses.
the stiffening ability of the arch. The Burr arch-truss was often criticized for being statically indeterminate. Critics attempted to analyze the system of arch and truss together, while the attitude of the builders was to proportion each separately to carry the total load and merely “yoke” the two together.
FIGURE 15-3 The deteriorated members in the Utica Road Covered Bridge were replaced in kind. (See color insert.)
214
The Timber Trusses of Burr, Town, and Haupt
With modern computers, the analysis of the Burr arch-truss can be accomplished in elegant ways to mimic its actual action. FIGURE 15-4 The Old Salem Covered Bridge is a modified Burr. A partial arch is shown here during construction. (See color insert.)
The success of the Burr arch-truss is proven by its popularity. Within the few years, between the granting of his patent and his tragic financial failure and death in 1822, Burr accomplished some incredible feats of construction such as the 400-foot-span bridge across the Hudson River at Waterford, New York.
ITHIEL TOWN The Town lattice has also been criticized for being structurally indeterminate and wasteful of material. Actually, it is the best possible truss configuration for a covered bridge because of its redundancy and the repetitive nature of its construction. The system provides for relatively close spacing between lattice and chord intersections, usually 4 feet on center. This provides the opportunity for close spacing of the transverse floor beams without overstressing the bottom chord in bending. The nature of highway loadings requires that the floor of a bridge be tested for concentrated wheel and axle loads. In other configurations of timber trusses, widely spaced truss panel points greatly limit the capacity of the bridge requiring extra heavy floor stringers, beams, and flooring, or panels. The combined tensile and bending forces in the bottom chord of a covered bridge are critical to its capacity.
Ithiel Town
215
In Town lattice bridges, the load path into the truss is more direct, from the floor decking into the transverse floor beams usually spaced at 2 feet on center. The floor beams are usually placed on top of the bottom chord with every other beam extending through the lattice. Every other floor beam runs across the width of the bridge from face to face of lattice, creating an eccentric loading condition on the bottom chord that can be mitigated by shimming so that the through beams bear on the outboard portion of the chord. The myth that Town lattice truss bridges are easier to build, because the joinery is less complicated than a Burr, should be dispelled. The vast number of individual pieces to be assembled, and the large number of trunnels to be driven requires an intensive application of labor. The system is complicated. Ithiel Town controlled the construction of these bridges, in part, because there were many details critical to the successful construction of a Town lattice bridge that are not readily apparent. In 1839, Ithiel Town published a pamphlet containing a description of his improvement “in the Principle, Construction, and Practical Execution of Bridges” that represented his best thinking related to his patents for the Town lattice truss.1 The contents of this publication are notable because they show tie beams combined with principal rafters and knee braces. Some existing Town lattice truss bridges were either not built according to Town’s latest thinking or they have lost their original roof structures. For example, the Goddard Bridge in Kentucky contains only common rafters and no interior knee braces. Figure No. 1 in Town’s pamphlet shows a floor consisting of transverse flooring and square longitudinal stringers.1 The Haverhill-Bath Covered Bridge in New Hampshire contains stringers and possibly original floor beams rather than the closely spaced floor beams and longitudinal flooring now found in so many Town truss bridges. The stringer solution is much better because these secondary members are lighter in weight and allows air to circulate around the floor beams, keeping them relatively dry. Although large bolster beams are shown in two figures of bridge sections in Town’s pamphlet, no mention of these critical elements is included. Apparently, the need for sufficiently large bolster beams, so as to not overstress the chords and lattice sticks, was obvious from the very beginning. To properly construct a new Town lattice truss bridge requires scrupulous attention to detail. First, the timber needs to be of a very good quality of uniform dimension. Douglas fir No. 1 Dense, free of heart center, is one of the best materials to use for a Town lattice truss bridge. Southern pine is less desirable, because of its additional weight, the presence of more knots, its dimensional instability, and the difficulty of commercially obtaining large quantities of good-quality material in lengths greater than 16 feet. Often the
216
The Timber Trusses of Burr, Town, and Haupt
design of a Town lattice requires lengths of bottom chord material in the 32 to 36 foot range. Arnold Graton of Ashland, New Hampshire, has built more Town lattice timber truss bridges than anyone else now living. Working with his father, Milton Graton, for 37 years, he learned the particulars of the Town lattice truss as if he had sat at the knee of Ithiel Town himself. FIGURE 15-5 Arnold Graton (left) with his son “JR” Graton in Thomaston, Georgia.
The Town lattice requires a wide bearing surface for the truss so that bottom chord, lattice, and connections are not overstressed. The general rule of thumb is that the truss should extend beyond the center of the bearing equal to the depth (height) of the truss. Town lattice trusses usually terminate at a built-up end post. If the end of the truss is close to the bearing point, the endpost may greatly affect the forces in the lattice braces and counter braces. Bearing blocks, bed timbers and bolster beams can be configured to enhance the capacity of a Town lattice truss. The Auchumpkee Covered Bridge in Thomaston, Georgia, was originally built with very heavy double-cantilevered bolster beams that tapered down in depth from their supports. These were reused in Arnold Graton’s 1996 reconstruction of the bridge that had been destroyed in a flood. The tapered configuration is not only visually pleasing, it provides a gentle transition between the main span and the supports. A Town lattice truss will be substantially stronger if the chord sticks are as long as possible. By scattering the end joints in the bottom chord in a rational manner, there is less chance that a joint will fall precisely at midspan or at the most critical point in the bottom chord. A more subtle consideration is load
Ithiel Town
217
FIGURE 15-6 The original doublecantilevered bolster beams were reused at the Auchumpkee Creek Covered Bridge.
sharing between individual leaves. The trunnels not only connect chords and lattice together, they also allow for load sharing within the individual chord sticks to provide continuity through joint locations. Drawings for new or existing Town lattice trusses should show the distribution of joints in all chords with the length of the chord sticks noted. Replacement chord sticks installed in a bridge should respect the original joint locations. During the first Covered Bridge Conference held in Burlington, Vermont, in February 2003, we observed and briefly reviewed the analysis of several covered bridges as performed by universities for government agencies, and by traditional highway bridge engineers as consultants. In the first case, the effort is academic, resulting in an educational tool used to transfer knowledge to the design community. In the second case, there are serious gaps in the understanding of how these timber structures perform by some members of the highway bridge design community. Some engineers demonstrate their lack of knowledge of timber design when they talk of “shear planes” in the design of trunnels. The capacity of trunnels used as the primary connector in Town lattice trusses is governed by the bearing in the trunnel perpendicular to grain. Timber elements do not fail in shear across the grain. When a load is applied perpendicular to the longitudinal axis of a timber pin, it may fail in bearing perpendicular to grain, in horizontal shear, or bending; but not in shear through its cross-section. Since bearing in the pin controls the design, increased capacity in Town lattice connections can be achieved by increasing the diameter of the pins or by
218
The Timber Trusses of Burr, Town, and Haupt
selecting trunnel material with a high allowable design value in bearing perpendicular to grain such as live oak, locust, or mesquite. Many highway, county, and consulting engineers, considering ways to increase the capacity of Town lattice trusses, have added steel splice plates at bottom chord joints. Connections such as these may be effective if the drilling is very accurate, the holes not more than 1/16th of an inch larger than the bolt diameter, the connection consists of two plates with the connection in double shear, and the connections are prestressed by jacking some camber into the bridge prior to drilling the holes. In actual practice, none of these conditions are met. The iron and steel dogs, found in Town lattice railroad bridges, to fasten chord sticks together, work much better because they were installed with great precision during original construction. In some cases they are adjustable and can be tightened.
RETROFITTED ARCHES In this chapter we must discuss the use of the retrofitted nail laminated timber arch as stiffening and strengthening devise installed in many covered bridges of the multiple kingpost design. Obviously, these bridges should not be categorized as Burr arch-trusses for they do not follow the Burr patent. The considerable structural advantages of retrofitted two-hinged nail or bolted laminated arches offer a strong case for not restoring a bridge to the earlier time period that does not include the arches. It can easily be demonstrated that retrofitted nail laminated two-hinge arches do not share load-carrying capacity equally with the truss system. If properly built and maintained, the nail or bolt laminated two-hinged arch adds considerable stiffness to the bridge structure. The capacity of the arches depends on the supports being nonyielding and the arches being held in line to avoid buckling out of plane. For the arches to work, the arch ends must bear against a thrust block capable of resisting all horizontal and vertical forces without movement. This is one “Achilles’ heel” of retrofitted nail laminated stiffening arches. The second possible defect in nailed or stitch bolted arches is the lack of sufficient fastening to resist shear forces between individual laminations caused by bending moments induced by unbalanced loads. If a bridge retrofitted with two hinged laminated arches is raised to avoid floods or ice in the river, then the stone abutments and piers will have to be modified or rebuilt to accommodate the horizontal thrust of the arches.
The Bunker Hill Covered Bridge
219
The boundary (support) conditions for both the arches and the trusses are very important to the evaluation and condition assessment of the bridge. The ability of the pier and abutments to resist the horizontal thrust of the arches without movement is critical. The reconfiguration of bed timbers, bearing blocks and bolster beams at supports is a powerful tool in strengthening an historic covered bridge because the truss superstructure is not affected. These elements are among the first to deteriorate because of their proximity to stone, earth, and water. Because of this, these pieces are rarely original to the period of construction. Often, the current timbers are creosote treated replacements. Enlarging bed timbers can reduce the span of a bridge, greatly reducing member forces.
HERMAN HAUPT From an engineering standpoint, it could be argued that the best form for a new covered timber bridge would be a double Town lattice with a stiffening arch. For any refinement of the Town lattice truss, the designer should simply look to General Herman Haupt’s Improved Lattice Truss. General Haupt (1817–1905), a noted bridge designer from Pennsylvania, graduated from West Point and became chief of military railroads during the Civil War. Rigorous mathematical methods of analyzing the forces and stresses in framed structures, such as bridges, were unknown until the 1840s. Civil engineers Squire Whipple and Herman Haupt independently developed mathematical methods of truss design. In 1842, Herman Haupt produced a small pamphlet, “Hints on Bridge Construction by an Engineer.”2 Squire Whipple is credited with developing the scientific basis of bridge design in America with his 1847 publication, “A Work on Bridge Building.” In 1851, Herman Haupt produced his major work, General Theory of Bridge Construction.2
THE BUNKER HILL COVERED BRIDGE In North Carolina, the Bunker Hill Covered Bridge, owned by the Catawba County Historical Society, was built in 1895 in general accordance with General Haupt’s 1839 design patent. The Bunker Hill Bridge is 80 feet, 2 inches long (out-to-out) and 10 feet wide. The floor consists of two layers of 2 ⫻ 8 and 2 ⫻ 10 deck boards supported by 3 ⫻ 10 floor beams spaced approximately 34 inches on center. The Bunker
220
The Timber Trusses of Burr, Town, and Haupt
Hill Covered Bridge is the only remaining example of Herman Haupt’s 1839 patent for the Improved Lattice Truss. It is the older of only two remaining historic covered bridges in North Carolina and is on the National Register of Historic Places. It is located approximately one mile east of a former stagecoach stop in Catawba County. The trusses consist of 3 ⫻ 12 posts (vertical web members) and double 2 ⫻ 12 braces (diagonal compression web members) in a lattice design where the braces cross two panels. The top chord consists of two 2 ⫻ 12s on each side of the braces that contain the posts at the centerline of the truss. The bottom chord consists of four 3 ⫻ 12 members. The end post is a 6 ⫻ 12. The first brace is a notched 12 ⫻ 6 with the second post passing through a rectangular hole in the brace. Connections between members are wood trunnels (pegs), usually three per joint. Two of the four members that form the chords are cut at the same splice locations, resulting in a net cross-sectional area in tension members equal to one-half of the gross cross-sectional area. In 1987, we provided an accurate analysis of the Haupt truss configuration of the Bunker Hill Covered Bridge. The axial forces in individual webs and chords were obtained, as well as local bending moments in continuous members. We performed an analysis on an AT&T PC 6300 computer using a plane frame analysis program to model the truss. The computer model contained of 55 joints and 94 members. The computer model included “link” connections at interior web intersections to simulate the continuity of lapped member connections where there is shear transfer between members, but each of the intersecting members maintains its continuity through the joint. The links are one-thousandth of a foot in length. We used for the link connections, the section properties equivalent to one, two-inch diameter trunnel. The chords were modeled as continuous members, as were individual web “sticks.” This is more accurate than the usual truss design assumption that all members are pinned at their intersections, including chord members. The supports were modeled as idealized hinge or roller supports. It is important to note that the truss model analyzed assumed a theoretical truss containing no deterioration or damage. Defects in individual timber members, as well as slippage in connections and shrinkage in connections or members, were not accounted for in the computer model.
Design Loads Although the bridge is located in Conner Park in Claremont, North Carolina, and is used for pedestrian traffic only, we analyzed the trusses for both pedestrian traffic and uniform lane loading equivalent to AASHTO H15-44.
The Bunker Hill Covered Bridge
221
The pedestrian traffic load combination consists of 100 psf floor live load in accordance with the 1978 edition of the North Carolina State Building Code for Catawba County.
Timber Member Evaluation The capacities of the members, and of the spliced connections were evaluated using the forces obtained from the computer program. We did not visually identify the species of wood used in the constructions of this bridge, other than to tentatively identify it as dense red oak for lattice sticks and southern pine for chords. We assumed conservative design values of E ⫽ 1500 ksi, Fb ⫽ 1400 psi, Ft ⫽ 1100 psi, and Fc ⫽ 1700 psi (parallel) for this evaluation. The computer analysis indicated that the critical areas of the truss were at the splices in the bottom chord and at the second brace. We computed tension forces for net cross-sectional areas not containing a splice as well as sections assumed to contain two splice joints in the critical bottom chord.
Analysis The preliminary structural analysis did not include a detailed analysis of the connections. The truss and floor beams were adequately sized to support uniform loads imposed by pedestrian traffic as well as an H15 vehicular loading for a one-lane bridge. Deflection under these loads was computed to be less than one-half of an inch across the full span. The support of the bridge by the abutments was close to the second post location. This support condition reduced the overall stresses in the truss by reducing the span but overstressed the second diagonal somewhat under the design loads.
Condition Survey In 1987, we pronounced the Bunker Hill Covered Bridge to be in good condition. The tin roof did not leak. Roof rafters, truss members, floor beams, floor decking, and lateral cross-bracing were generally in good to excellent condition. Some posts and braces contained unusual holes and notches, which may have been misdrilled holes or notches made by vandals. Although the concrete and stone abutments that were repaired or rebuilt by the Department of Transportation were not an authentic restoration, the structural condition of the abutments appeared good. Although the abutments are well constructed, backfill on the sides of the abutments and at the ends of the bridge constituted a decay problem to the wood in close contact with soil or concrete. A concrete swale use to divert runoff around the sides of the abutments was located too close to the siding. The ends
222
The Timber Trusses of Burr, Town, and Haupt
of the siding boards were decayed in several areas. The powder post beetle or some similar boring insect had attacked the truss members. At the time, we made five recommendations: 1. We recommend maintaining the existing tin roof rather than reroofing with wood shingles. Tin is economical, noncombustible, light in weight, and sheds snow. For these reasons, it remains the roofing material of choice for many New England covered bridges. 2. The wood of the bridge at the abutments should be “insulated” from direct contact with earth or concrete. The concrete swale should be rebuilt so that it is not in contact with the superstructure or siding. The ends of the bridge floor and chord members should be protected from direct contact with earth. 3. Consideration should be given to installing an automatic fire-protection system. 4. The bridge should be swept or blown clean with compressed air on a periodic basis to remove debris that has accumulated on and around the bottom chord. 5. Consideration should be given to nominating the Bunker Hill Covered Bridge for inclusion in the American Society of Civil Engineer’s National Historic Landmark Program. We concluded that the Bunker Hill Covered Bridge, is a very significant example of nineteenth-century bridge technology, is in excellent condition, and is well maintained. Herman Haupt was involved in so many emerging technologies for so many years, his early timber bridge design work is almost forgotten. His autobiographical Reminiscences of General Herman Haupt overshadows much of his previous work and many of his later accomplishments. Haupt’s improved lattice truss bridge was a response to Ithiel Town’s 1820 and 1835 patents for the plank lattice timber truss. Haupt used the analytical methods he developed in the 1840s to design a more efficient lattice truss, which consisted of web members positioned only at locations that required support. Redundant members were removed, resulting in the improved lattice truss as described in his book General Theory of Bridge Construction published in 1851.2 The Bunker Hill Covered Bridge is the only remaining example of the bridge truss design by Herman Haupt in 1840 and illustrated in his 1851 book General Theory of Bridge Construction, Fig 90, Page 153.2
The Bunker Hill Covered Bridge
223
FIGURE 15-7 An illustration of the Haupt Truss is on the first page of the chapter titled “Improved Lattice” from General Theory of Bridge Construction (Ref. 2).
General Haupt was keenly aware that his knowledge and ability as a civil engineer was vital in ensuring the health, safety, and welfare of the general public: “With even greater simplicity and economy than the ordinary lattice, it appears to be entirely free from its defects; and possessing many of the essential requisites of a good bridge, with a capability of extension to spans of considerable length, it seems to be unusually well adapted to the wants of a community with whom economy is an object.”2
In the Bunker Hill Covered Bridge, with the skin removed, we see the handiwork of Herman Haupt. FIGURE 15-8 The Bunker Hill Covered Bridge with repairs almost completed. (See color insert.)
224
The Timber Trusses of Burr, Town, and Haupt
This opportunity came when a windstorm uprooted a tree next to the bridge, smashing the south portal. The damage revealed considerable damage where the ends of the bridge had been encapsulated by concrete when the bridge was previously repaired. Having completed a recent evaluation, Sidney Halma gave us the call to assist with the repairs. With Mr. Halma pleading poverty on behalf of the Catawba County Historical Society, we were limited in what we could provide within our negotiated fee. As a result, we decided that we would produce a minimal set of drawings and invite two or more bridgewrights or qualified timber framers to the site to observe the damage for the purpose of determining the scope of work. To limit my time traveling, and to have the bidders agree on scope, I decided to invite Arnold M. Graton and Jan Lewandoski to visit the site at the same time. Fortunately, they both flew from Manchester, New Hampshire to Douglas Airport at Charlotte, North Carolina, aboard the same plane, where I met them, transporting them by automobile to the bridge site. After the three of us spent three to four hours observing conditions, we agreed on a scope of work. Arnold Graton was the successful bidder, and soon he went to work. During the 1987 rehabilitation, Arnold Graton, removed the side boarding and roofing from the bridge in order to gain access to chord members that required repair. FIGURE 15-9 Deterioration was apparent at all four corners of the bridge.
Deteriorated chord members that were replaced in kind consisted of bottom chord members at the four bearing corners of the bridge. Arnold Graton
The Bunker Hill Covered Bridge
225
replaced badly decayed or missing members with solid timbers of equal size that were ripped from a 12 ⫻ 14, 38 feet in length. FIGURE 15-10 Arnold Graton repaired in kind deteriorated chord and web members using southern pine similar to the original.
This old dense southern pine bridge timber had been in storage in the Graton’s yard in New Hampshire since the 1950s. By removing the sideboarding and roofing of the Bunker Hill Covered Bridge, the incredibly beautiful framing was revealed. The temporary removal of the sideboarding of the bridge by Graton was reminiscent of Haupt’s order, as chief of military railroads during the Civil War, to remove the roofing and sideboarding of the covered bridges in the vicinity of Washington, D.C., to prevent the Confederates from easily burning those vital links. Though the Bunker Hill Covered Bridge played but a small role in the development of the nation, covered bridges that no longer exist played a pivotal role in the growth of the United States. The development of rational analytical methods for truss design in the 1830s and 1840s paralleled the growth and expansion of the railroads. Covered bridge structures were the first to benefit from methods developed by early civil engineers. In covered bridges we see an emerging engineering analysis and construction technology, pioneered by men such as Burr, Town, and Haupt, which was soon applied to both timber and iron bridges as American civil engineers rose to the challenges presented by a developing railroad industry.
226
The Timber Trusses of Burr, Town, and Haupt
REFERENCES 1. Town, Ithiel. A Description of Ithiel Town’s Improvement in the Construction of Wood and Iron Bridges: Intended as a General System of BridgeBuilding for Rivers, Creeks, and Harbours of Whatever Kind of Bottoms; and for any Practicable Width of Span or Opening, in Every Part of the County. New Haven: S. Converse, 1821. 2. Haupt, H. General Theory of Bridge Construction, New York: Appleton and Co., 1851.
CHAPTER
16
The Cornish-Windsor Covered Bridge
he conservation of the Cornish-Windsor Bridge was a compromise among rehabilitation-in-kind proponents, authentic restoration advocates, and Vermont and New Hampshire governmental officials. This compromise replaced overstressed wood with glued laminated timber, a modern-day forest product. The fine-grained virgin eastern white spruce timber that was used originally is no longer grown. The use of glued laminated timber preserved the appearance of the bridge, preserved the Town lattice structural system, minimized the use of steel, and met modern highway standards. It has been estimated that at one time, the United States contained at least 10,000 covered timber bridges1. In 1980, six states contained 78 percent of our remaining 893 covered bridges2. Certainly, the remaining covered bridges enhance the quality of life for artists, tourists, and preservationists who seek out these romantic reminders of past technology. What kind of preservation philosophy is needed in order for us to conserve our remaining covered bridges? Perhaps the Cornish-Windsor case study will provide insight into a conservation process of engineering analysis and preservation philosophy that led to the compromise solution that was completed in November 1989. The 460-foot-long Cornish-Windsor Covered Bridge, which links Cornish, New Hampshire, with Windsor, Vermont, is a special covered bridge. The bridge,
T
Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
227
228
The Cornish-Windsor Covered Bridge
which spans the upper Connecticut River, is the longest covered bridge still standing in the United States and longest two-span covered bridge in the world. As cited in its nomination to the National Register of Historic Places, this is the only remaining notched Town lattice bridge in the world. Until the start of construction it had carried two lanes of automobile traffic safely across the Connecticut River. The Cornish-Windsor Bridge is a National Civil Engineering Historic Landmark. It was the subject of a book, published in 1926, titled, The Economic Implications of the Bridge at Windsor, by structural engineer Richard Dana3.
HISTORY OF THE CORNISH-WINDSOR BRIDGE The Cornish-Windsor Bridge was built in 1866. James F. Tasker of Cornish, New Hampshire, and Bela J. Fletcher of Claremont, New Hampshire, constructed the bridge after the 1839 notched timber lattice truss patented by Ithiel Town of New Haven, Connecticut (1784–1844). In the American Society of Civil Engineers paper “A History of the Development of Wooden Bridges” by Robert Fletcher and J. P. Snow, the following information is presented regarding the Town lattice: The distinctive characteristics of the Town lattice are its use of simple sizes of lumber, the small amount of framing required, and the need of nothing but bolts and a few round rods for metal work. In such regions as those mentioned, far from centers of skilled labor and steel fabrication shops, the simple character of materials and labor required by this type is important. The trusses are generally built of uniform sections throughout. While this is a feature that is often criticized as wasteful of material, such waste is much more than balanced by the resulting simplicity of framing and erection. The Town lattice principle is similar to that of the English iron riveted lattice. Both will stand more abuse from service than any other type of truss. Both will give indications of distress long before collapse, and those that were properly built are found doing duty far longer than many other types. The most successful early builders of wooden bridges placed much emphasis upon the necessity of protection from the weather by roof and side covering. All later experience has proved that bridges not so protected deteriorate rapidly1.
REHABILITATION ALTERNATIVE USING TIMBER ARCHES The traditional New England method of reinforcing timber-covered bridges was the subject of the controversy that lasted about eight years, according to David W. Wright, director of the National Society for the Preservation of Covered
Rehabilitation Alternative Using Timber Arches
229
Bridges. The laminated timber arch retrofit proposed by the Committee for the Authentic Restoration of the Cornish-Windsor Bridge required traditional methods and materials as practiced by Milton S. Graton, craftsman, of Ashland, New Hampshire. Mr. Graton’s proposed timber arch solution had a long history. In a letter to Mr. J. W. Storrs, Consulting Engineer, dated August 1908, J. P. Snow, bridge engineer of the Boston & Maine Railroad, recommended arches for the Cornish-Windsor Bridge. In another letter to Mr. Storrs dated September 15, 1908, Snow stated the following: . . . regarding Windsor Bridge: — An arch of 20’ rise could be used and the figures would give a section of 9 ⫻ 42 or 10 ⫻ 38. . . . The foot of the arches would need to be very strongly secured to the masonry and timbers would need to be framed between the arches to prevent ice catching on the lower one and to make both of them act together. I think it can be absolutely safe.4
J. P. Snow co-authored paper No. 1864 (Proceeding, ASCE, November, 1932, Vol. LVIII, pp. 1455–1498) of the American Society of Civil Engineers, “A History of the Development of Wooden Bridges,” which discussed the construction of supplemental arches in timber bridges: Combinations of arch and truss have been disproved by school men because of the impossibility of determining the theoretical distribution of stress between the truss and the arch; but if there is strength enough in both, and they are properly yoked together, the safe elasticity of the wood and the connections will take care of the distribution. The Town lattice is the best of the various types of wooden trusses to serve as an arch stiffener because its web members serve either as counters or main braces. The value of arches framed with trusses, if heeled against the masonry, has been amply demonstrated by other types of trusses, some of which have stood for a century.1
In 1984, Mr. Graton proposed the following as detailed in Plans for the Authentic Restoration of the Cornish-Windsor Covered Bridge. The bridge would be retrofitted with four radial arches, built up with 2 ⫻ 14’s of dense select structural untreated Douglas fir, mechanically laminated with stitch bolts and spikes. The location of the reinforcing arches at the outside of the trusses of the Cornish-Windsor Bridge would maintain the interior width of the bridge at its original two lanes. Concrete thrust block supports would have to be built into the tops of the two abutments and the central pier in order to create sufficient bearing area. Raising the bridge would be necessary in order to provide the additional clearance needed to place the arches above damaging winter ice. Additional longitudinal floor beams and transverse needle beams would also be
230
The Cornish-Windsor Covered Bridge
required to increase the structural capacity of the bridge to HS15-44 (the designation for a standard highway design and the minimum live load for highways which carry, or may carry, heavy truck traffic). Load sharing between the new radial rib arches and the trusses would be attained by adjusting threaded hangers or suspender rods, which connected the two elements.5 Objections to Mr. Graton’s arch solution were based on preservation philosophy, as well as other issues. Because the arches were to be 20 feet deep, they would spring from a point 4 feet below the bottom of the bridge. The visual impact of the partially exposed curved arches was objectionable to many people, particularly the Vermont Agency of Transportation, the Vermont Division of Preservation, and the Town of Windsor. In addition, with the arches placed to the outside of the trusses, the bridge cross-section and end appearance would have to change. Probably the greatest objection was the necessity of raising the bridge 4 feet above its original location so that the arches would avoid the winter ice that forms in the upper Connecticut River. The bridge raising would change the historic relationship of the bridge to grade at both ends. The street in Windsor and the highway in Cornish would have to be elevated, along with several residential structures. The arch supports would also have extended, beyond the protecting envelope of the bridge, to bear against stone masonry and a concrete thrust block. This critical connection would have been subject to wetting by driving rain, high water, and moisture derived from contact with the stone and concrete, as well as ice damage. Protection of the spring point of the arch was a major concern of the opponents of the timber arch retrofit.
REHABILITATION ALTERNATIVE USING REPLACEMENT-IN-KIND The solution preferred by the transportation departments and preservation offices of both New Hampshire and Vermont was a replacement-in-kind retrofit that would substitute larger, stronger timbers for existing fabric. The replacementin-kind solution was shown through analysis not to be feasible for two reasons. First, solid timbers of sufficient strength were not available. That is, to maintain a cross-section similar to the original chords, new timbers would require design values in tension far exceeding those published for the grades and species of timbers available. Second, the presence of butt joists and shear blocks, which would be required in any replacement chord configuration of the truss, would reduce the net section in tension. The original chords consisted of four members connected together in such a way that many of the end splices in the 32- foot-long pieces occurred in areas of high stress.
Rehabilitation Alternative Using Glued Laminated Timber Replacement Chords
231
REHABILITATION ALTERNATIVE USING GLUED LAMINATED TIMBER REPLACEMENT CHORDS In January 1988, I proposed a solution requiring replacement of the original chords with glued laminated timber members in very long lengths, to bridge areas of high stress. Although it was presented with reservations, this solution was immediately accepted by the two departments of transportation. The glued laminated timber replacement chord solution provided the Cornish-Windsor Bridge with an HS15-44 capacity without the addition of retrofitted laminated timber arches. This alternative required the installation of architectural grade, prefabricated, structural glued laminated timber chords and floor beams in areas of high tensile stress in the bridge.6 Structural glued laminated timber, commonly referred to as glulam, was introduced into the United States in 1936 from Germany. In glued laminated timber products, higher design values are obtained by providing clear, dense laminations in areas of high stress. Strength-reducing defects such as large knots are removed. Natural growth characteristics such knots, wane, and checks normally found in all timber materials are considered to be “defects” because of their strength-reducing capabilities.7 In the production of structural glued laminated timber, laminations are glued together with waterproof glue. The surface appearance of structural glued laminated timber does not have to be the slick-planed finish often seen in architectural applications. A crosssanded finish approximating a rough sawn appearance can be furnished.7 For the Cornish-Windsor Bridge, the use of prefabricated glued laminated timber offered five advantages: 1. Because glued laminated timber consists of a number of pieces of laminate glued together, it can be fabricated in longer lengths than solid materials. 2. It can usually be fabricated and shipped within 8 to 10 weeks. This period is less than the total time required for ordering, cutting, and drying large solid timber materials. 3. The moisture content of structural glued laminated material is rigidly controlled. Constant moisture content throughout the cross section of 15 percent or less is provided at the time of shipment. This aspect of glued laminated timber is significant because the shrinkage of truss members after construction can cause additional deflection as a result of the opening of critical joints. 4. Unlike solid timber, structural glued laminated timber is an engineered, stress-rated product of a timber laminating plant. Plant fabrication
232
The Cornish-Windsor Covered Bridge
ensures quality control, which is impossible to obtain by field laminating or by using solid materials. 5. Also, glued laminated timber members of southern pine can be pressure treated before gluing with complete penetration of the preservative. This is desired to extend the life of members subjected to wetting. Complete penetration of preservative is not obtainable in some species such as Douglas fir or in the heartwood of most other species. The advantages of the laminated timber chord replacement design over the timber arch retrofit immediately became apparent. Modification of the foundations of the buttresses and central pier was not required. The cross-section of the bridge would also remain essentially the same. All live and dead loads would be supported by the rehabilitated lattice trusses, thus preserving the use of the original structural technology. Additional continuity would be built into the bridge by using the longer chord material. This continuity would help to limit future deflection by eliminating splices and shear block connections. Additional transverse and longitudinal carrying beams would not be required if laminated timber floor beams were substituted for the existing 4 ⫻ 16 floor beams.
DISADVANTAGES OF THE GLULAM CHORD REPLACEMENT ALTERNATIVE There are four disadvantages of the laminated timber chord replacement design: 1. The use of structural glued laminated materials integrated into an historic bridge structure may not be acceptable to some historic preservationists. 2. Overall bridge stiffness is not as great as can be achieved with retrofitted laminated timber arches. 3. Overall bridge safety would depend on relatively few mechanical splices. These critical splices would integrate the new laminated timber chord material with existing bridge fabric. Such work would require a very high level of skill among the timber framers. 4. Long timber pieces are difficult to handle, ship, and integrate into the bridge. Precise coordination of field cuts and daps is necessary so that lattice web members fit as required between the chords. Early in 1988, the design and construction of the glued laminated timber chord replacement alternative was implemented. In making this decision, the
Disadvantages of the Glulam Chord Replacement Alternative
233
key for us was the confidence expressed by Jan Lewandowski of Greensboro Bend, Vermont, that he could successfully integrate the glued laminated timber chords into the bridge by scribing and notching. At each lattice to chord connection, the members were both notched 1¼ inches and pinned. The snug fit of these joints was critical to the performance of the rehabilitated trusses. The analysis for the Cornish-Windsor Bridge in 1989 was executed on a personal computer using a STRAAD three-dimensional frame analysis program. It involved 1,600 members and 2,800 joints for one truss and required approximately 13 hours to run. We modeled joints to allow rotation and continuity at lattice intersections using links.
FIGURE 16-1 The analysis provided forces for 1,600 members.
To obtain realistic support conditions, we modeled springs. It was a frustrating ordeal because often the 13-hour process would yield incorrect results. I would start the program at the end of the workday, expecting results the next morning. Too often, summer electrical storms would interrupt the power and I would have to start again. The results of the analysis were magnificent. All of the lattice member and chord forces were produced. We could see the effects of bolster beam supports and accurately determine the optimum locations for chord splices for an array of loading conditions. A temporary cable-stayed support system was designed to allow construction to proceed while the Connecticut River was filled with ice. The design of
234
The Cornish-Windsor Covered Bridge
the cable stayed temporary support system was an adventure in itself. Originally, Chesterfield Associates was planning to shore the bridge from the river. Unfortunately, the Upper Connecticut often freezes during the winter. Moving ice would simply destroy any temporary supports standing in the river. During a meeting with NHDOT engineers and officials, Dave Allen, of Chesterfield Associates, the contractor, explained that the two-year construction schedule would require work to be phased in such a way to avoid the ice. The plan was to work on the two spans of the bridge independently. While the discussion ensued, I was quietly sketching on the proverbial, “back of an envelope.” I quickly sketched the bridge with a two-span cable stayed structure to allow the symmetrical two-span bridge to be rehabilitated in a symmetrical manner. After presenting the sketch and interjecting a few comments into the discussion, the advantages of such a system became apparent to all. It was immediately embraced. The cable-stayed system had to be fast tracked. We designed the three 80-foot towers using 10HP42 steel piles, which were available to the contractor. The steel system consisted of transverse needle beams, two longitudinal carrying beams, built-up towers, and an array of 140 ksi Dywidag ® bars for stays. The design was handsketched on notebook paper and faxed to the jobsite on a “just in time” schedule so that welders would not be waiting.
FIGURE 16-2 The towers were fabricated in a field on the Cornish, New Hampshire, side of the river.
Two towers were erected on opposite banks, and one on the central pier.
Disadvantages of the Glulam Chord Replacement Alternative
235
FIGURE 16-3 The cable stayed system allowed for an orderly rehabilitation of the roof structure. (See color insert.)
Larger concrete dead men with earth anchors were installed to resist the pull of the stays on the end towers. The needle beams provided a perfect support for a rail and rolling hoist. FIGURE 16-4 The glued laminated timber chords were as much as 116 feet in length.
236
The Cornish-Windsor Covered Bridge
This enabled the long glued laminated timber chord replacement members and other materials to be pulled into the bridge. FIGURE 16-5 Glued laminated timber was used for chord replacement material, floor beams, and bolster beams.
The cable-stayed system allowed work to continue through the winter and the repairs to be made in a symmetrical manner that was important for a twospan continuous truss with very high tensile stresses in the top chord over the central pier. FIGURE 16-6 The cable stayed system allowed work to proceed through the winter.
Disadvantages of the Glulam Chord Replacement Alternative
237
As an added bonus, it allowed the contractor to pull up to 30 inches of camber into each span. This was important because there were reports that James Tasker was unhappy with the dead load deflection of the bridge, which appeared soon after construction. The sag in the spans of 12 and 14 inches were reversed providing the positive camber that the bridge never had. To assist the trusses, we installed large glued laminated timber double-cantilevered bolster beams under the bridge at the central pier. FIGURE 16-7 The cantilevered bolster beams are 10 ¾ inches wide by 42 inches deep.
Construction was completed in November 1989, and the bridge rededicated on December 8, 1989, with the governors of both states attending the ceremony. The problem of how to rehabilitate the Cornish-Windsor Covered Bridge became a question of compromise. The retrofitted arch solution would have conserved a greater percentage of the historic fabric by supplementing the original lattice truss with reinforcing arches. The retrofitted arches would have been an excellent structural solution because of their great rigidity. However, the laminated chord solution retains the original system as the primary structural element with a minimum of intervention, while requiring only the replacement of overstressed chord material with glued laminated timber. Because of the primary consideration of highway bridge safety, the glued laminated timber chord solution emerged as the most reliable and acceptable of all the solutions considered. Analysis indicated that the increased strength afforded by modern timber materials and connections was required to upgrade
238
The Cornish-Windsor Covered Bridge
FIGURE 16-8 The governors of both New Hampshire and Vermont attended the dedication ceremony. (See color insert.)
FIGURE 16-9 Key to the project was the ability to successfully integrate glulam sticks into the notched Town lattice system.
the Cornish-Windsor Bridge to a level that would allow it to be kept in service as a highway bridge. Conservation of our historic timber bridges can become a reality when the solution combines the ultimate goal of highway safety with a sound preservation philosophy. Only through rigorous structural analysis, which recognizes the special conditions inherent in historic timber structures, does sufficient information on which to base sensitive preservation decisions become available.
References
239
FIGURE 16-10 Camber remained in the completed bridge for several years.
REFERENCES 1. FitzSimons, L. Neal, et al. American Wooden Bridges, ASCE Historical Publication No. 4. New York: American Society of Civil Engineers, 1976. 2. Donovan, Richard T., ed. World Guide to Covered Bridges. Boston: National Society for the Preservation of Covered Bridges, Inc. 1980. 3. Dana, Richard T. The Bridge at Windsor, Vt., and Its Economic Implications. New York: Codex Book Co., Inc., 1926. Copy in Wilbur Collection, University of Vermont Library. 4. Snow, J.P. (Bridge Engineer, Boston and Maine Railroad, Boston), letter to J.W. Storrs (Consulting Engineer, Concord, NH), Aug. 22, 1908, Engineering Society Library, New York, NY 5. Graton, Milton S. and Wright, David W. Plans for the Authentic Restoration of the Cornish-Windsor Covered Bridge. Unpublished report, 1984; revised, 1987. 6. Fischetti, David C. “Glulam Chord Replacement Alternative, CornishWindsor Covered Bridge” report, Jan. 19, 1988. 7. American Institute of Timber Construction. Timber Construction Manual. 3rd ed. New York: John Wiley and Sons, 1985.
CHAPTER
17
A New Covered Bridge for Old Salem
unique covered bridge has been built in the United States. The North Carolina Department of Transportation project provided a pedestrian overpass over Highway 52 at Old Salem, the site of North Carolina’s first Moravian community. Moravian settlers arrived in North Carolina from Bethlehem, Pennsylvania, in 1753. To enhance and blend with the cultural landscape and historic architecture of Old Salem, several types of covered bridge structures were considered. The final choices were the Burr arch-truss and the Town lattice. The Burr arch-truss is a two-hinged arch combined with a multiple kingpost truss. The arch affords great stiffness. The Town lattice has many redundant members, providing a truss with great toughness. Although Theodore Burr’s (1771–1822) patent of 1817 claimed nothing but the arch, combined with the multiple kingpost truss, it became the most popular covered bridge structural system in the United States. Of the seven surviving covered bridges in Lehigh and Northampton counties near Bethlehem, Pennsylvania, all are Burr arch-trusses. In 1970, nearly 300 Burr arch-trusses were still standing, with 175 located in Pennsylvania; this was the type of bridge that the Moravians would have constructed for themselves in Salem during the first half of the nineteenth century. For this reason, it was decided that the Burr arch-truss was the logical choice for the
A
Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
241
242
A New Covered Bridge for Old Salem
covered bridge built at Old Salem. This paper will discuss the development of the design for the Old Salem Bridge and the application of covered bridge technology to both the preservation of historic structures and the construction of modern transportation structures.
THE CONCEPT Why build a covered bridge at Old Salem? As a tourism destination, Old Salem needed a pedestrian overpass structure to enhance and blend with its cultural landscape and historic architecture. The choice of a covered bridge conforms to the traditional technology of covered bridge building in North America. At the same time, it was important to Old Salem planners, such as John Larson, that the structure not be mistaken for an original artifact. To differentiate, the bridge is clad with transparent panels that give a modern appearance while exposing the traditional interior construction.
FIGURE 17-1 The acrylic panels provided a weathertight sidewall closure. (See color insert.)
The bridge serves as a gateway for vehicular traffic entering Old Salem as the museum community expands westward.
Description
243
DESCRIPTION The bridge is a 120-foot span Burr arch covered bridge that spans business Highway 52 through the city of Winston-Salem, enabling pedestrians to gain access to Old Salem from a visitors parking lot. Pedestrians using this bridge enter Old Salem adjacent to the Museum of Early Southern Decorative Arts. The bridge is framed with two massive Burr arch-trusses, 15 feet, 10 inches in height with a 5-foot rise. The chords and arch are built up from several members with staggered splices to provide continuity. Individual chord members are 5 inches square in cross-section. The braces are rectangular in section. The posts are large, cut to shape timbers, which contain offsets at brace-bearing points.
FIGURE 17-2 The brace to chord connections had to be made tight in the field.
The roof deck is 2 ⫻ 6 (1½ by 5¼) tongue and groove decking. The floor deck is 3 ⫻ 6 (1½ by 5¼) double tongue and groove decking. All of the timber materials are various species of southern pine. The bridge is protected by a standing seam copper roof and transparent acrylic wall panels. The arches spring from two cast-in-place concrete, stone-faced abutments. To conform to the Americans with Disabilities Act, the 5-foot rise was configured into a system of ramps and platforms.
244
A New Covered Bridge for Old Salem
FIGURE 17-3 The bridge is protected by a standing seam copper roof.
FIGURE 17-4 The arches spring from stone-clad concrete abutments.
There is no historical precedent for a covered bridge at this location or in the vicinity of Old Salem. Certainly, however, North Carolina had many covered bridges, which spanned nearby rivers such as the Deep, Catawba, Haw, Dan and the Yadkin.1
History
245
FIGURE 17-5 The 5-foot rise had to be configured into a series of ramps and landings to conform with ADA.
HISTORY In 1751, the land now occupied by the city of Winston-Salem in North Carolina was a wilderness crossed by the hunting trails of the Cherokee, Creek, and Catawba Indian tribes. In London, leaders of the Moravian Church were considering an offer of John Carteret, the Earl of Granville, to sell them a large tract of land from his holdings in the North American colony. The Moravians, the spiritual descendants of the Czech priest Jan Hus who was martyred in 1415, had established in 1741, the town of Bethlehem, Pennsylvania, as their chief center in North America. It is from Bethlehem that Moravian explorers set out in August 1752 to search for suitable land.2 A small group of five men left Pennsylvania traveling down the coast past the Chesapeake Bay to Edenton, North Carolina. Their leader was Bishop August Gottlieb Spangenberg, whose task it was to search for the 100,000 acres of land for the church to purchase from the Earl of Granville. Accompanied by the Earl of Granville’s chief surveyor and three local inhabitants, they traveled westward.2 After a wrong turn that led them into the North Carolina mountains, the group found the tract of land they were searching for. They had surveyed several plots that proved to be unsuitable prior to locating a large tract of land, which they named Wachovia.2 In the following year, 1753, a group of Single Brethren
246
A New Covered Bridge for Old Salem
(unmarried Moravian men) journeyed from Pennsylvania, down the Shenandoah River Valley, and into North Carolina to establish a new settlement.2 In 1755, the first married couples arrived to take up residence in the temporary town of Bethabara. The permanent settlement of Salem was established in 1766. For many decades, overland travel between the two Moravian communities was common. This historical link between Pennsylvania and North Carolina is important in the justification of the type of truss system selected for the new Salem Bridge.
PROJECT JUSTIFICATION The following time line is provided to show that a Burr arch-truss is the most logical choice for this particular span. 1753 The first Moravian settlers arrive from Bethlehem, Pennsylvania. They establish Bethabara as a temporary community. 1771 Theodore Burr, a Harrisburg, Pennsylvania engineer and contractor is born in Connecticut. 1776 The residents of Bethabara move to Salem. 1784 Ithiel Town, a New Haven, Connecticut, architect, engineer, and bridge promoter is born. 1804 Theodore Burr builds a 400-foot span bridge across the Hudson River at Waterford, New York. 1817 Theodore Burr’s patent of 1817 claimed nothing but the arch combined with the multiple kingpost truss. This became the most popular covered bridge structural system. 1820
Ithiel Town’s plank-lattice design patent.
1822 Financial failure and death of Theodore Burr. 1835 Ithiel Town (1784–1884) secured a patent for a lattice bridge with double webs and secondary chords. 1835 The Humpback bridge is built near Covington, Virginia. The 120foot-long multiple kingpost bridge has an 8-foot rise. 1842
The pamphlet “Hints on Bridge Construction by an Engineer” is published by Herman Haupt of Pennsylvania.
1844
Ithiel Town dies.
1894
Bunker Hill Covered Bridge is built in Claremont, North Carolina, after Herman Haupt’s improved lattice.
Project Justification
247
1970 The oldest covered bridge in the United States, built in 1812, is a Burr located near Lewisburg, Pennsylvania. 1971 Nearly 300 Burr arch-trusses are still standing, with 175 located in Pennsylvania, more than in any other state. 1980 Of 893 historic covered bridges remaining in the United States, 231 are in Pennsylvania and 6 in North Carolina. 1989 Surviving Covered Bridges in Northampton County near Bethlehem, Pennsylvania include: Name
SpanType
Date Built
Solts Mill/Kreidersville
115 ft. Burr arch
1840
1989 Surviving covered bridges in Lehigh County near Bethlehem, Pennsylvania include:
Name
SpanType
Date Built
Bogert
187 ft. Burr-arch
1841
Wehr
236 ft. Burr-arch
1841
Manassas Guth
127 ft. Burr arch
1858
Rex
136 ft. Burr-arch
1858
Geiger
130 ft. Burr-arch
1858
Schlicher
127 ft. Burr arch
1882
The Burr arch-truss was the logical choice for a covered bridge in Old Salem. This is the type of bridge that Moravian settlers would have built during the first half of the nineteenth century as their community matured. During this period, many Burr arch-trussed bridges were built in Northampton and Lehigh Counties in Pennsylvania near the Moravian settlement of Bethlehem. In 1970, nearly 300 Burr arch-trusses were still standing, with 175 located in Pennsylvania. Of the seven surviving covered bridges in Lehigh and Northampton counties near Bethlehem, Pennsylvania, all are Burr arch-trusses3. Although a Town lattice bridge was proposed to be constructed on the plank road near Old Salem, this type of bridge was not desirable as a pedestrian bridge because it does not provide sufficient open space between chords to produce an open appearance. The Town lattice is distinctive in its use of simple sizes of lumber, and the small amount of framing. The resulting simplicity of framing requires less skilled labor but produces a closed tunnellike structure that must overshoot its supports in order to distribute its end reactions. The Burr arch-truss requires great
248
A New Covered Bridge for Old Salem
skill in timber framing, like the large Dutch barns found in many German communities. In chapter 15, we dispel the common belief that the Town lattice is simpler to build than a Burr arch-truss. Louis Wernwag (1770–1843), who was born in Germany, and Timothy Palmer (1751–1821) of Newburyport, Massachusetts, built many great timber bridges. Their bridges varied in design and construction, each being designed for a specific span, using a one-of-a-kind trussed arch. Because of their complexity, a pedestrian bridge built after the designs of Wernwag and Palmer was judged impractical for this project. For these reasons, it was decided that the Burr arch-truss was the logical choice for a covered bridge at Old Salem.
RECYCLED TIMBER Originally, the drawings indicated that the large posts were to be recycled material. The intent was to obtain these members with reasonable moisture content so that shrinkage in the posts would not affect the stiffness of the trusses. These members were assumed to be more available as recycled material because of their large cross-section and relatively short lengths. At one point, Al Anderson, of Blue Ridge Timberwrights, suggested that his company could furnish all of the material in the bridge as recycled timber. I agreed with the request as long as a dependable method of quality control could be instituted. During the process of material acquisition, BRTW revealed that it was unable to locate posts of a sufficient size in sufficient quantity. BRTW offered several solutions for mechanically attaching blocks to the posts. I considered mechanical attachment, but rejected it as inadequate. Alternatively, to fabricate the posts from glued laminated timber was not in keeping with the original intent of the project. I suggested that the blocks be attached by gluing in a glulam plant if quality control could ensure the integrity of the joint. Fabricating the large posts from new material would require extensive drying, if timbers so large could be found at all. It appeared at one point that the bridge would be furnished with recycled timber for everything but the posts. This change would have reversed the plans, which required new material with only the posts of recycled timber.
MATERIAL GRADING Recycled material posed a problem in grading. The Southern Pine Inspection Bureau (SPIB) does not have criteria for grading recycled material. Criteria for certain types of deterioration, damage, manmade holes, daps, notches, and mortises are not accounted for in the grading rules. There is no way to account for the history of recycled timber. The effects of long exposure to high loads or
Awards
249
elevated temperatures are unknown. NCDOT and I agreed that some sort of mechanical testing would be required to verify that each piece had the necessary integrity for its role in the bridge. It was agreed that first all timbers should be graded in accordance with SPIB Grading Rules. Drilled holes would be considered to be open knots with the same criteria applied regarding size, location, and frequency. After grading, all suitable timbers would be load tested by applying a known load and measuring the deflection across a given span in order to compute the modulus of elasticity. This would provide a measure of stiffness for each piece, presumably enabling us to discard pieces that fell below the published values for the grade. Certainly, knowing the modulus of elasticity for compressive members is particularly valuable. For tension members, it was thought that the recycled material, being extremely dense, would be at least as strong as published values for the same grade of new material.
MOISTURE CONTENT It became clear that moisture measurement using meters would be problematic. Because of accumulated salts in the recycled timbers, moisture contents varied widely. The history of the timbers, according to BRTW, included some that were taken from a marine structure and others that came from a building that stored agricultural chemicals. Several samples were oven dried, establishing that the average moisture content was much less than what the handheld moisture meters had indicated. Storage at the job site was critical to the moisture content of these materials. Timbers were stored at the site off the ground, but uncovered. Rain affected the top surface of the timbers. Water-filled mortise holes and areas around shakes and checks resulted in high moisture readings in various locations. Through numerous conversations between the North Carolina Department of Transportation, the timber frame subcontractor BRTW and I suggested that materials could evaluated and approved using a combination of handheld moisture readings verified with oven-dry tests.
AWARDS The New Covered Bridge for Old Salem won several awards for design, including the following: • 2002 Biennial Awards—Excellence in High Design, Award of Merit for the Pedestrian Bridge over Old Salem Bypass, Old Salem, North Carolina • Community Appearance Commission of Winston-Salem and Forsyth County—1999–2000 Count Zinzendorf Award
250
A New Covered Bridge for Old Salem
CONCLUSION The Salem Bridge revives traditional timber framing and bridge building as it was applied to the construction of covered bridges in North America during the first half of the nineteenth century. FIGURE 17-6 The end view displays the complexity inherent in extending the two-hinged arch to the bearing point without interrupting the bottom chord.
The project required the application of modern timber engineering to the design and construction of a cultural heritage structure. FIGURE 17-7 The bridge is an authentic covered bridge built in the traditional manner.
Bibliography
251
REFERENCES 1. Richard Sanders Allen, Covered Bridges of the Middle Atlantic States. (Brattleboro, Vermont: The Stephen Green Press, 1959). 2. C. Daniel Crews, Villages of the Lord: The Moravians Come to Carolina (Winston-Salem: Moravian Archives, 1995). 3. Susan M. Zacher, The Covered Bridges of Pennsylvania (Harrisburg, PA: Commonwealth of Pennsylvania and Museum Commission, 1994).
BIBLIOGRAPHY American Wooden Bridges (New York: American Society of Civil Engineers, 1976).
CHAPTER
18
The Tohickon Aqueduct
first became aware of the Tohickon Aqueduct project when contacted by William J. Collins, a landscape architect and timber framer from Point Pleasant, in Bucks County, Pennsylvania. We agreed to meet and discuss the proposed project at the annual meeting of the Timber Framers Guild of North America in Guelph, Ontario, in 1992. Bill Collins, a resident of Point Pleasant and a principal in the firm Simon Jaffe Collins Incorporated Landscape Architecture of Berwyn and Doylestown, Pennsylvania, had worked several years as project manager, landscape architect, and designer for the local sponsor, the Point Pleasant Community Association. The design concept he presented to me in Guelph was an aqueduct framed with Town lattice trusses, in keeping with the original 1834 construction. The Delaware Canal was constructed in the early 1830s with the primary goal of transporting anthracite coal from northeastern Pennsylvania to cities on the eastern seaboard. The Tohickon Aqueduct is a vital link in the 60-mile-long Delaware Canal carrying the canal over Tohickon Creek in Point Pleasant, Pennsylvania. The canal climbs 164 feet between Bristol and Easton through a series of 23 locks, over nine aqueducts. The Tohickon Aqueduct, originally built as a timber-framed Town lattice truss structure was replaced in the 1890s with an iron riveted structure containing a wood-framed trunkway. This aqueduct collapsed in 1931. After World War II, the canal was transformed into a Pennsylvania state park and the aqueduct reconstructed with steel girders supporting a cast-inplace concrete trunkway. By 1990, the badly deteriorated concrete and steel
I
Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
253
254
The Tohickon Aqueduct
structure needed to be replaced. As if to place an exclamation mark on the statement that the aqueduct needed to be replaced, a September 16, 1999, storm in Point Pleasant, caused a portion of the sidewall of the aqueduct to collapse. Bill Collins was one of several community leaders who were very interested in replacing the aqueduct as a timber structure. The concept plans were presented at a meeting of community and elected officials and officials of the Pennsylvania Department of Conservation and Natural Resources, Bureau of Facilities Design and Construction. A unique agreement was reached, allowing the community to collaborate with the State Parks Department by providing engineering plans for the timber superstructure outside the normal procurement process. Apparently, it was an easy agreement to broker, as the state would not have to pay for the engineering. Fortunately, there was an organization interested in having the Tohickon Aqueduct constructed of wood. The Wood in Transportation Program of the U.S. Department of Agriculture Forest Service came to the rescue, providing five small grants to successive phases of the project. The state would be responsible for administration of the project and design of the substructure and the interface of the trunkway with the canal. Initial funding for design of the superstructure was provided by U.S. Forest Service grants through the Wood in Transportation Program. Initial funding was minimal, so design proceeded slowly between 1992 and 1999. This was especially frustrating for the members of the Point Pleasant Community Association when I presented them with construction photographs of the New Covered Bridge in Old Salem, North Carolina, a similar project well underway, which had started at the same time. By contrast, the aqueduct project had gone nowhere. During the extended design phase, the proposed Town lattice truss had evolved into a Burr arch-truss. The geometry of the aqueduct was governed by the existing stone piers, the canal grades, and location of the towpath. It was soon apparent that a trapezoidal shaped trunkway would be the most logical cross-section allowing sufficient space for the ten foot wide standard canal boat or barge while minimizing the total amount of weight to be supported. Grades required the trunkway to be supported on transverse beams supported by the bottom chords of two parallel trusses. Interior diagonal braces provided lateral stability to the top of the trusses, completing the trapezoidal shape. The use of a Town lattice truss had strong historical precedence in Bucks County, with 11 covered bridges, so framed, remaining in 1989. Those covered bridges were built between 1832 and 1875, certainly within the active history of the canal. It is interesting to note that the counties in Pennsylvania that had been settled by the English usually built Town lattice–framed covered bridges, while the counties settled by the Germans mostly built Burr arch–framed bridges. We were about to upset the covered bridge continuum.
The Tohickon Aqueduct
255
There were a number of good reasons for selecting a Burr arch-truss system instead of a Town lattice truss design for the superstructure. First, the original aqueduct was a Town lattice, which was replaced after 50 or 60 years with an iron aqueduct. We were not able to locate information about the original design, its configuration, or its record of service. As a result, a Town lattice design would be open to almost as much speculation as any other system. In reality, the Town lattice would have been a difficult system to construct, because it would have to be built on site with many trunnels driven into a large number of lapped joints of chords and lattice. The aqueduct, by its nature, needed to be built of pressure treated wood for durability. The problems of treating and drying pressure-treated timber would be virtually insurmountable using waterborne treatment such as Chromated Copper Arsenate (CCA). The acquisition of trunnel stock, which usually is of White Oak (impossible to pressure treat) and southern pine pressure-treated lattice and chord material, would require a very long lead time to dry, treat, and redry. Any excess moisture in the trunnels or lattice would result in splits forming in the lattice and the trunnels loosening as the structure reached its equilibrium moisture content. Although the goal was to design a bridge that timber framers could build, the assembly of a Town lattice structure requires specific experience and skills unique to certain bridgewrights. Although the Town lattice has a reputation for toughness, it contains many built up and intersecting members with a potential for decay between members on hidden surfaces. Boring or cutting through CCA pressure-treated material is problematic because salt crystals associated with the preservative tend to dull tools. Driving trunnels through salt-treated lattice and chords is also an issue because of the brashness of the treated wood and the roughness of the salt-treated surfaces, which must engage during the driving process. The Town lattice truss is labor intensive and would have to be built continuous over three spans, extending beyond the abutments a distance equal to its depth. Although this would allow for the forces at the end supports to be distributed among a sufficient number of lattices, as opposed to an abrupt termination resulting in excessive stresses in the lattice, the total length of the trusses would increase by 24 feet. Repairing a Town lattice truss is extremely difficult and labor intensive because of the closely spaced and tightly held lattice sticks. Again, this work would require the services of a bridgewright with specific experience. The Burr arch system was designed as a redundant system with either the arch or the truss able to support all loads, independent of the other. The nineteenthcentury builders would proportion each and then simply “yoke the two together.” In this way, they could circumvent the question of whether the truss stiffens the arch, or the arch stiffens the truss.
256
The Tohickon Aqueduct
In this case, the truss and arch were analyzed separately and then also together. Instead of superimposing the arch on the truss, in the computer we actually suspended the less stiff continuous truss from three two-hinged arch spans. The Burr arch structural system was designed to support a total weight of 8000 plf. FIGURE 18-1 The aqueduct consists of three equal spans of 66 feet. (See color insert.)
Although the superstructure was covered and protected with a membrane liner in the trunkway, all wood was specified to be pressure treated to resist decay. The aqueduct, by its very nature and environment, is susceptible to decay caused by moisture derived from condensation, leaks, and splash. The first design was as traditional as possible using timber-framed connections for splices and to build up the arches. The arches were detailed with mechanically fastened laminated members with shear blocks and stitch bolts with timber washers. The posts and braces were solid timbers, while the critical chord members were glued laminated timber members to ensure quality control and long continuous lengths. To minimize the amount of steel in the structure, posts and braces were notched to fit notches in the chord members. To provide continuity as the supports, the chords were connected with traditional bolt-o-lightning splices. The trunkway was fitted with a membrane liner to ensure the water-tightness of the aqueduct. We suggested that a second layer of wood consisting of large panels be placed on top of the liner to conceal it and provide puncture protection. An aqueduct is unique because it is uniformly loaded on a constant basis. A vessel traversing the aqueduct displaces an amount of water equal to its weight,
The Tohickon Aqueduct
257
and thus, does not increase the load to the structure. Aqueduct structures provide an opportunity to test the concept of load duration, which is central to the design of timber structures. The Tohickon Aqueduct was bid in 1999 with J.D. Eckman, Inc. of Chester County, Pennsylvania, submitting the low bid of $3.1 million. Several timberframe companies that were heavily courted by the designers declined to submit a bid. Because the low bid exceeded the state’s proposed budget, the Department of Conservation and Natural Resources was directed by the state to develop an alternative design in concrete. Again, on behalf of the Point Pleasant Community Association, Bill Collins petitioned the Department of Conservation and Natural Resources to consider a timber aqueduct. This time it would be a “value engineered” version of the first design, bid as an alternative to a concrete structure designed by the department. Again, it agreed, on similar terms, that value engineering would proceed without funding from the state. As before, the Forest Service agreed to fund the engineering design with the condition that the project include fiber-reinforced polymers to reduce cost. Fiberreinforced polymers were introduced as a research project of the Advanced Engineered Wood Composites Center at the University of Maine. The structural system was value engineered to reduce costs by simplifying details, remove requirements for traditional timber framer qualifications, and introduce more glued laminated timber into the project, in particular, for the two-hinged arches.
FIGURE 18-2 The arches were replaced through “value engineering” by glued laminated timber.
258
The Tohickon Aqueduct
Traditional hand-crafted joinery was deleted, including the complicated bolt-o’-lightning splices. The three spans were designed to be individual trussed systems identical in geometry. The use of Pennsylvania red oak was deleted as an alternative and the more easily obtained southern pine was specified. The goal of the value engineering was to reduce construction costs by $500,000. The revised project bid in 2000, with J.D. Eckman, Inc. again emerging as the low bidder, was $2.1 million, approximately $1 million less than the original. The aqueduct as built is a skewed structure, 201 feet, 10 inches in length with trusses that are 12 feet in height, out to out of the chords. FIGURE 18-3 The skewed structure is 201 feet, 10 inches in length.
It includes three 66-foot spans with double 6 ¾ inch by 23 3⁄8 inch glued laminated two-hinged arches yoked to a multiple kingpost truss with double 6 ¾ inch by 16 ½ inch and single 8 ¾ inch by 16 ½ inch glued laminated timber chords, top and bottom. Although the Tohickon Aqueduct was formally reopened on September 15, 2001, and was eligible for nomination for the special Palladio Award Competition for Covered Bridge Restoration announced by Clem Labine’s Traditional Building magazine, I was persuaded by one of the jurors not to enter it since it was a reconstruction and would not qualify. The Palladio Awards program launched in 2000 by Traditional Building magazine and Period Homes magazine included “covered bridge repair, preservation,
The Tohickon Aqueduct
259
FIGURE 18-4 The chords are pressure-treated glued laminated timber.
FIGURE 18-5 The superstructure was constructed of pressure-treated southern pine.
restoration, or reconstruction completed between 1998 and 2003.”1 It appeared that the twin dilemmas of whether the aqueduct would qualify as a covered bridge and whether a total reconstruction of the superstructure in an alternate system would render it unlikely to earn honors. Of course, there were historic examples
260
The Tohickon Aqueduct
FIGURE 18-6 The Tohickon Aqueduct was reopened on September 15, 2001.
FIGURE 18-7 The completed aqueduct won a National Timber Bridge Award in 2002. (See color insert.)
of aqueducts with Town lattice and Burr arch structural systems included in Richard Sanders Allen’s series of covered bridge books. Some structural engineers favor demolition of a historic covered bridge, only to reconstruct it new, as a viable preservation solution. They argue that the new rebuilt bridge is still historic
Reference
261
because the original “idea” remains. Certainly, the reconstruction from scratch of the superstructure of a long-gone timber framed aqueduct does not trample on preservation sensibilities. In fact, prior to the Palladio Awards, the Tohickon Aqueduct had won a first place National Timber Bridge Award in 2002 for “Rehabilitation of an Existing Bridge.” The most remarkable aspect of the Tohickon Aqueduct project was the ability of Bill Collins to move a state agency toward a solution in which they had no initial interest, and then obtain, through negotiation, interested third parties to pay for the engineering.
REFERENCE 1. Cesa, Edward A., News Release USDA Forest Service, January, 2003.
CHAPTER
19
The Current State of Historic Preservation Engineering: One Engineer ’s Point of View*
INTRODUCTION s we ease into the twenty-first century, it is useful to reflect on the last 30 years of preservation engineering in the United States, as well as the current status of the profession. One organization, the Association for Preservation Technology, has been at the forefront, raising awareness and providing a forum for a wide spectrum of preservation-engineering issues. There is, however, additional work to be done. Knowledge of preservation and materials technology, increased ability to communicate and exchange ideas, and both successes and failures in practice have enabled preservation engineers to make the necessary judgments in evaluating historic structures. The engineer must be convinced that the structural model in the computer is an accurate representation of the building, or the building components, being considered. Once that is clear, the application of rigorous analysis, test, and engineering judgment
A
* This chapter was originally written for the APT Bulletin Vol. XXIX, No. 3-4, Thirtieth-Anniversary Issue, The Journal of Preservation Technology, The Association of Preservation Technology. Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
263
264
The Current State of Historic Preservation Engineering: One Engineer’s Point of View
is necessary to explain why the structure has performed adequately for many years, rather than simply explaining why it is not working.
CURRENT PRACTICE Within the construction industry it is architects who have assumed leadership in historic preservation. A relatively small portion of structural engineers in private practice consult with architects on building design. Of these, very few provide engineering services for National Historic Landmark or National Register properties. Often, when engineers, as consultants to architects, respond to the particular program established for a project, the amount of sensitivity brought to bear is directly proportional to the architect’s direction. Fortunately, there are numerous projects where the engineer has introduced sensitivity to the benefit of the whole team. The creative preservation engineer can make a major difference in the overall success of a project by being sensitive to the original historic fabric. Structural engineers may become embroiled in conflicts over preservation philosophy with architects, clients, approving agencies, state preservation offices, and third-party reviewing organizations. In many cases, the engineer’s responsibility is to ensure that all structural code requirements are met with a minimum of intervention. At the same time, money allocated for testing may be limited. The tendency is to opt for a retrofitted independent structural system, such as a steel or concrete frame, which will support all vertical and lateral structural loads, including the building’s own weight. This, to many engineers, is the most appropriate solution because it circumvents the issue of the capacity of the existing structure, particularly in buildings with timber structural components and masonry walls. One would assume that sufficient fieldwork would be undertaken to verify deficiencies and deterioration before replacing the existing structural system with the new. Often, however, this is not the case. In many cases, the decision is based on insufficient testing, observation, and analysis. The philosophy of analyzing the structural system of a building sufficiently to justify doing little or nothing to the historic fabric is contrary to current practice, which establishes design fees on the basis of how much work needs to be done. An innovative, creative solution including research, job-site observation and measurement, long-term monitoring, and extensive analysis of the existing system and potential solutions may be beyond the fee structure in the standard contractual arrangement between architect and engineering consultant, since fees are usually determined as a percentage of construction cost. Unfortunately, an intrusive solution requiring major intervention may result.
Preservation Engineering Education
265
Our society, which demands immediate solutions, does not tolerate unforeseen costs and does not forgive errors or omissions in construction or design. This forces the design engineer to follow the path of least risk, although this approach may result in the highest overall project cost. For construction financing purposes, cost must be predictable. To prevent possible cost overruns due to unforeseen conditions, the design engineer is often forced into major intervention involving great quantities of new materials, which are far more predictable. The perceived risk extends to the serviceability of the rehabilitated historic structure and is based on “not knowing.” Lack of information originates with the absence of a thorough investigative program involving observation, testing, and analysis. Some architects may be tardy in bringing the preservation engineer on board. Selection of a qualified engineer early in the project is crucial. According to Martin Weaver (1993): “Although structural surveys should involve qualified structural engineers, the conservator is frequently going to encounter evidence of structural problems when no engineer is present and in situations where it is unlikely that anybody is going to be able to return for a second look until much later in the project when it may be too late.”1 Some architects may be unsure of which consultants they should hire. Rather than hire both a conservator and a structural engineer, they engage one of them, until it is apparent that the needs of the project dictate additional assistance. As an organization, the Association for Preservation Technology is built on the premise that an interdisciplinary relationship must exist for a project to succeed. The concept of minimum intervention was confirmed in the special APT Bulletin (XXIII, 1991) on preservation engineering.2 APT members have also engaged in interdisciplinary exchanges with such organizations as the American Concrete Institute, the American Society for Testing Materials, the American Society of Civil Engineers, the American Society for NonDestructive Testing, and others. APT is one of few organizations that serve as a forum for technical issues, as well as preservation philosophy. Many times, it is the conservator and structural engineer working together who strike a balance between structural adequacy and the maximum retention of historic fabric.
PRESERVATION ENGINEERING EDUCATION In many ways, the engineering profession is slighting preservation practice in that engineering education applies the latest in research and thought to new construction. Very little time is given to historical perspectives relating to the built environment, regardless of when it was built.
266
The Current State of Historic Preservation Engineering: One Engineer’s Point of View
Academic training for engineers in North America is lacking in several crucial areas of preservation technology. Courses in history, history of technology, materials science, masonry, timber design, and preservation are the minimum core subjects for a program in preservation engineering. Other courses, such as industrial processes, would provide students with an appreciation of basic manufacturing methods uncommon in today’s construction industry. For economic and environmental reasons, many manufacturing methods have disappeared or have been relocated outside of North America. As a result, engineers are not being trained in such areas as pattern making and foundry practice. This puts them at a disadvantage when such mundane items as earthquake washers must be specified. Some universities are providing appropriate courses for preservation engineering undergraduates. This direction should be encouraged. However, the nationwide push toward mandatory continuing education for engineers presents the best opportunity so far to ensure that practicing engineers are equipped with preservation knowledge and skills. In the United States, preservation engineers and trainers must become aware of the professional development requirements in each state in order to address shortcomings. Moreover, APT, an organization composed mostly of architects and conservators and an excellent repository of research and experience, is in an ideal position to help provide continuing education to practicing engineers.
RESEARCH IN HISTORIC STRUCTURES Historic structures provide the best laboratories for basic research in materials. The service life of a material or system can best be observed in an installation that has experienced cycles of thermal and moisture changes, long periods of sunlight, and gravitational force. Accumulated knowledge in preservation technology offers a broader palette of solutions. For example, a structural system to replace a historic hammer-beam truss in a church could be a steel frame clad in wood, a glued laminated timber frame with bolted connections and steel side plates, or a traditional timber frame with dovetail and mortise-andtenon connections, or multiple leaves of prefabricated nail plate trusses. The structural system could be built with precast concrete or extruded aluminum box sections, or the frame could consist of fiber-reinforced plastic resin structural elements simply grained to look like wood. The final decision should depend on what is most appropriate for the project, rather than what is most comfortable for the engineer. Unfortunately, there is little incentive for the construction-material industry to spend money on historic-materials research. Basic research focuses on
Building Codes
267
bringing new products to market. For example, basic research into the loadduration factor for timber design as it applies to timber structures that have been in service for a very long time will not help sell new products for the forest-products industry. The clay-products industry has little or no interest in doing research into what might be considered archaic systems, such as limebased mortars, terra cotta, and structural clay tile. Smaller specialty suppliers are still the primary source of replacement materials for preservation projects.
BUILDING CODES Building codes continue to change in response to disasters. The terrible Triangle Shirtwaist Company factory fire of March 25, 1911, affected building codes in New York City, as well as other North American cities. The 1981 Kansas City Hyatt Regency walkway failure changed the way steel structures are designed and detailed by shifting more of the burden for the design of shop details to the engineer of record. As a result of Hurricane Andrew, which battered south Florida in 1992, codes have been complicated with various windload factors and unrealistic loading conditions in order to prevent future damage from a similar storm, as if a deficiency in the code were the problem (studies have shown that the code in South Florida was more than adequate, had it been followed, to produce buildings constructed well enough to resist wind forces generated by Hurricane Andrew). The Northridge, California, earthquake of 1994, as well as the one in Kobe, Japan, a year later, will greatly affect seismic requirements of the building codes to be published in the next few years. New textbooks, handbooks, design codes, and building codes regularly replace the old. In recent years, there has been an accelerated transfer of basic research regarding the application of loads—wind, snow, and seismic—from the graduate-school laboratories directly into model building codes. Building codes are not the proper forums for this exchange of ideas; rather, they should be a distillation of the best and simplest requirements, which have been proven. Only time will tell how these more complex building codes will affect the existing stock of buildings as they become candidates for restoration, rehabilitation, or demolition. Instead of being of repository of minimal, yet simple, requirements for the construction of the safe structures, building codes are prescribing complicated methods of analysis, forcing engineers into a “cookbook” methodology from which they cannot vary, except at their own peril. An engineer evaluating the seismic resistance of a historic structure must fit in into a certain building type.
268
The Current State of Historic Preservation Engineering: One Engineer’s Point of View
In a 1990 issue of Wood Design Focus, Arlo Ceccotti presented an earthquakeperformance challenge to researchers, code writers, and designers: It is evident that thorough knowledge and planned balance of the positive and negative aspects will yield a proper design that guarantees structural safety at a reasonable cost. Researchers have the challenge of quantifying the factors that yield ductile behavior and energy dissipation in the structure. They can determine how to design and detail connections that lead to ductile systems, rather than brittle failures. Code writers have the challenge of combining the often disparate results of research. They must present a few relatively simple and conservative design rules, which are easy to apply, for the most common structural forms (those with known ductility and dissipation levels). Yet, for less common structures, for which experience has demonstrated good structural performance, code writers must provide simple rules or guidelines based on the engineering judgment. Designers, have the challenge of finding the classes, creating the most convenient design from technical and economical points of view.3
Having participated in a building code review committee, it is apparent that code writers ultimately accept the findings of academia, possibly due to liability concerns, As Ceccotti has explained, these issues will not go away, and their impact on historic structures cannot be denied. Proposed seismic provisions for building additions will affect the historic preservation and the renovation and rehabilitation segments of the construction industry. The application of complicated seismic requirements, which are subject to wide interpretation, will cause the demolition of many existing buildings. For example, to determine the seismic resistance of an existing building accurately, the unit weight and shear capacity of the existing masonry must be known. This may require extensive testing in the field to obtain design values to be used in the analysis, for which owners often are not willing to pay. Seismic strengthening should not automatically require the installation of a retrofitted steel or concrete structural system into a building. Bernard Feilden (1982) has discussed methods of strengthening historic buildings to retain as much historic fabric as possible: “Examination of earthquake damage shows that bonding of walls together at the corners is vital, together with the tying of floors and roofs to walls. The insertion of tensile reinforcement with some degree of prestressing to bond elements together give the masonry of historic buildings greater earthquake resistance.”4 Photographs of heavily damaged buildings in Friuli, Italy, after the 1979 earthquake demonstrate the efficiency of temporary timber bracing. Similar bracing can be employed during repairs to stabilize tall masonry walls. Many owners faced with rehabilitating or adding to an older or historic structure will elect to demolish when faced with engineering fees for evaluation
Conclusion
269
or potentially unknown construction costs required to bring a building into conformance with the seismic code.
ENGINEERING JUDGMENT Preservation engineering is quite different from designing new structures. Freedom of choice is eliminated. The preservation engineer must evaluate an existing system, which in some cases was not designed but merely proportioned according to a pattern book based on rules of thumb. Meeting the requirements of the building code is not the same as ensuring a safe structure. Structural engineers must make the judgments necessary to keep a historic structure in service when parameters appear to fall short of minimum code requirements. For example, in reviewing the capacity of an existing structural member, many parameters complicate the process. Size, span, and spacing of members are dictated by the structure. It is the engineer’s task to determine the size, orientation, material, properties, and boundary conditions of all the structural elements in an existing building. It must be recognized that structural members that are determined to be “overstressed” may in fact be perfectly safe. It is important to evaluate the basis for the conclusion. The loads assumed for design should be reconciled with the actual loads. A safe floor structure should not fail in bending due to the actual loads imposed, but excessive deflection, excessive vibration, or a lack of stiffness should not automatically categorize a floor structure as unsafe. Strict deflection limitations should be set for floors that support plaster ceilings in lieu of wood, or tin ceilings, or no ceilings at all. For comfort, the deflection limitation set in most building codes for floors, no matter what the ceiling, as 1/360th of the span. Today we have the technology to analyze loose-laid stone walls, obtaining a quantitative methodology that utilizes lateral earth and hydrostatic pressures, unit weights, friction and roughness coefficients, shape factors, and wall dimensions. Yet engineers insist on building replacement stone walls with reinforced concrete faced with a stone veneer while knowing that the serviceability of a loose-laid stone wall, properly constructed of a suitable stone material, can easily outlast the reinforced concrete wall.
CONCLUSION Preservation engineers dare to meet challenges that engineers engaged in new construction never encounter. The knowledge that is being accumulated through these experiences needs to be shared with engineers entering the field through
270
The Current State of Historic Preservation Engineering: One Engineer’s Point of View
undergraduate education and with practicing engineers, who must continue to educate colleagues in architecture, government, and the community about proper preservation techniques so that the body of knowledge and the physical inventory of historical structures will remain for those who follow.
REFERENCES 1. Martin E. Weaver, Conserving Buildings, Guide to Techniques and Materials (New York: John Wiley & Sons, 1993), 5. 2. Stephen J. Kelley, “Overview: The Role of the Engineer in Preservation, “APT Bulletin XXIII (1991): 6. 3. Arlo Ceccotti, “The Earthquake Performance Challenge,” Wood Design Focus 1 (1990): 3. 4. Feilden, Bernard M. Conservation of Historic Buildings (New York: Butterworth & Co. Ltd., 1982), 104-105, 121.
BIBLIOGRAPHY Fitch, James Marston. Historic Preservation: Curatorial Management of the Built World (New York: McGraw-Hill, 1982), 128–129, 146–147, 350–355. Harvey, John. Conservation of Buildings (London: John Baker, Ltd. 1972), 116–125. Hosner, Jr., Charles B. Preservation Comes of Age – From Williamsburg to the National Trust, 1926–1949 (Virginia: The University Press of Virginia, 1981). The Preservation Press, National Truss for Historic Preservation, Preservation: Toward an Ethic in the 1980’s (Washington, D.C.: National Preservation Conference Williamsburg, Va., 1980).
Index
AASHO. See American Association of State Highway and Transportation Officials Abington, VA, 56 ACI. See American Concrete Institute Adair, Kenneth, 188 African American, 125 Ahoskie, NC, 87 AITC. See American Institute of Timber Construction Alison, Olivia, 174 Allen, Richard Sanders, 260 American Association of State Highway and Transportation Officials, 36 American Concrete Institute (ACI), 25, 29, 265 American Institute of Timber Construction (AITC), 28 American Plywood Association (APA), 34, 119 Ames Dial Deflectometer, 85 Anderson, Al, 56, 248 Anthony, Ron, 54, 143 APA See American Plywood Association Appalachian Mountains, 31 Aqueduct, 47 Archeological evidence, 125, 132 ASTM, ix, 7, 76, 84–85, 131, 173 The Atlantic Monthly, 26 Auchumpkee Covered Bridge, 109, 216, 217 AutoCAD®, 135 Beaufort, SC, 91, 104–105, 170, 176 Bending stress, 16, 18–19, 65, 81, 152–153, 201 Bethlehem, PA, 123, 241, 245, 246, 247 Blake, Charlie, 47, 135 Blake Moving Company, 46–47, 50, 135 Blue Ridge Timberwrights, 48, 56, 133, 248 Bolt-o-lightning, 49, 256, 258 Bolts-plus, 105–106 Bow’s Notation, 36 Brazil, 33 Brick, 7–8, 43–46, 76–79, 86, 99–103, 125, 182, 190 Brick masonry, 6–8, 44–45, 75–76, 97, 102–103, 127–128, 160, 178, 187 Brick piers, 43
Bridges, 27, 35–36, 63, 211–226 covered, 49–56, 207–210, 219–220, 227–239, 241–251 highway, 11 historic, ix, 11–12 one-lane, 11 two-lane, 11 Buie’s Creek, NC, 101 Bull, Peter, 48, 121 Bunker Hill Covered Bridge, 49, 219–225, 246 Burnside Plantation, 50 Burr, Theodore, 27, 212–214 Bush, David M., 193 Buxton, NC, 183, 201 Cable-stayed, 233, 234, 236 CABO code, 29 Caisson foundations, 30 Campbell University, 101 Camp, Billy, 103 Canada, 15, 57, 68, 149, 152 Cape Hatteras Lighthouse, 181–205 Carteret, John, 123, 245 Cast iron, 6, 67, 211 Catawba County, NC, 49, 219–221, 224 CCA. See Copper Chromated Arsenate Ceccotti, Ario, 32, 268 Certified rehabilitation, 2, 69, 83 Chapel Hill, NC, 45 Charleston, SC, 8, 10, 30–31, 48, 52, 98–109, 115, 122, 152–157 Charlotte, NC, 49, 224 Chesterfield Associates, 234 Chesnut, Sarah, 54 Chowan County Courthouse, 18, 152 Church of the Virgin Mary, 190–191 Civil Engineering, 23–24 Civil War, 54, 115–116, 125, 219, 225 Clay tile, 30, 102, 267 Code Mandated Vibratory Analysis, 29 Collins, Bill, 47–48, 253–254, 257, 261 Computer model, 11, 64, 66, 154, 220
Structural Investigation of Historic Buildings: A Case Study Guide to Preservation Technology for Buildings, Bridges, Towers, and Mills. David. C. Fischetti © 2009 John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
271
272
Index
Concord, NH, 18, 152 Concrete Reinforcing Steel Institute (CRSI), 6, 88 Connecticut, 50, 115, 192, 228, 234, 246 Conservation, viii, 41–56, 115, 149–168, 178–179 Continued professional development, 38 Continuity, viii, 11, 25, 46, 63, 106, 154, 176, 217, 233 Contour interval, 4, 63 Copper Chromated Arsenate (CCA), 157, 163, 255 Corning Glass Museum, 80 Cornish-Windsor Bridge, 227–239 Count Zinzendorf, 124 Crack monitoring, 4–5 Crawl space, 43–46, 74–78, 84, 100, 127 Cribbing, 43, 54, 107, 109–110, 190, 198–199, 202 CRSI. See Concrete Reinforcing Steel Institute Cyclic loading, 10, 18, 64, 152 Darlington, SC, 43 Darrah Hall, 52–53 Deflection, viii, 2–6, 16–19, 45–46, 63–65, 151–155, 165, 231–232, 269 Delaware Canal, 47, 253 De Niro, Robert, 33 Design philosophy, 36, 208 Diamond Shoals, 184 Differential settlement, 123 Dorton Arena, vii Drift pin, 12 Drill rig, 84, 131, 134, 135 DuPont, William, 139 Dutchmen, 49, 52, 54, 147, 156–157 Dywidag®, 234 Eagle Block Hotel, 87–90 Economic Recovery Tax Act, 58 Engineering education, 36–37 preservation, 265–266 Engineering judgment, 17, 33, 64, 150, 269 Engineer of record, 3, 25–27, 33–35, 42, 161, 267 Epoxy, 52–53, 67, 76, 119, 146–147, 162–165, 201 Equilibrium moisture content, 8–9, 59, 255 Factor of safety, 17, 135, 194, 201 Fees, 22, 28 Feilden, Bernard, 268 Fiber saturation point, 9, 59–60 Fish plates, 61 Flat-plate, 87–90 Fletcher, Bela J., 228 Florida, 34–35, 55, 188, 267 Fore, George T., 91–92, 94, 103, 154–155, 186, 205 Foundation Services, Inc., 134–135 Freeze-thaw, 176 Froehling & Robertson (F&R), 81, 85, 131, 156, 174 Fungi, 161, 162
Garcia, Antonio M., 24 Garrett Hotel, 87 Geotechnical testing, 84 Globalization, 55 Glued laminated timber, 16, 48, 54–56, 118, 149, 152, 160–166, 210, 227, 231–237, 248, 257–259 Glulam, 149–168, 231, 232–239, 248 Goddard Bridge, 215 Goldberg, Mike, 48, 120 Grade beams, 138, 188, 195 Grading rules, 9, 60, 248–249 grading rules expert, 9 Graham, Tommy, 52, 54, 156 Grant writers, 42 Graphic analysis, 36 Graton, Arnold, 49–51, 54, 109–110, 145, 216, 224–225 Graton, JR, 109, 216 Graton, Milton, 216, 229 Greensboro, NC, 46, 134–135, 233 Griphoists®, 110, 111 Ground modification, 42 Halma, Sidney, 224 Hand-auger borings, 84 Hanisch, Max C., 159 Harshman, Scott, 134 Haupt, Herman, 21, 27, 49, 211–219, 225, 246 Hawaii, 31, 33 Hayward Barker, Inc., 134, 135 Henderson, NC, 50 Hillman Incorporated, 189, 198 Hillsborough, NC, 19, 153 Historic Covered Bridge Preservation Program, 211 Historic District Commission, 45 Historic Preservation Office, 64 H.M. Kern Corporation, 135 Horizontal deflection, 45–46, 155 Horizontal shear, 11, 16, 60, 65, 150, 161–162, 217 Hurricane Fran, 49–50, 58 Hurricane Hugo, 31, 153–154 Hyatt-Regency, 25, 267 IASM. See International Association of Structural Movers Improved lattice, 49, 219–220, 222–223, 246 Increment borer, 9, 59, 76–77 In Situ, 175 International Association of Structural Movers (IASM), 43 International Building Code, 3 International Chimney Corporation, 181, 194, 195, 204, 205 Iron dogs, 61 Jacking, 42–44, 98, 164, 205, 218 James Madison’s Montpelier, 54, 62, 139–147 Jeanes, John, 144
Index Jobsite observation, 44, 129 John Milner Architects, Inc., 126, 130 Joints dovetail, 60, 63, 68, 152, 266 tenon, 60, 63, 68, 152, 157, 266 Joist hangers, 11, 44, 60, 146, 164 Joist substitutes, 16, 18, 68, 168 Kivett Hall, 101 Knots, 63, 215, 231, 249 Kobe, Japan, 29, 105, 267 Laminated veneer lumber, 18, 54, 68, 146–147 Lateral bracing, 5, 66–67, 78, 107–109, 138, 209 Larson, John, 130, 131, 138, 242 LEED, 158 Lehigh, PA, 241, 247 Lewandowski, Jan, 47, 49, 233 Lime mortar, 7, 100, 101, 107, 170 Live load duration, 17, 64, 151 Load duration, viii, 13, 17–18, 64, 151–152, 257 Load and Resistance Factor Design (LRFD), 29, 151–152 Load testing, 4, 6, 65–66, 208 Long-term deflection, 35, 46 LRFD. See Load and Resistance Factor Design Lumber grades, 49
273
The New Jersey Rehab Code, 3 NC State Building Code, 81. See also North Carolina State Building Code NDS. See National Design Specification for Wood Construction Nervi, Pier Luigi, 36 New London, CN, 192 Newport, NH, 87, 89 North Carolina State Building Code, 3, 29, 221. See also NC State Building Code North Carolina State University, 49, 72, 74, 83, 56, 183 Northampton County, 241, 247 Northridge, CA, 29, 267 Old-growth, 10 Old-growth forest, 63, 158 Old Salem, 56, 123, 241 Oppermann, Joseph K. 115 Orange, VA, 54 Original plans, 5, 185 Outer Banks, 183 Oven-dried weight, 9, 59, 85, 249 Owen-Thomas House, 174 Oxford Limestone, 52
MACTEC, 195, 204–205 Magee, Tom, 121 Market Hall, 10, 48–49, 115–122 Marl, 31 Maxwell diagram, 36 MBM Construction, 48 Mesick, Cohn, Wilson, and Baker Architects, 54, 144 Methylene chloride, 163 Midway Plantation, 50 Miles Brewton House, 52, 152, 156 Milner, John, 126, 130 Mini piles, 130, 131, 134–135, 137–138 Modulus of elasticity, 19, 46, 66, 97, 174, 208, 249 Moisture content, 8–9, 18, 46, 54, 59–60, 67, 76, 249 Moisture penetration, 8, 13 Montague Building, 18–19, 71–90, 152 Montezuma Castle, vii Moorfields, 19, 153 Moravians, 123, 123, 125, 241, 245 Morris Island, 115 Mortar, 6–7, 30, 76, 92, 100–101, 136, 170–171, 267 MTMA Design Group, 186, 193 Museum of Early Southern Decorative Arts, 243
Palladio Awards, 122, 258, 261 Palmer, Timothy, 27, 248 Partridge, Reuben L., 210 Penetration tests, 131 Peshtigo, 159–160 Phillips, Charles A. 129 Phillips & Oppermann, 115, 130 Piles pencil, 134 piles, 134 pin, 134 Pilkey, Orrin H., 183, 193 Pinckney, B.J., 94 Pith, 60 Pittsburgh, PA, 189, 190 Plan stamping, 54–56 Pocopson Industries, 48 Point Pleasant, PA, 47, 253–254, 257 Pooley, Bruce, 28 Portland cement, 92, 100, 135, 171, 177, 179, 188, 200 Preservation engineers, 18, 68, 168, 263, 269 Preservation philosophy, 16, 41–42, 68–69, 150, 227, 238, 264–265 Purlin, 9, 16, 59, 63–64, 142, 150, 168
National Design Specification for Wood Construction (NDS), 28, 67, 81, 208 National Park Service, 64, 86, 172, 181, 186–187, 193, 204 Negligence, 26, 33
Rehabilitation, 2, 68–72, 115, 161, 194, 228–232, 235 Relative humidity, 8–9, 59, 93 Replacement-in-kind, 18, 68, 152, 155–156, 168, 230 Resistance drilling, 54, 143 Restoration, 6–7, 49, 72, 91, 125–127, 135–138, 229
274
Index
Restoration mason, 42, 120 Riveted iron truss, 47 Riveted steel structures, 12 Roller bearing, 46 Romanesque Revival, 74 Ruscon, 109 Saw kerf, 60 Scarf joint, 60–62, 67, 156 Screws, 67–68, 83–84, 158, 164 Season checks, 60 The Secretary of the Interior’s Guidelines, 161, 165. See also The Secretary of the Interiors Standards for Rehabilitation The Secretary of the Interiors Standards for Rehabilitation, 2, 68, 73, 92. See also The Secretary of the Interior’s Guidelines Seismic design, 29–33 Seismic Hazard Exposure Group, 32 Scissors trusses, 44–46 Shear blocks, 61, 120, 230, 256 Shear heads, 77, 88, 89 Shop drawings, 25, 54, 55, 161–163 Shoreline erosion, 183, 184 Shoring, 41–43, 54, 74, 77–79, 115, 134, 197–198, 203–205, 210 Shrinkage radial. 9, 59, 66 tangential, 9, 59, 66 volumetric, 9, 59 Sickles-Taves, 103, 172, 176 Simbel, Abu, 191, 192 Simmons, Albert, 98 Simplified engineering, 21–40 S & ME, 100, 103, 104, 106 Smith, J. Stephen, 109 Snowdrift, 27–28 Snow, J.P., 228, 229 Southern pine, 10, 18–19, 46, 81–82, 127, 157, 215, 225, 232, 248, 259 Specialty contractor, 41–56, 138 Specific gravity, 9, 59, 66–67, 76, 85, 172 SPIB, 248, 249 Split Rings, 67 Standard penetration, 84, 105, 131 Statically indeterminate, 37, 213 Steel, 6, 12, 25, 77–79, 83–90, 99, 136–142, 162–164, 166, 197–203, 264–268 Steeple, 23, 52, 93, 99, 109, 113, 123, 153–158 Stetson, Dexter, 185, 195 St. Helena’s Episcopal Church, 91–113, 170 St. Helena Island, SC, 52 Stick, David, 185 St. Michael’s, 31, 52, 99, 153, 156–157 St. Philip’s Episcopal Church, 101
Stone, vii, 6, 15, 33, 42, 57, 154, 184–187, 195–199, 230, 269 Storrs, J.W. 229 Strain gauges, 4 Stucco, 8, 92, 102–103, 176–177 Structures existing, viii, 3, 10, 30, 37–38, 87, 159 historic, 1–14, 17–18, 64, 151–152, 266–267 Surveyor, 2, 42, 76, 208, 245 Tabby, 92, 103, 169–179 Tasker, James F., 228, 237 Tax credit, 86–87 Tax credit status, 74, 83 Tedesko, Anton, 23 Telfair Museum of Art, 174 Tenon, 60, 63, 68, 152, 157, 266 Termites, 69, 161, 162 Terra cotta, 6, 267 Testing laboratory, 156, 173, 208 Thomaston, GA, 109, 216 Thermal movement 4, 13 Timber, viii, 4–6, 8–13, 15–19, 28, 47–51, 57–70, 85–86, 149–168, 221–225, 231–232 Timber design, 8–11, 15–18, 28–29, 58–60 Timber framer, 42, 47–56, 64, 120–121, 224, 232, 255 Timber Framers Guild of North America, 120, 253 Timber joinery, 61–63, 139 Tinius-Olsen, 156 Tohickon Aqueduct, 47–48, 253–261 Tongue and groove decking, 243 Topographic plan, 4, 63 Town, Ithiel, 27, 211, 214–219, 222, 228, 246 Town lattice, 47–51, 212, 214–219, 227–229, 238, 241, 247–248, 253–255, 260 Treenails, 60 Triangle Shirtwaist Company, 267 Trinity United Methodist Church, 43–44 Trunnels, 48, 60, 127, 215, 217, 220, 255 Tudor arches, 159, 162–165 Tuttle, Harry, 33 Ultimate stress design, 29 Underpinning, 42, 74, 106, 125–127, 130–131, 134–135, 138 Underwriters Laboratory, 25 United Church of Chapel Hill, 44–47 United hydraulic system, 181, 202, 203 Use factor, 155 Utica Road Covered Bridge, 213 Wachovia, 124, 245 Wake County, NC, 50, 84 Walker Building, 18–19, 152 Watagua Club, 74
Index Watagua Hall, 71–90 Weaver, Martin, 265 Wernwag, Louis, 27, 248 Whipple, Squire, 21, 27, 219 White, Percival, 26 White’s Mill, 56 Wilson, Barrett, 193 Winston-Salem, NC, 115, 125, 130, 243, 245, 249 Wood Design Focus, 32, 268
The Wood Handbook, 9, 60, 67 Wood scientist, 42, 54, 143 Working stress design, 29, 152 Wright, David W., 228 Wrought iron, ix, 6, 11, 66, 153, 158 nails, 11 Yates Mill, 49–50, 58, 70 Yates Mill Associates, 49 Yline, A., 28
275